(VOL-3 WEAPON TRAINING SUBJECTS) TRAINING DIRECTORATE-CRPF NEW DELHI - INDIA ( DECEMBER – 2011) 1 FOREWORD: The need for a single handbook containing all lessons of Constable (GD) basic training in CRPF has been felt for quite sometime. The raising of Addl. Trg. Centres further necessiated this - to provide the instructors with enough trg. materials in a single booklet form so that there is uniformity in the contents.. After discussions in various forums and consultations with experienced trainers the syllabus was reviewed. While reviewing the syllabus enough attention has been paid to the changing security scenario, modus operandi of anti-nationals and changing social millieu. This is the first time, the syllabus revision committee itself has come out with elaborate and comprehensive lesson plans on each of the subject which I feel will be very useful to the trainers. Prepared in roman hindi, the contents would be easily understood by even non-hindi speaking personnel. I hope, this handbook will benefit all trainers and trainees in enhancing their Knowledge,skill and aptitude in their duties. DEC-2011 NEW DELHI K.VIJAY KUMAR, IPS DIRECTOR GENERAL, CENTRAL RESERVE POLICE FORCE 2 FROM THE DESK OF ADDL.DGP(TRG.) : Training is the best investment for any Organisation, more so in an armed force like ours. The operational efficiency any unit can be best tested in its trg. ground. This roman hindi HANDBOOK FOR CT-GD BASIC TRG. consisting of all lessons/trg. for the whole 44 weeks trg. period, is prepared to benefit both instructors and trainees to impart/undergo trg. as per the present needs of our organistion. I hope this book will be of immense help to all – as prepared in easy language covering all topics in a comprehensive manner. D.K.PATHAK, IPS ADDITIONAL DGP (TRG.)-CRPF NEW DELHI INTRODUCTION BY IGP(TRG.) : It is during basic trg. that one learns all the fundamentals of any organisation.Hence its importance cannot be overemphasized.SRC has made, an all out attempt to review the contents of the basic course in accordance with the everchanging dynamics of our country’s internal security scenario.This change could not have been effectively communicated to the target group i.e., thousands of recruits joining this force- without making an authentic and comprehensive resource material. The compilation of lesson plans in a booklet form is an attempt in that direction. The committee would welcome any suggestion for inclusion in future editions. K.MADHUSUDHANAN, IGP-(TRG.)- CRPF NEW DELHI 3 PREFACE BY AUTHOR: “ A man would do nothing if he waits to do a work in such a way- that nobody would find fault on what he has done “ Compiling lesson plans on a variety of subject to be taught during long 44 weeks was’nt an easy task. We had to go through various sources like trg. books, pamphlets of Army, BSF, SPG,CRPF,CISF &Other forces/Police from our country through their publications. Internet was also a main source for thinking globally. This booklet has been made in simple Roman hindiwithout changing the meaning or spellings from the source , as Roman hindi is a flexible language with no firm spelling for a particular word -unlike pure English or hindi-and our main intention is to make the user to study easily and understand fully. Most of the lessons were prepared after due thoughts on the present Training Needs of our constables . I request the readers to advise/correct us , if any conceptual or spelling mistakes are found-through my e-mail id -- gkumarindia@aol.in-- for corrections and also request for their valuable suggestions to further improve this handbook. G.KUMAR , B.Sc.,M.A.,M.Phil.,MBA., SECOND-IN-COMMAND (30 BN CRPF-ASSAM) ATTACHED AT ATC – CRPF – AVADI (T.N) CONTENTS S/N O. A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CODE RE RM OCT UAC BOX SM HC PTT OMDPT PTTEST SUBJECT PHYSICAL TRAINING Running and Endurance RouteMarches Obstacle Clearing Trg. Un Armed Combat Boxing Swimming Hill & Building Climbing PT Tables One Minute Drill For Strengthening PT Tests PERIODs DAY PERIOD S NIGHT PERIO DS TOTAL PERIOD S 127 - 127 08 04 04 - 44 44 45 15 36 36 36 36 - 27 36 40 45 15 36 32 36 36 27 4 TOTAL B 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 C 1 2 LOD FD AD LRD CD FND OMDD DTEST 430 16 446 11 138 90 30 - 11 138 90 30 30 O9 20 - 30 09 20 12 - 12 TOTAL WEAPON TRAINING 5.56 INSAS Rifle 5.56 INSAS LMG 340 - 340 119 53 08 - 127 53 7.62 SLR 7.62 LMG 9MM Carbine Machine AKM 51 mm MORTAR NO.36 H.E Grenade 9MM Browning Pistol Tear Smoke Firing One Minute Drills with Weapon Bayonet Fighting Weapon Tests TOTAL 12 79 28 35 31 29 20 15 164 25 08 06 04 08 06 32 - 12 87 34 39 39 35 20 15 196 25 42 18 670 72 42 18 742 DRILL Lectures On Drill Foot Drill Arms Drill Lathi,Riot Drill and Bugle Calls Cane Drill Last rites Drill One Minute Drills in Uniform Drill Tests 3 4 5 6 8 9 10 15 16 17 INSAS LMGIN SLR LMG CM AKM MOR GN PIS TS FIR OMD 18 19 BAY WT-T D MR, GPS, FE, IED, FC, BC, TACTICS, CI&POLICE OPS, JC & F/FIRING (OUTDOOR SUBJECTS) MR Map Reading & GPS 28 08 36 FE Field Engineering, 36 36 Explosives & IEDs FC Field Craft 28 16 44 BC Battle Craft 35 -35 TAC Tactics 53 -53 CP Counter insurgency & 36 16 52 Police operations JC Jungle camp & field 240 64 304 Firing INT Intelligence & Security 27 27 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 5 9 OMDCI E. 1 2 One Minute Drills for CI Ops. TOTAL INDOOR SUBJECTS L Law And Manuals RR Rescue & Relief Operations FF Fire fighting IS VIP/Jail/ Airport security & Guarding of vital installations HR Human Rights PO Central Police & State Police organisations HF Hygiene & Sanitation,First Aid&AIDS OP Office procedure IN/OU INDOOR/OUTDOOR T-T WRITTEN Tests TOTAL 3 4 5 6 7 8 12 Grand Total 31 - 31 514 104 618 18 08 - 18 08 08 08 - 08 08 08 08 - 08 08 16 - 16 04 08 - 04 08 86 - 86 2040 192 2232 BLOCK SYLLABUS FOR JUNGLE CAMP TRG. S/N o Code SUBJECT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 PT MR Tac FC FE EXP FF Misc BI 10 SCE Endurance Training Map Reading & GPS Tactical Ops Field Craft Field Engineering Explosive Field firing Miscellaneous Battle inoculation TOTAL 7 days self contained exercise TOTAL NO. OF PERIOD ALLOTTED Day Night Total 12 08 20 18 14 32 70 20 90 16 06 22 13 00 13 06 00 06 18 00 18 16 00 16 11 00 11 180 48 228 During Day & 76 Night 240 64 304 6 DETAILED SYLLABUS FOR WEAPON SUBJECTS (1) 5.56 MM INSAS RIFLE (Code – INSAS) Sl Code Subject 1 INSAS-120 5.56 mm INSAS rif se waqfiat, kholna,jorna aur safai karne ka tariqa sikhana. 5.56 mm INSAS rif ke mag ko bharna,kahli karna , rif ko bharna ,ready make safe aur khali karne ka tariqa sikhana. Bhin bhin posn se 5.56 mm INSAS rif par mazboot pakar hasil karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56 mm INSAS rif se shisht lena aur fire karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56mm INSAS rif ki chaal, parne wali roken aur unhen dur karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56mm INSAS rif se shisht mein tabdili karna,shisht ki jagah chunna, hawa ka haq rakhte huye harkati tgt par POA chunne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56mm INSAS rif ki trigger mechanism ke bare mein jankari dena Total 2 INSAS21-40 3 INSAS41-58 4 INSAS59-76 5 INSAS77-96 6 INSAS97-116 7 INSAS116-127 L/D Pra c. Nig ht T ot al 2 0 4 14 2 4 14 2 2 0 4 14 - 1 8 4 14 - 4 14 2 1 8 2 0 4 14 2 2 0 4 7 - 1 1 28 91 8 1 2 7 (2) 5.56 MM INSAS LMG (Code – LMG-IN) Sl Code Subject 1 LMG-IN1-9 2 LMG-IN -10-18 3 LMG-IN 5.56 mm INSAS LMG ka bayan,visheshtayen, kholna,jorna aur safai karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56 mm INSAS LMG ke mag ko bharna,kahli karna ,lmg ko bharna ,ready make safe aur khali karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56 mm INSAS LMG se pakar, sisht L/D Nig ht To tal 2 Pr ac . 7 - 9 2 7 - 9 2 7 - 9 7 4 -19-27 LMG-IN -28-35 5 LMG-IN -36-45 6 LMG-IN46-53 aur fire karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56mm INSAS LMG ki chaal, parne wali roken aur unhen dur karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56mm INSAS LMG ko action ke dauran handling karne ka tariqa sikhana 5.56mm INSAS LMG ke upar istemal hone wale sighton ke bare mein jankari dena Total 2 7 - 9 2 7 - 9 2 6 - 8 12 41 - 53 (3) 7.62 SLR RIFLE (Code – SLR) S/ No. CODE 1 SLR-12 7.62 mm self loading rifle se waqfiat,safety,kolna ,jorna aur safai 2 SLR-34 SLR-56 SLR-78 SLR-912 Magazine bharna, sight lagana, rifle bharna aur khali karna Fire karna 3 4 5 SUBJECT PERIODS L/D Pr ac . 1 1 Rifle ki chal aur hone wali roken Tube launching MK-1 se waqfiat aur rifle grenade ko fire karne ka tariqe sikhana Total Ni gh t - To tal 2 1 1 - 2 1 1 - 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 - 4 6 6 - 12 (4) 7.62 MM LIGHT MACHINE GUN (Code –LMG) Sl Code Subject 1 7.62mm light machine gun se waqfiat, kholna, safai aur jorna Magazine ka bharna aur sight lagana Shist , pakar aur fire karna Chal aur roken 2 3 4 LMG-115 LMG16-30 LMG31-43 LMG- L/D 5 Pra c. 8 Nig ht 2 Tot al 15 5 8 2 15 5 8 - 13 5 9 2 16 8 5 6 44-59 LMG60-72 LMG73-87 Tripod 5 8 - 13 Fixed line 5 8 2 15 30 49 8 87 Total (5) 9 MM CARBINE MACHINE (Code - CM) Sl Code Subject 1 CM-1-7 2 CM -814 9mm carbine-viseshtaien, kholna, jorna aur safai Magazine ko bharna, carbine ko bharna, khali karna aur fire karna 3 CM 1522 4 CM-2334 L/D 1 Pra c. 4 Nig ht 2 Tot al 7 1 4 2 7 Turant upay aur rokon ko dur karna 1 5 2 8 CQB role mein carbine (IWT) 3 9 - 12 Total 6 22 6 34 (6) AKM (Code – AKM) Sl Code Subject 1 Rifle AK-47 se waqfiat, kholna, jorna aur safai ka tariqa AK-47 ke magazine bharna, rifle ka bharna, sight lagana, ready, fire, make safe aur khali karna. AK-47 Assault Rifle ki Chal , Roken aur Fouri ilaz Total 2 3 AKM-116 AKM17-31 AKM32-34 L/D 4 Pra c. 12 Nig ht 2 To tal 18 4 12 2 18 1 2 - 3 9 26 4 39 (8) 51 MM MORTAR (Code – MOR) Sl Code Subject 1 51 mm mor aur dial sight se waqfiat karana Mortor ka kholna jorna aur 2 MOR-14 MOR-5- L/D Pra c. Tot al - Ni gh t 2 2 2 4 2 8 4 9 3 4 12 MOR13-17 MOR18-25 5 MOR26-33 6 MOR34-39 safai Mor ke bombon ki pahchan, visheshtayen aur chal Bombon ko fire ke liye taiyar karna,bharna, khali karna fire aur misfire ka tariqa sikhana 51 mm Mor se direct aur indirect fire karne ka tariqa sikhana Mor det ka kam aur fire niyantran Total 2 3 - 5 2 4 2 8 2 4 2 8 2 4 - 6 12 19 8 39 Nig ht 2 Tot al 8 (9) NO. 36 H.E.GRENADE (Code – GN) Sl Code Subject 1 GN-1-8 2 2 3 GN-9-15 GN-1629 GN-3039 No.36 HE grenade ki pahchan aur istemal Grenade ko phainkna Grenade phainkna aur lobbing Tube launching MK-1 se waqfiat aur rifle grenade ko fire karne ka tariqe sikhana Pra c. 4 2 2 5 10 2 7 14 2 6 2 10 Total 8 25 6 39 2 Pra c. 4 Nig ht - Tota l 6 2 6 - 8 2 4 - 6 6 14 - 20 4 L/D (10) 9 MM PISTOL BROWNING (Code – PIS) Sl Code 1 2 3 PIS-1-3 Subject 9 mm pistol se waqfiat, kholna ,jorna aur safai karne ka tariqa sikhana PIS-4-6 9 mm pistol ke mag ko bharna, khali karna, pistol ko bharna,ready,make safe aur fire karne ka tariqa sikhana PIS-7-11 9mm Pistol ki chaal, parne wali roken aur unhen dur karne ka tariqa sikhana Total L/D 10 (15) TEAR SMOKE (Code – TS) Sl Code Subject 1 TS-1 2 TS-2 Tear smoke gas –ithiyas , kismain , range aur prayog Tearsmoke unit Tekanpur(gwalior) main banaye jane wale tear smoke gas munitions ke bare main jankari 3 TS- 3-4 4 5 6 TS-5-6 TS-7-8 TS-9 7 8 9 TS-10 TS-11 TS-1213 TS-1415 Tear smoke munitions –badal aur hawa ka asar Chamber test ki baremain jankari Tear smoke grenades ki chal Tear smoke gas ka sidhant aur istemal main dhianki baten Tear smoke munitions ka storage Tear smoke gas –karo , na karo Tear smoke respirators ki kismain Respirator drill-gas position aur sahi fitting Total 1 0 L/D 1 Pra c. - Nig ht - Tot al 1 1 - - 1 1 1 - 2 1 1 1 1 1 - - 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 - 1 1 2 1 1 - 2 10 05 - 15 (16) FIRING (Code – FIR) S/ No CODE SUBJECT 1 FIR-127 FIR28-45 FIR46-54 FIR55-98 FIR99-113 FIR114161 2 3 4 5 6 WEE K NO. MUS KETRY PERIODS ALLOTTED FOR DAY NIGH FIRING T FIRIN G 18 - TOT AL Miniature range firing INSAS short range firing A.K.M. firing 20 9 26 9 9 - 18 28 3 6 - 9 INSAS long range firing LMG short range firing LMG long range firing 30 10 18 16 44 33 6 9 - 15 36 5 27 16 48 27 11 7 8 9 FIR162170 FIR171183 FIR184196 Hand grenade firing 38 - 9 - 9 Carbine Machine firing 40 4 9 - 13 Pistol 9 MM firing 40 4 9 - 13 50 114 32 196 Total (17) ONE MINUTE DRILLS WITH WEAPONS (Code-OMD-W) S.N CODE SUBJECT L/ PRAC o. D . 1 2 3 4 5 6 OMD-W 14 OMD-W 58 OMD-W 912 OMD-W 13-16 OMD-W 17-20 OMD-W 21-25 Cleaning of firearms 1 3 TO TA L 4 Filling magazine with one hand 1 3 4 Gun and stealth 1 3 4 Preparing a Range for firearms practice Stress shooting 1 3 4 1 3 4 Safely taking and depositing firearms from armoury TOTAL 1 4 5 06 19 25 (18)BAYONET (Code – B) Sl Code Subject 1 BAY-15 BAY-611 BAY-1217 BAY-1829 Basic position aur karwaian BAY-1935 BAY-3638 2 3 4 5 6 L/D 1 Pra c. 4 Nig ht - To tal 5 Hamle ki karwaian 1 5 - 6 Hamle aur bachao ki karwaian 1 5 - 6 Bachao aur hamle ki mili jhuli karwaian 2 10 - 12 Tan shastr aur ani ghompna 1 5 - 6 Training stick 1 2 - 3 12 7 BAY-3942 Zati bachao 1 3 Total 4 - 42 (19) TEST (Code – WT-T) S/N o CODE SUBJECT 1 WT-T 118 Test TOTAL TRG. OF PERIODS L/D 18 Prac. - Total 18 Total 18 - 18 WEAPON DAY PDS. 670 NIGHT TOTA PDS. L 72 742 13 (1) 5.56 mm INSAS RIFLE(INSAS) INSAS 1-20 5.56 MM INSAS RIF SE WAQFIAT, KHOLNA,JORNA AUR SAFAI KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA HAI. 14 TARTIB S/N O (a) 1. (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (d) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan. (c) Bandoba st ki karwai. 5.56m m INSAS Rifle, mag, Assy Bag Ground sheet, Q1. 7.62 mm SLR ka kargar rg kitna hai? TIME Actua l Runnin g (e) (f) 01 01 01 02 REMARK S (g) Ustad nirikshan karne ka khud namuna den. 15 3. PAHUNC H Ans. 300 X. Q.2. 7.62 mm SLR ka sight radius kitna hai ? Ans. 553 mm. Ladai ki badalte haalat aur sena ki tarakki ke sath sath hamare hathiyaron mein bhi kafi badlav aya hai. Hamare desh ke vaigyanikon ne bhi halke aur lambe rg tak maar karne wala 5.56 mm INSAS Rif ka awishkar kiya hai. Is hathiyar ka poora poora faida uthane ke liye zaruri hai ki jawan iski khubiyon se bhali bhanti parichit ho taki wah is hathiyar ka bharpoor faida utha sake. 01 03 Pahunch sabaq se sambandhi t ho. 16 (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 4. UDDESH 5.56 mm INSAS Rif se waqfiyat, kholna,jorna aur safai karne ka tariqa sikhana hai. 01 04 Dohraya jaye. 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS Rif, As per Mag,, Bayonet, Accessory trg Bag, Chindi, Long Easel, aids. Black Board, Chalk, Duster aur Ground Sheet. 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag No-I. INSAS Rif ki visheshtayen aur tech data. Bhag No-II. Kholna, ,Hisse purzon ke naam, kaam, aur jorna . Bhag No-III. Accessories se jankari aur safai karne ka tariqa 01 06 BHAG NOI INSAS Rif ke Visheshtayen aur Technical Data. 08 14 NAMUNA (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (a) INSAS Rif SLR ke banspat 25% halki aur 70% recoil kam hai. (b) Kargar rg jaida hai. (c) INSAS Rif mein gren sight laga hai. (d) INSAS Rif, LMG, aur Carbine ke chaal wale purje aapas mein ek saman hain. (e) Iska bayonet multipurpose hai. (f) Isse hum single shot 17 aur three rds control burst fire karte hain. (g) Iska mag ardh pardarshi hai. (a) (b) Tech Data (a) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) Wazan (i) (ii) (iii) Khali Rif Khali Mag Khali Mag ke sath Rif (iv) Bhari Mag (v) Bhari Mag ke sath Rif (vi) Bayonet (vii) Bhari Mag aur Bayonet ke sath (b) Lambai (i) Rif (ii) Bayonet (iii) Bayonet ke (iv) sath Rif Barrel (c) Sight Radius (d) MV (e) Grooves (f) Penetration (g) Muzzle Energy (h) Recoil Energy (j) Rate of Fire (i) Normal (ii) Cont Burst (iii) Intense (iv) Cyclic - 3.6 Kg - 90 Gms - 3.69 Kg - 340 Gms - 3.94Kg - 305 Gms - 4.1Kgs - 960 mm 285 mm 1110 mm 464mm - 470mm 900mtr/sec - 6 (RH) 200mm - 3mm on 700M MSP - 1685J - 4.43J - 60 Rds/Min - 90 Rds/Min - 150 Rds/Min - 600-650 Rds/Min 18 (a) (b) (k) Amn (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 02 16 Pure class se abhyas karaya jaye. (i) Ball (ii) Tracer (iii) Blank (iv) HD Carts Trigger operation - 2.1 (l) kg (m) Body sheet matel 1mm moti Assy. (a) Muzzle Cover. (b) Bayonet.(Dagger, Saw, Screw Driver, Hammer, Bottle Opener, Wire Cutter) (c) Sling. (d) BFA. (e) TDLS. (f) PNS. Assy Bag ka Saman. (a) Muzzle Cover. (h) Bore Brush. (b) BFA. (j) Pull through. (c) Clearing Plug (k) Extractor (d) Patla Drift. (l) Helical Spring Inner. (e) Mota Drift. (m) Helical Spring Outer. (f) Chamber Brush. (n) Assy Bag. (g) Firing Pin. ABHYAS (a) (b) BHAG II Tech Data par abhyas karaya jaye. (c) Rif ko kholna , Hisse Purjon ke Naam aur Jorna. (d) (e) (f) (g) 19 NAMUNA (1) Rif kholne ke liye sabse pahle mag ko utaren, change lever ko ‘R’ ya ‘B’ par karen aur rif ko cock karen. (2) Bayonet catch ko dabate hue bayonet ko utaren. (3) Sling ko kholen. 08 24 (e) (f) (4) Dahine haath ki kalme wali anguli se retainer locking lever ko dabate hue anguthe se retainer ko aage karen aur receiver cover ko kholen. (5) Piston extension aur recoil spring ko bahar nikalen. (6) Piston extension se rotating bolt ko alag Karen. (7) Gas tube locking catch ko 900 mein khara karte hue gas tube ko alag karen. (8) Firing pin aur extractor kholne ke liye drift ki madad se pahle pin firing axis pin aur baad mein extractor axis pin ko kholen. (9) Mag ko kholne ke liye stud ko dabate hue bottom plate ko kholen aur spring ko nikalen. (a) (b) (c) INSAS Rif mote taur par 12 accessories ki bane hoti hai ;_ (d) (g) 20 1. Barrel assembly. (a) Flash eliminator. Paida hone wale shole ki teevrta ko kam karta hai aur gren projector ka bhi kaam karta hai. (b) Barrel. Goli ko sahi disha mein jaane mein madad karta hai. Ismein grooves aur land goli ko spin deta hai jisse goli ko sthirta milti hai. (c) Lug Bayonet. Bayonet ko fit karne ke kaam ata hai. (d) Gas Block and Plug Gas. Gas vent ke upar lagi poori accessory ko block gas kahte hain. Jisse gas cylinder mein dakhil hoti hai. (e) Gas Regulator, Gas Scape Hole. Gas regulator ki matra ko cont karta hai. Iski do posn hain. Low aur High. (f) Loop Front Sling. Sling lagane ke kaam ata hai. 2. Hand Guard. Yeh Rif ko pakrane ke kaam ata hai. Jisko cap ke dwara fit kiya jata hai. Iske andar ek reflector hota hai jo hand guard ko garam hone se bachata hai. 3. Cocking Handle Assembly. Rifle ko cock karne mein madad deta hai. Slide ke pichhle hisse laga hota hai. Iske purjon ke naam is prakar hain :- (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 21 (a) Cocking Handle. (b) Slide. (c) Plunger. (d) Pin. 4. Body Housing Assy. Yeh 1mm Sheet Metal ka bana hai. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) 5. Cover Assy. (a) (b) (c) 6. Hinges. Male Dovetail. Rear Sight Housing. Trigger Mech Assy. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (a) Left Channel Right Channel Safety Sear. Ejector. Spacer. Rear Block. Change Lever. TRB. Hammer. Trigger Sear. Auxillary Sear. 7. Pistol Grip Assy. 8. (c) Butt Assy. (b) (a) (b) (c) 9. (d) (e) (f) (g) Butt Plate. Butt Trap. Rear Sling Loop. Piston Extension Assy. (a) Piston. (b) Cam Way. (c) Stem. (d) Recoil Spring Housing. (e) Right Lug. (f) Bottom Surface. 10. Rotating Bolt Assy. 22 (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) Cam. Firing Pin. Locking Lug. Feed Piece. Extractor. 11. Recoil Spring Assy. (a) Stopper. (b) Guide. (c) Spring. (a) (b) 12. (c) Mag Assy. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (d) (e) (f) 02 26 10 36 (g) Lips. Platform. Bottom Plate. Dimpal. Retainer. Spring. Jorna. Jis sequence mein khola gaya hai thik uske viprit karwai karte huye joren. Akhir mein cock karke trigger press Karen. ABHYAS Class ka abhyas karaya jaye BHAG – III ACCESSORIES SE JANKARI AUR SAFAI KARNE KA TARIQA. NAMUNA INSAS RIF ke sath 06 prakar ki accessories di gaye hain :(a) Muzzal cover (b) BFA (c) Sling (d) Bayonet multi purpose (e) Day light telescopic sight (f) Passive night sight 23 1 (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) Day Light Telescopic Sight. (i) Wazan - 485 Gms (ii) Dia - 65mm (ii) Lambai - 255mm (iii) Field of View - 15 Degree (iv) Magnification -4X (v) Range - 400m (vi) Exit Pupil Dia - 6 mm (vii) Eye Clearance - 40 mm (viii) Objective - Refractive. (ix) Eye Piece - Fixed Focus Monocular Pattern. (x) Operating Temp - -40 degree to 55 degree (xi) Storage Temp - -40 degree to 70 degree Passive Night Sight. (i) Wazan 1.065 kg (ii) Lambai 281mm (II) Dia 70mm (iii) Field of View 10 Degree (iv) Magnification (c) - 24 -4X (v) - 300m (a) (b) Range detection (c) 11 (d) (e) (f) (g) (vi) Engagement - 200 mtr (vi) Exit Pupil Dia - 6 mm (vii) Eye Clearance - 22 mm (viii) Objective -. (ix) Eye Piece - Variable Monocular Pattern. (x) Operating Temp - -30 degree to 45 degree (xi) Storage Temp - -30 degree to 65 degree Safai ka saaman :(a) Chindi (b) Cleaning rod (c) Burush cleaning bore (d) Burush cleaning chember (e) Drift -2 (f) Tool removing reptured case (g) Tool adjusting fore sight and rear sight (h) Oil bottle Pullthrough Safai Karne ka Tariqa. Safai ke teen stage hote hain :(a) (b) Aam Safai. (i) Rojana ki safai. (ii) Weekly Safai. (iii) Monthly safai. Firing Ke Lihaj se. (i) Firing se Pahle. (ii) Firing ke Dauran. (iii) Firing ke baad. 25 (a) (b) (c) (c) Mausam ke Lihaj se. (i) (ii) (d) (e) (f) (g) High Alt. Desert. Lubrication. (a) 4 degree se above - OX 52. (b) 4 Degree se -18 Degree - OX –13. (c) -18 Degree se -40 Degree - OX 13 + Superior quality K/Oil 1:1. (d) -40 degree se -50 degree - OX 13 + Superior quality K/Oil 2:3 Chindi ka scale. (a) Safai ke liye - 4” x 1 ½ ” (b) Oil ke liye - 4x1 “ 7. ABHYAS Bhag-III ka abhyas karaya jaye. SANKSHEP Q1. INSAS Rif ki MV kitni hai ? Ans. 900m/sec. Q2. INSAS Rif ki safai ke liye chindi ka scale kya hai ? Ans. 4” x 1 ½”. 02 38 02 40 Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. ************************************************************************************ 26 INSAS 21-40 5.56 MM INSAS RIF KE MAG KO BHARNA,KAHLI KARNA , RIF KO BHARNA ,READY MAKE SAFE AUR KHALI KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA TARTIB S/N O (a) 1. (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (d) (d) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (e) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan. (f) Bandoba st ki karwai. 5.56m m INSAS Rifle, mag, Drill Carts, Assy Bag Ground sheet, 2. DOHRAI Q1. INSAS Rif ki MV kitni hai ? Ans. 900m/sec. Q2. INSAS Rif ki safai ke liye chindi ka scale kya hai ? Ans. 4” x 1 ½”. 3. PAHUNC 5.56mm INSAS TIME Actua l Runnin g (e) (f) REMARK S (g) 01 01 Nirikshan class se karwaya jae. 01 02 Pichhle lesson 01 03 Pahunch 27 H RIF jawan ka jati hathiyar hai. Is liye jawan ko kholna , jorna aur safai karna jan lena hi kafi nahi hai balki larai ke maidan mein Rif ka pura faida uthane ke liye Rif ko bharna aur khali karna ana chahiye Sath hi bhari Rif ko ek jagah se dusri jagah le jane ke liye make safe ki karwai bhi achhi tarah ani chahiye. sabaq se sambandhi t ho. 2 (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 4. UDDESH 5.56 mm INSAS Rif ke mag ko bharna,khali karna , Rif ko Bharna, Ready, Makesafe aur Khali Karne ka tariqa Sikhana Hai. 01 04 Dohraya jaye. 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS Rif, As per Mag,drill carts,accessory trg bag, chindi, long easel, aids. black board, chalk, duster aur ground sheet. 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag No-I. Mag ko bharna aur khali karna Bhag No-II. Sight lagana aur range hasil karna Bhag No-III. Rif ko bharna,ready,makesafe aur khali karna. 01 06 28 BHAG NOI MAG KO BHARNA AUR KHALI KARNA :- NAMUNA Amn ki Safai. Rounds ko len aur saaf kapre se round ko ek ek karke saaf Karen. Agar samay kam ho to kai roundon ko ek saath kapre mein lappet kar safai ki ja sakti hai, lekin dhyan rahe ki roundon ka aapas mein ragad nahin hona chahiye. Amn ko saaf karke kisi saaf jagah par rakhen. 10 16 (e) (f) Mag ka Bharna. Bharne se pahle mag ka mulahija karen. Agar mag ki body tuti ho ya lips tute hon to aise mag ko na bhara jaye. Dusre mag ko len aur isi tarah mulahija karen. Agar thik ho to bharne ke liye istemal karen. INSAS Rif ke mag ko bharne ka tariqa bhi SLR ke mag ki tarah hi hai. Iska mag fibre glass ka bana hone ki wajah se ismen 3 (a) (b) (c) rds bahar se hi dikhai dete hain. Ismen ham filler ka istemal nahin karte hain kyonki iske rds cortons mein band hokar aate hain. Mag ko len aur is prakar pakren ki mag ka chhota mehrab andar ki taraf aur bada mehrab bahar ki taraf ho. Mag ko ground sheet , boot ki toe ya raan par rakhte hue saaf kiye hue rds ko len aur dono haathon ki anguliyon aur anguthe ki (d) (g) 29 madad se ek ek rd bharen. Bharte samay agar koi rd niche gir jata hai to use aakhir mein saaf karke bharen. Is prakar ek mag mein 20 rds aate hain aur 20 hi bhare jate hain. Mag ko Khlai Karna. Mag ko len aur baen aur is prakar pakre ki haath ki char ungliyan upar se aur angutha andar se pakarte hue chhota mehrab zamin ki taraf ho. Kisi nukili cheej ki madad se rd ke bairkhilaf dabate huye mag ko khali Karen. Dhayan rahe agar rd ka istemal kiya jar aha ho to hare k ya do rd ke baad iski badli kar di jaye. Roundon ka girav saaf jagah par hona chahiye. Roundon ko saaf Karen aur cartoon mein band Karen. ABHYAS Mag ko bharna aur khali karna par abhyas karaya jaye. BHAG NO-2 SIGHT LAGANA AUR RANGE HASIL KARNA :Teen prakar ki sighting ki subhidha hai :(a) Open sight (b) Day light telescopic sight (c) Passive night sight 05 21 05 26 Pure class se abhyas karaya jaye. 4 (a) (b) (c) a) Open Sight. Open Sight ke hisse purje :(i) Fore Sight. Fore sight protractor. Fore sight tip, locking nut. (ii) Rear Sight (d) (e) (f) (g) 30 Housing rear sight, Lips, Rear sight apparture, leaf spring, screw axis, plunger Range Hasil Karna. Rear open sight par do lips bane hue hain. Pahle par 2 ka ank likha hai, jo 200m ke rg ko zahir karta hai. Dusre ke upar 4 ka ank likha hai jo 400 m ke rg ko zahir karta hai. 100m aur 300m ke rg hasil karne ki koi suvidha nahin hai. Abhyas BHAG-III NAMUNA Day light telescopic sight aur passive night sight ke bare mein aap ko pichhle lesson mein bataya gaya hai. Sight lagane par abhyas liya jai. Rif ko Bharna, Ready, Makesafe aur Khali Karna. Jab Rif par khali mag chadhi ho, chamber khali ho aur change lever ki posn ‘S’ par ho to rif khali mani jati hai. Jab bhari hui mag chadhi ho, chamber khali ho aur change lever ki posn ‘S’ par ho to Rif bhari hui mani jati hai. Jab Bhari mag chadhi ho, chamber mein rd ho, change lever ki posn ‘R’ ya ‘B’ par ho, kalmewali ungali trigger par ho to rif ko ready mana jata hai. 02 28 06 34 Bhar Posn. Bhar posn ke adesh par baen paon ko chalti halat mein aage len, dahine haath se rif ko badan kea age uchhalte huye taul wali jagah se pakren. Is posn mein dekhnewali baten. Dono paon kad ke mutabik khule huye hon, badan ka bojh dono paon ke upar, baen haath ki pakar forehand guard oar, dahine haath ki pakar pitol grip par, rif 31 (a) (b) (c) dahini bagal mein dabi hui. (d) (e) (f) (g) Bharne ke Hukam par Karwahi. Jab firer ko tgt dikhai de ya hukam mile bhar, to karwahi is prakar Karen. Change lever ki posn ‘S’ par Karen, mag catch ko dabate hue mag ko utaren aur pouch mein band Karen. Pouch se bhara mag len, mag ka mulahija karte hue mag way mein fit karen aur yakin Karen ki mag thik tariqe se lag gaya hai. Baen hath ki pakar fore hand guard par wapis le jaen. Ready. Jab firer fire karne ka irada rakhta ho ya hukam mile ready, is adesh par change lever ki posn ‘R’ ya ‘B’ par Karen, butt kandhe ka milap Karen, kalme wali anguli trigger ke upper rakhen 32 aur agle hukam intezar karen. ka Make Safe ki karwahi. Jab bhari hui rif ko ek jagah se dusri jagah par le jana ho to makesafe ki karwai ko amal mein laya jata hai. Karne ka tariqa. Sabse pahle kalme wali anguli ko trigger se bahar karen, rif ko kandhe se niche layen, rif ko dahine turn karte huye do baar cock Karen, durust shisht lete huye trigger ko press karen, rif ko kandhe se niche layen, change lever ki posn ko ‘S’ par Karen, pouch se bhari mag ko len, mag ka mulahija karte huye mag way mein dakhil Karen, yakin Karen ki mag thik baith gaya hai, kneeling posn akhtiyar Karen, eject huye rd ko len, saaf karke dusri mag (a) (b) (c) mein bharen. (d) (e) (f) (g) abhyas 04 38 Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. Q1. INSAS Rif ki mag mein kitne rds bhare jate hain? 02 40 Khali Karna. Khali kar ke aadesh par make safe ki tarah hi karwahi karte hain aur aakhiri mein khali mag chadha dete hain. ABHYAS 7. SANKSHEP Bhag-III ka karaya jaye. 33 Ans. 20 rds. Q2. INSAS Rif ke sath kitne prakar ki sighting system ki subhidha hai ? Ans. 03 prakar ki. INSAS 41-58 BHIN BHIN POSN SE 5.56 MM INSAS RIF PAR MAZBOOT PAKAR HASIL KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA 34 TARTIB S/N O (a) 1. (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (d) (g) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (h) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan. (i) Bandoba st ki karwai. 5.56m m INSAS Rifle, Mag, Drill Carts, FIG 11 Tgt, Bhinbhin prakar ki arh., Q1. Desert mein INSAS Rif ki mag mein kitne rds bhare jate hain ? A. 20 rounds. Q.2. Make safe aur khali kar mein kya antar hai. A. Make safe mein bhara mag aur khali kar mein khali mag chadhya jata hai. TIME Actua l Runnin g (e) (f) REMARK S (g) 01 01 Nirikshan class se karaya jaye. 01 02 Dohrai pahle lesson se ek ya do question puchhkar le sakte hain. 35 3. (a) PAHUNC H (b) Rif se kai posn se fire kiya jata hai lekin posn aisi honi chahiye ki aasani se ikhitihar kiya ja sake aur hathiyar par majboot pakar hasil ki ja sake. Ladai ke maidan mein kaun si posn ikhitihar ki jae yeh to zamin ki banawat aur kudrati sidhai par nirbhar karta hai. Isliye har ek jawan ko kudrati sidhai hasil karne ka tariqa pata hona chahiye. (c) 01 (d) 03 Pahunch sabaq se sambandhi t ho. (e) (f) (g) 4. UDDESH Bhin bhin position se 5.56 mm INSAS Rif par majboot pakar hasil karne ka tarika sikhana hai. 01 04 Do bar bataya jayega. 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS Rif, As per trg 01 Mag, Dill Carts, Fig aids. 11 Tgt, Ground Sheet, Sand Bag, Fire Trenches. 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag -I Lying Posn. Bhag -II Kneeling aur Sitting Posn. Bhag -III Standing Posn aur Fire Trench 06 01 Sabak ko tartibwar chalane ke liye. 36 ka Istemal. BHAG –I NAMUNA Lying posn.. Kisi bhi posn ki teen buniyadi usul hain. (i) Kudrati sidhai (ii) Bone support (iii) Relax muscles. Laying posn asani se akhtiyar ki jane wali aramdeh aur bunyadi posn hai. Is posn mein badan ka khaka chhota banta hai, jis se larai ke maidan mein nichi se nichi arh ke pichhe se dushman ki najar aur fire se bachte hue dushman ke upar kargar fire dal sakte hai. Rif, Mag, Drill Carts, Ground Sheet. 10 16 Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. Posn Lene ka Tariqa. Sabse pehle tgt ki sidh mein khare ho jae, chalti halat mein baen paon ko thora baen aur age len sath hi rifle ko baen hath par badan ke samne is prakar uchhalen ki barrel takriban 45 degree ke angle par ho, aur baen hath ki pakar hand guard par, iske bad daen hath se zamin ka sahara lete hue let jaen. Is posn mein dekhne wali baten:(a) (b) (c) (a) Flash eliminator zamin se upar ho. (b) Badan line of fire se tirchha ho. (c) Badan ke neeche koi (d) (e) (f) (g) 37 chubhne wali cheej na ho. (d) Taange kad ke mutabik khuli ho. (e) Ho sake adiyan zamin par baithi hue hon. Kudrati sidhai. Rif ko dahine rakhen aur baen haath ki kohni ko tab tak harkat den jab tak ki tgt, baen kohni, dahina kandha aur dahina paon ek seedh mein na aa jae. Ab dahini kohini ko us jagah par rakhen jahan par kohni dahine aur thora kandhe ke niche ho. Dono haathon ki hatheli ko thudi ke neeche lagakar aankhen band Karen aur badan ke tanav ko mahsoos Karen. Yadi badan mein tanav hai to kohni usi jagah rakhte hue badan ko aage peechhe karte hue tanav ko door Karen aur kohni ki jagah ko mark kar den. Rif, Mag, Drill Carts, Ground Sheet. Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. Durust Pakar. Rif ki pakar haasil karne ke liye kandhe mein le jaen. Baen haath ki kalme wali anguli aur anguthe ke beech jo ‘V’ banta hai wahan par rif ko rakhen. Hand guard niche wali hatheli apr aa jae. Charon angulian bahar se aur angutha andar se saath hi mag ko kalai ke saath hona chahiye. Mazboot pakar mein sharir ke bibhin angon ka ka kaam is prakar hai:- 38 (a) (b) (c) (ai) Bayan haath. Bayan haath Rif ko niche jane se rokta hai aur hand guard ke neeche support ka kaam karta hai. (b) Dahina haath. Dahine haath se piston grip se is prakar se pakren ki teenon anguliyan bahar se, angutha andar se aur kalme wali anguli trigger guard ke aar-paar.ho. Dahina haath Rif ko kandhe ki taraf khinch kar rakhta hai aur saath hi Rif ko majbooti se pakarne mein madad deta hai. (c) Kandha. Kandha butt ko jagah deta hai aur rif ko peechhe jaane se rokta hai. (d) Sir. Sir ko butt par is prakar rakhen ki gaal ka narm bhag butt par tike. Sir se butt ko na dabaen. Yeh posn butt par hamesh ek jagah aur ek jaisi honi chahiye. Eye relief 2” se 3” honi chahiye. (d) Rif, Mag, Drill Carts, Ground Sheet. (e) (f) (g) Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. Poori Pakar ko Majboot Karna. Poori pakar ko majboot karne ke liye baen kohni ke loose mans ko zamin par jamate hue thora aage push Karen , dahine kohini ke loose mans ko kaabu rakhne ke liye 39 kohini ko apni taraf khiche. Yadi rif upar point kar rahi ho to dahine hath ko aage Karen. Agar niche point kar rahi ho to dahine hath ko pichhe Karen. Agar baen point kar rahi ho to baen paon ko thora baen Karen aur agar dahine point kar rahi ho to dahine paon ko thora aage Karen. Khara hone ke liye rif ko baen haath se dahini bagal mein laen, saath hi baen paon ko close Karen. Dahine haath se zamin ko push karte hue khare ho jaen. (a) (b) (c) (d) Lying Supported Posn. Rg par pahle posn lete samay unsupported posn len uske baad hi unchai ke anusar arh lagayen. Support lagate samay dhyan rahe ki firer ki kudrati sidhai na bigde. Saath hi agar sp naram mitti ki hai to baen haath ki kalai ko sp ke saath lagaen. Agr sakht mitti ki hai to sp par hand guard ko rakha jae. Dhyan rahe Rif, Mag, ki sp ke saath mag na Drill lage. Carts, Ground Kohni ka support Sheet. (Bone Support). Yadi rif ko unsupport posn se zero kiya jae aur support ke sath fire kiya jae to goliyan nishane ki jagah se upar lagengi. Agar rif ko supported posn se (e) (f) (g) Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. 40 zero kiya jae aur unsupported posn se fire kiya jae to goliyan nishan ki jagah se neeche lagengi. Is liye Rif ko elbow support se zero karna chahiye, taki kisi bhi posn se fire karne par goliyan POA par lage. Pahle unsupported posn akhtiyar Karen uske baad kohni ke aage ek char inch unchi sand bag lagen. Jisse firer ko firing ke dauran kafi sthirta milti hai, lekin is posn mein bhi mag arh ke niche nahin lagna chahiye. ABHYAS (a) (b) BHAG-II NAMUNA Lying posn ka abhyas karaya jaye. (c) (d) Kneeling aur Sitting Posn Samtal aur apne samne uthi hui zamin ki satah par nikalne wale tgt par fire karne ke liye kneeling posn sabse achhi posn hai. Is posn se hathiyar ke line of fire ki unchain ko badla ja sakta hai. INSAS Rif, Mag, Kneeling Unsupported Ground Posn Kneeling posn Sheet. ikhtiyar karne ke liye 05 21 (e) (f) 05 26 Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. (g) Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. 41 tgt ki taraf face karen, baen paon ko tgt ke sidhai mein karen, saath hi rif age uchhlte hue baen hath mein tol wali jagah se pakren, muzzle age aur upar ki taraf ho, ab dahine ghutne ko kafi dahine rakhte hue dahine ghutne par baith jayen. Agar mumkin hi to badan ka bhok eri par tikayen. Baen kohni ko baen ghutne par is prakar rakho ki kohni ki haddi ghutne ki haddi se alag ho. Dhahine hath se pistol grip ko pakro aur butt ko dahine kande ke gadde mein jamao aur dahine kohni ko upar aur zamin ke samanantar rakhen aisa karne se butt ko kandhe mein jamane ke liye kafi jagah milegi. I Kneeling Supported Posn Kneeling supported posn ikhtiyar karne ke liye sabse pahle kneeling unsupported posn ikhtiyar karen. Ab itna aage harkat karen ki baen hath aur baen tang support ke saath mil jae. Rif ka koi bhi hissa support ke saath nahi lagna chahiye, nahi to firer ko jaldi jaldi POA badli karne mein dikkat hogi. 42 (a) (b) ABHYAS BHAG-III NAMUNA (c) Sitting Posn. Jab ki arh kneeling posn se chhota ho aur dhalwandar zamin par posn lena ho to aise mein sitting posn ka asani se istemal kar sakte hain. Dhalwandar zamin par posn lena ho to aise mein sitting posn lete samay eriyon ko zamin par jama diya jae jaisse badan ko sathirta mile. Posn is prakar len tgt ko dekhen, baen paon ko tgt ki seedh mein Karen, dahine paon ko dahine aur aage Karen. Baen hath se rifle pakren aur dahine hath se zamin par sahara lete hue baith jae, baen hath ki pakar ko durust Karen aur uske baad dahine anghutne ko dahine kohni ke niche Karen. Sitting Posn ka abhyas karaya jaye. Standing Posn aur Fire Trench ka Istemal. Standing posn se hum tgt par us waqt fire karte hai, jabki us tgt par kisi dusri posn se fire karna munasib na ho ya harkat ke dauran jab achanak tgt samne aye. Tabhi is posn ko istemal kiya jata hai. (d) (e) (f) INSAS Rif, Mag, Ground Sheet. (g) Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. 05 05 31 36 Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. 43 Standing Posn. Standing posn ikhtiyar karne ke liye tgt ki taraf face karo aadha dahine turn karen, saath hi rifle ko uchhalte hue baen hath se aise pakren, ki muzzle asman ki tarf aur butt chhati ke samne, paon kad ke mutabik khule hon. Butt ko dahine kandhe ke gadde mein tikaen. Baki pakar pahle ki tarah. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) Dahine kohni ko upar uthaen, taki kandhe mein butt ke liye achhi jagah bane aur rif ko mazbuti se pakara ja sake. Is prakar rif ka jiada se jiada wazan dahine hath par hoga, baen hath se rif ko baki posn ki tulana mein aage se pakaren. Aisa karne se rif ko sahara milega aur rif jiada nahin hilegi. Posn ko akhri taur par thik karne ke liye, paon ko us waqt tak harkat den jab tak ki kudrati taur par nishana na le sake. Standing in Fire Trench Morche mein khare hokar apni height ke anusar morche ko set karen, uske bad badan ke baye hisse ko morche ki agli diwar se lagayen. Dahine paon ko thora pichhe lete hue badan ko aage dhakelen. Donon kohniyan trench se bahar zamin par jama hua aur chest ke wazan se kohniyon ko dabakar rakhen. 44 Is posn mein hathiyar ki pakar aur support lying posn ki tarah hi hai. Wobble Area. Shist lete waqt, rif ki taraf ki harkat ki had ke beech jo ilaka banta hai, use wobble area kahte hain. Yeh harkat kudarti hai. Jisko puri tarah dur hanin kiya ja sakta hai. Jitna ziada rif ko sahara milega, uthna hi wobble area kam banega. Iske khilaf agar unsupported posn se fire kiya jaye to woubble area ziada banega, khas taur par us waqt jab standign posn se fire kiya jae. Firer ka trigger ke dabane par pura control hona chahiye. (a) 7. (b) ABHYAS (c) Bhag III ka abhyas class se karaya jaye. SANKSHEP Q1. INSAS Rif ko kitne posn se fire kiya jata hai ? Ans. Char posn se. Q2. Firing posn ke buniyadi usul kya hain ? Ans. Kudrati sidhai, bone support, relax muscle. (d) (e) (f) 02 38 02 40 (g) Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. ******************************************************************************** 45 INSAS 59-76 5.56 MM INSAS RIF SE SHISHT LENA AUR FIRE KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA S/N O (a) 1. TARTI B (b) SHURU TEACHING POINTS (c) (j) Class ki SHURU ginti groupon KA mein bant . KAM (k) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan. (l) Bandoba st ki karwai. TRG AIDS (d) TIME Actua l Runnin g (e) (f) 5.56mm 01 INSAS Rifle, Mag, Drill Carts, 1x1 Tgt, Aiming Box, Aiming Corrector , Tin Disc, Aiming Disc, Sabhi prakar ke bd, Ground Sheet. 01 REMARK S (g) Nirikshan class se karaya jaye. 46 2. (a) 3. 4. DOHRAI (b) PAHUNCH UDDESH Q1. Kisi bhi firing posn ke teen buniyadi baten kya hain ? A. Kudrati sidhai, Bone support aur Mans peshiyan tanav rahit. Q.2. Arh ka istemal karte samay dhyan mein rakhne wali baaten kya hain ? A. Mag hamesha arh ke peechhe hona chahiye. (c) Achook nishane baji ka dusra buniyadi ushul hai durust sist lena. Agar ek firer durust posn, pakar aur shist ke saath saath durust trigger operation ki karwahi bhi thik karta hai, to ek goli ek ek dushman ka mudda hasil kar sakta hai. Is liye har ek jawan ko shist lene ke saath saath sahi trigger operation ki karwahi achhi tarah se aani chahiye. 5.56 mm INSAS Rif se shist lena aur fire karne ka tarika sikhana hai. 01 (d) Dohrai pahle lesson se ek ya do question puchhkar le sakte hain. 02 (e) (f) 01 03 01 04 (g) Pahunch sabaq se sambandhit ho. Do bar bataya jayega. 47 5. SAMAN 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT 5.56 mm INSAS Rif, As per Mag, Dill Carts, 1X 1 trg Tgt, Aiming Rest, aids. Aiming Box, Aiming Disk, Shist ki galti ka board , Sight picture ka board, pencil, long easel, black board, chalk, duster Tin disk , Pointer aur sheet ground. Bhag -I Durust Shist lena. 01 05 01 06 Saman ko point karke batayenge. Sabak ko tartibwar chalane ke liye. Bhag -II Shist lete samay hone wali galtiyan aur shudharak exercise. Bhag -III Trigger operation. Bhag- IV Karna. (a) (b) BHAG –I NAMUNA (c) Fire (d) Durust Shist Lena. Jab ek firer apne aankh aur dimag ka sahi talmel karte hue apne hathiyar ke upar lagi hue sighton ka istemal karte hue shist ko POA par milata hai use shist lena kahte hain. Rif, Mag, Sight Shist ka kaida. Alignment Koi ek firing posn ko aur Sight ikhtihar karen, Rif ko Picture ka seedha aur majboot Model, pakren. Tgt ka khaka Ground (e) (f) 04 10 (g) Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. 48 apne dimag mein sheet. bithayen. Koi ek aankh band karen. Rear sight aperture ke beechon beech fore sight tip ki noke ko POA par milaen aur durust sight picture hasil karen. Trigger press karne se pahle nazar fore sight ki tip par layen. Is prakar jab ek firer durust shisht lene ki karwai karta hai to woh do baton ko amal mein lata hai :(a) Sight Alignment. Jab ek firer back sight aperture ke Madhya mein fore sight tip ko milata hai ,yani ki firer ki aankh, back sight aperture ka Madhya aur fore sight tip ko ek line mein milane ki karwahi ko sight alignment kahte hain. (b) Sight Picture Durust align ki gai sight ko POA par milane ke karwahi ko sight picture kahte hain, yani ki firer ki aankh, back sight aperture ka Madhya fore sight tip aur POA tak jo farziya line banti hai use sight picture kahte hain. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 49 ABHYAS Sawal jawab se abhyas karaya jaye. BHAG-II Shist Lete samay Hone Wali Galtiyan aur Sudharak Ex. NAMUNA Jab ek firer majboot pakar, durust shist aur sahi trigger operation ki karwai karke fire karta hai to bhi uski goliyan kabhi-kabhi POA se hat kar lagti hain. Is ka karan anya takniki karnon ke sath sath manav aankh ki khasusiyat bhi hai. Har insane ke aankh ki yeh kamjori hai ki aankh ek hi samay par do alag alag fasle par lage nishanon ko ek saath focus nahi kar sakti. Isko mahsoos karane ke liye class apne baen haath ke anguthe ko khara karen aur kisi ek nishan ko chune. Jab aap apni nigah kisi nishan par karte hain to aapko apna angutha dhundhla dikhai deta hai aur agar angutha par nigah jamate hain to nishan dhundhai dikhai deti hai. INSAS Rif, Ground Sheet, Sahi shist ka bd, Aiming Box, Aiming Corrector, Pencil, Rubber. 03 13 04 17 Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. Thik isi prakar agar jawan POA ko dekhne par jiada jor deta hai toh use fore sight tip dhundhli dikhai deti hai aur woh foresight tip ko apparture ke 50 Madhya mein na rakh pane ki galti kar jata hai, jise Sight Alignment ki galti kahte hain. Jab firer foresight tip ko dekhne mein jiada jor deta hai toh POA dhundhla dikhai deti hai, jisse woh sahi POA na chunne ki galti kar jata hai, jise Sight Picture ki galti kahte hain. (a) (b) (c) Ladai ke maidan mein agar ek jawan sight picture ki galti karta hai to goli tgt ko hit karti hai kyonki yah galti har ek rg par ek jaisi hai, lekin sight alignment ki galti karne par badhte hue rg ke saath-saath goli tgt ko bhi chhor sakti hai kyonki yeh galti badhte hue rg ke saath badhti hai. Isi liye sight alignment ki ahmiyat sight picture se jyada hai. (d) INSAS Rif, Ground Sheet, Sahi shist ka bd, Aiming Box, Aiming Corrector, Shudharak Ex. Sight Pencil, alignment ki galti karne Rubber. walr firer ko aiming box ex diya jata hai. Is ex mein firer short aiming rest ke peechhe posn leta hai. Muzzle end se 10m ki duri par Aiming box rakha jata hai. Box par lage safed kaagaz (6” x 6”) par firer shist leta hai aur coach aiming disk ko (e) (f) (g) Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. 51 paper par rakhta hai. Firer ke ishare ke mutabik coach aiming disk ko harkat deta hai. Jyon hi firer ki durust shist mil jaati hai to bah coach ko ishara karta hai to coach pencil se nishan laga deta hai. Yeh karwahi teen bar ki jati hai. Aisa karne par agar firer ka gp 6cm ka banta hai to uski sight alignment ki karwahi sahi hai. Aiming Corrector Ex. Sight picture ki galti karne wale firer ko aiming corrector ex diya jata hai. Is ex mein rif ke back sight ke peechhe aiming corrector lagaya jata hai aur firer ki shist ko check kiya jata hai. Zarurat suda correction dekar use thik karta hai. (a) (b) ABHYAS (c) Class se abhyas karaya jaye BHAG III Trigger Operation. Yeh Rif SLR ke banispat chhota aur halka hai. Is liye iska trigger dabate samay zaida cont ki zarurat padti hai. Is rif se teen rds cont burst fire kiya jata hai. Trigger dabane ka kaam kalme Rif, Mag, NAMUNA (d) (e) (f) 03 20 04 24 (g) Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. Namuna 52 wali anguli ka hai. Tin Disc, Anguli ka pehla aur Ground dusra jorke beech ki Sheet. jagah ko trigger ke upar rakhte hai. Trigger ke do khichav hai, halka aur sakht khichav. Pahla khichav hasil karne ke baad dusra khichav hasil karen. Trigger dabate samay barrel harkat nahin karni chahiye. Is prakar trigger par 2.1 kg ka dabav aane par trigger press ho jata hai. Jis prakar se trigger ko dabaya gaya hai usi prakar aram se trigger ko relayase bhi kiya jaye is karwai ko short relayase ki karwai kahte hain. bayan ke sath diya jaye. Galat trigger operation ki karwai karne wale firer ko Tin disk ex di jati hai. Firer lying posn ikhtiyar karne ke baad bhar aur ready ki karwai karta hai. Coach barrel ke upar tin disc rakhta hai aur firer se trigger press karne ko kahta hai. Firer dwara trigger press karne par agar tin disc nahi girta hai toh firer ke trigger operation ki karwai sahi mani jati hai. Yeh karwai bhi teen baar karai jati hai. Agar do baar tin disc nahi girta hai to trigger operation ki karwai sahi mani jati hai. 53 (a) (b) ABHYAS (c) Trigger operation ka abhyas karaya jaye. BHAG-IV Fire Karna. Alagalag halation mein nikalne wale tgts par kargar fire dalne ki kabliyat ke lihaj is Rif ko banaya gaya hai. Is rif se do kism ka fire kiya jata hai. NAMUNA (a) Single Shot. (b) Three rds cont burst. Single Shot Fire. Sahi posn ikhtiyar karen. Kudrati sidhai ko check karen. Rif ko bhar, ready aur sahi sight lagaen. Sahi sight alignment aur sight picture hasil karen. Dimagi taur par sharer ke un angon ko check karen jo rif ko hold karne mein madad karte hain. Jaise bayan hath, dahina hath, kandha aur sir. Ab saans ko normal halat mein chalne den. Back sight apparture ke madhya mein foresight tip ko rakhte huye POA par milayen, Fore sight tip 6 baje aur 12 baje ki line mein harkat karni chahiye. Trigger ke pahle khichav ko hasil karne ke baad kuchh samay (d) Rif, Mag, Drill Carts, Ground Sheet. (e) (f) 03 27 07 34 (g) Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. 54 ke liye saans ko roken aur trigger ke dusre khichav ko bhi hasil karen. Goli fire hone ke baad usi pakar, posn aur shist ko kayam rakhte hue fore sight tip ki movement ko check Karen. Foresight tip jahan point kar rahi hogi goli takriban usi jagah par lagi hogi. Ab saans ko chhor den aur maar ko pukaren. (a) (b) (c) Goli fire hone se maar pukarane tak ki karwai ko follow through kahte hain. Is prakar single shot mein ek minute mein 60 rds ke hisab se fire kiya jata hai. Stop. Fire karte samay tgt ilake mein koi jaandar vastu aa jaye ya trg ke dauran aadesh mile ‘stop’ to karwai is prakar karen. (a) Kalme wali anguli ko trigger se baahar nikale. (b) Rif ko kandhe se niche laen aur change lever ki posn ko ‘S’ par karen. (c) Iska mag ardh pardarshi hone ke karan mag ka yakin karne ki jarurat nahi padti. Agar mag khali hone wala hai to mag ki badli karen aur agle hukm ka intezar karen. Go On. (d) Rif, Mag, Drill Carts, Ground Sheet. (e) (f) (g) Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye. Agar tgt ilake se 55 jandar vastu hat jae ya trg ke dauran aadesh mile ‘GO ON’ to change lever ki posn ko pahle wali posn mein karen aur Rif ko fire mein shamil karen. Three Round Control Burst. Control burst fire mein ek baar trigger dabane se teen rds fire hote hain aur agla burst fire karne ke liye trigger ko relayase karne parta hai. Burst fire mein ‘Stop’ aur ‘Go on’ ki karwai single shot ki tarah hi hoti hai, ismen har ek rd ka follow through nahin kiya ja sakta hai. Cont burst fire mein ek minute mein 90 rds ke hisab se fire kar sakte hain. (a) 7. (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) ABHYAS. Class ka rifle ke upar fire karne ka abhyas liya jae. 04 38 Abhyas pure class se liya jaye. SANKSHEP Q. 1. Sight alignment aur sight picture mein kiski ahmiyat jyada hai ? Ans. Sight alignment ki ahmiyat jyada hai. 02 40 Pratyek bhag se ek sawal poochhna zaruri hai. Q. 2. Sight alignment aur sight picture ki galti ke liye kaun si ex di jati hai ? Ans. Aiming Box aur Aiming corrector ex. Q. 3. Follow through 56 se aap kya samjhte ho ? Ans. Goli fire hone se lekar maar pukarne tak ki karwai ko follow through kahte hain. INSAS 77-96 5.56mm INSAS RIF KI CHAAL, PARNE WALI ROKEN AUR UNHEN DUR KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA TARTIB S/NO 1. (a) (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. (d) Rif, Mag, Drill Carts, 1X1 Tgt, , Assy Bag, Black Bd, Chalk, Duster, Ground Sheet.. Q1. 300 m par tej daurte tgt ke liye kitne lead aage shist liya jata hai? A. 9 lead aage shist liya jata hai. TIME Actual Running (e) (f) 01 01 01 02 REMARKS (g) Nirikshan class se karwaya jae. Dohrai pahle lesson se ek ya do sawal puchhkar liya jaye. Q.2. Sight alignment aur sight picture mein kiski 57 ahmiyat jyada hai? A. Sight alignment ki ahmiyat jyada hai. (a) 3. (b) PAHUNCH (c) INSAS Rif gas ke dabav aur recoil spring ki takat se kaam karne wala hathiyar hai. Isse ham three rd cont burst fire bhi kar saskte hain. Lagatar firing se ismen chand ek roken par sakti hain, yadi har ek firer iski chal ke bare mein achhi tarah janta hai to ismen parne wali rokon ko aasani se door kar sakta hai. yeh tabhi sambhav hai ki yadi jawan ne achhi sikhlai hasil ki hue ho. 4. UDDESH 5. 6. (e) 01 (f) 03 (g) Pahunch sabaq se sambandhit ho. 5.56 mm INSAS Rif ki chaal , parne wali roken aur unhen dur karne ka tarika sikhana hai. 01 04 Do bar bataya jayega. SAMAN 5.56mm INSAS Rifle, As per mag drill carts, 1X1’ trg tgt, , accessory bag, aids. chal ka diagram, black bd, chalk duster aur ground sheet. 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. BHAGON Bhag -I 01 06 Sabak ko INSAS Rif (d) 58 MEIN BANT ki chaal. Bhag -II Parne wali roken aur unhen due karne ka tariqa. BHAG-I INSAS Rif ki Chaal. INSAS Rif ki chal 8 actionon mein poori hoti hai. Fire, Unlock, Extract, Cock, Eject, Feed, Load, Lock. NAMUNA (a) (b) tartibwar chalane ke liye. 20 (c) (d) Chal mein kaam karne wale hisse purjon ke naam:Change lever, Trigger, Hammer, Firing pin, Chamber wala rd, Gas vent, Gas plug, Gas cylinder, Piston extension, cam way, Locking lug, Barrel locking lug, Rotating bolt, Recoil spring, Barrel locking surface. 26 (e) (f) (g) INSAS ki Chal. Fire. Jab ek firer change lever ki posn ‘S’ se ‘R’ ya ‘B’ 59 par karke trigger press karta hai to hammer azad hokar firing pin retainer par chot marta hai jisse firing pin apne surakh se nikal kar rd ke primer par thokar marta hai aur rd fire ho jata hai. Ise fire ka action kahte hain. Unlock. Fire hue rd se paida hui gas bullet ko aage barrel mein dhakelti hai, jyon hi bullet gas vent ke paas se hokar gujrata hai kuchh gas, gas vent ke hole se cylinder mein dakhil ho jati hai. Cylinder mein dakhil gas piston head par dabav dalta hai, jisse piston extension peechhe ki harkat karta hai. Piston extension ke peechhe ki harkat ke dauran rotating bolt ka cam cam way mein dahine se baen itna ghumta hai ki rotating bolt ke locking lug barrel extension locking surface se alag ho jaten hai. Is karwai ko unlock ka action kahte hain. Extract. Unlock hone ke baad rotating bolt aur piston extension ek saath peechhe ki harkat karte hain, isi dauran extractor fired case ko apne munh mein pakar kar peechhe lata hai, is karwai ko extraction ki karwai kahte hain. (a) (b) (c) Cock. Chal wale purjon ki isi harkat jaari rahti hai. Isi douran piston extension ka (d) (e) (f) (g) 60 stem shuru shuru mein hammer ko thora niche dabata hai baad main piston extension ka bottom surface hammer ko pura niche daba deta hai, jisse safety sear ke nose ka milap hammer vent se ho jata hai. Is karwai ko cock ka action kehta hai. EJECT. Chal wale purje ki isi harkat ke dauran fired case ejector se se takrakar ejection slot ke raste dahine aur niche gir jata hai, Is karwai ko eject ki karwai kahte hain. FEED. Recoil spring apne housing mein sikur jata hai. Jab recoil spring apne tanao ko poora karta hai to piston extension ko age dhakelta hai. Is duran rotating bolt ke feed piece mag ke upar wale rd ko chamber mein dakhil kar deta hai. Is karwai ko Feed ki karwai kahte hain. LOAD. Extractor rd ke pende par sawar ho jata hai. Is karwai ko load ka action kahte hain. yahan par rotating bolt ki age ki harkat samapat ho jati hai lekin piston extension ki harkat baki rahti hai. Lock. Piston extension ki aage ki harkat jari rahti hai , Isi harkat ke dauran rotating bolt cam ki madad se cam way mein baen se dahine itna ghumta hai ki rotating bolt ke locking lug barrel extinsion locking surface ke saath lock ho jate hain. Is karwai ko lock ka action kahte hain. Lock hone ke baad bhi piston 61 extension ki kuchh harkat baki rahti hai. Jab piston apni aakhri harkat poora karta hai to piston extension ka nichla, pichhla aur dahina pehlu safety sear head par dabav dalta hai, jisse safety sear ki notch hammer vent se alag ho jati hai aur rif dubara fire ke liye taiyar ho jata hai. (a) (b) ABHYAS (c) Chal ka abhyas karaya jaye. BHAG-II PARNE WALI UNHEN DUR TARIQA. NAMUN A (d) (e) (f) 1 0 36 ROKEN AUR INSA KARNE KA S Rif, mag, clear Trigger dabane par Rif fire ing na kare ya fire karte-karte ruk plug, jae to karwai fauri ilaz ki karen . grou Karne ka tariqa, Sabse pahle nd kalmewali unguli ko trigger se Shee bahar karen. Rif ko cock karek t holding opening device ko lagayen. Rif ko kandhe se niche layen. Mag catch ko dabate huye mag ko utaren pouch mein 2 band karen. Pouch se bhari hui 5 mag ko len. Mag ka mulahija karte huye mag way mein dakhil karen. Yakin karen ki mag thik tarah se baith gaya hai. Butt kandhe ka milap karen. Rif ko fire mein shamil karen. Rif thik fire karega. Is prakar ek baar rif ko cock karne aur mag ki badli karne se teen prakar ki roken door hoti hain. Khali Mag, Misfire aur body mein atka hua round ya case. Fauri ilaz ki karwai karne (g) Abhyas pure class se karaya jae. Ustad class ko fouri ilaz ke bare mein tafsil mein batayega. 61 62 ke baad bhi rif fire na kaare ya fire karte karte purje aage hi ruk jae to iske do karan ho sakte hain. Sakhat khinchav ya gas ki kami ka rok. Rok ko pehchane, Kalmewali anguli ko trigger se bahar nikalen. Rif ko kandhe se niche laen. Rif ko neeche rakhen. Kneeling posn ikhtiyar karen. Rif ko uthayen. Baen haath ki pakar forehand guard par. Mag baen taraf aur ejection slot neeche ki taraf. Dahina ghutna poora dahine. Butt dahine ghutne ke saath laga hua. Dahina ghutna butt ko peechhe jane se rokta hai. Cocking handle ko khara karen. Dahine haath ki charon anguliyon ka huk banate hue rif ko cock karen. Yakin karen ki shakhat khinchav ki rok door ho gai hai. Shout karen shakhat khinchav ki rok door. Shakhat khinchav ki rok door. Dubara posn ikhtiyar karen. Butt kandhe ka milap karen. Rif ko fire mein shamil karen. Rif thik fire karega. (a) (b) (c) Sakhat khichav ki rok parne ke karan:(a) Chamber mein jyada gas jama hona. (b) Amn aur chamber ka jyada ganda hona. (d) (e) (f) (g) Fauri ilaz aur sakhat khincahv ki rok ko dur karne par bhi rif fire na kare ya ek ya do rds ke baad ruk jae to gas ki kami ka rok samajh kar karwai karen. Kalme wli anguli ko trigger se bahar nikalen. Rif ko kandhe se niche laen. Dahine turn karte hue rif ko 63 cock karen. Purjon ko aage jaane den. Change lever ki posn ‘S’ par karen. Rif ko dahine bagal mein laen. Gas regulator ki posn ka mulahija karen. Agar gas regulator ki posn low par ho to kisi saaf kapre ya chindi ki madad se low se high par karen. Shouting karen low se high par kiya. Low se high par kiya. Dhyan rahe hath barrel ke sath touch nahi hona chahiye. Yadi gas regulaon ki posn pahle hi high par ho to gren sight ko 60 degree ke angle par khara karen. Patle wali drift ki madad se gas vent aur gas plug ke hole ki safai karen. Gren sight ko poora niche bitha den. Gas regulator ki posn ko kapre ya chindi ki madad se high se low par karen. Shouting karen high se low par kiya. High se low par kiya. Change lever ki posn ko pahlewali posn par karen. Rif ko kandhe par le jaen durust shist len aur fire karen rif thik fire karega. Gas ki kami ki rok parne ke kaaran. Gas ka jiada fouling hone se gas vent ya gas plug ke hole ka band ho jana. Fauri ilaz,sakhat khinchav aur gas ki kami ka rok dur karne par bhi rif fire na kare ya fire karte purjon mein alag se awaj aaye to body aur chember ki rok samajh kar karwai karen. Kalme wali anguli trigger se bahar nikalen. Rif ko kandhe se neeche layen. Mag catch ko dabate huye mag ko utaren. Rif ko 64 (a) (b) cock karen. Purjon ko aage jane den. Rif ko khol den. Firing pin aur extractor ka mulahiza karen. Yadi tute hue hon to unki badli karen. Abhi ke liye firing pin extractor thik, toh ho sakta hai chamber mein kata hua case. Donon haathon se pistol grip se rif ko pakren aur rifle ko (c) jisam se aage karte hue chamber ka mulahiza karen. Dekhne mein aaya chamber mein kata hua case toh rif ko jor den. Rif ko cock karen aur HOD ko lagaen. Clearing plug ko len. Clearing plug ke teen bade hisse purje Base, Sleeve aur center pin. Base aur center pin ko tight karen, chamber mein dakhil karen. Purjon ko aage jaane den. Rifle ko cock karen aur HOD lagayen. Yakin karen ki kata hua case clearing plug ke sath bahar aa gaya hai. Pehla mauka milte hi unscrew karen. Bhari hui mag ko len aur mag ka mulahija karte huye mag way mein fit karen. Yakin karen ki mag thik lag gaya hai. Purjon ko aage jaane den. Rifle ko kandhe mein le jaen durust shist len aur fire karen, rif thik fire karega. Chamber mein case katne ke kaaran:- (d) (e) (f) (g) (a) Chamber ka jayda garam ho jana. (b) Cartridge case ke metal ka kamjor hona. Kabhi-kabhi clearing plug 65 ABHYAS (a) 7. (b) SANKSHEP ke saath kata hua case bahar nahi aata hai iske Iske chand ek karan hain. (a) Base aur centre pin ka thik kasa na hona. (b) Centre sleeve ka ulta jura hona (c) Centre sleeve aur pin ke head ka ghis jana (d) Kisi purje ka tut jana. Abhi hoga abhyas , abhyas ke liye aadesh is prakar honge Rif thik fire karta rukata ke aadesh par aap fauri ilaz ki karwai karenge Munasib rok milne par rok ko dur karenge Rif thik fire karta cock nahi ke aadesh par sakhat khinchav ke rok ko dur karenge Rif thik fire karta ek ya do rd ke baad rukta ke aadesh par gas ki kami ka rok dur karenge aur rif thik fire karta fire nahi ke aadesh par body aur chember ke rok ko dur karenge. (c) Q1. INSAS Rif ki chal kitne action meinpuri hoti hai ? Ans. 08 action mein. Q2. Fouri ilaj se kitne prakar ki roken dur hoti hai ? Ans. Teen prakar ki. Q3. Gas ki kami ki rok parne ke kya karan hain ? Ans. Gas ka jiada fouling hone se gas vent ya gas plug hole ka band ho jana. Q4. Chamber mein case 17 (d) 78 (e) (f) 02 80 (g) 66 katne ke kya karan hai ? Ans. Chamber ka jiada garam hona, rd ke metal ka kamjor hona. ************************************************************************************ INSAS 97-116 5.56MM INSAS RIF SE SHISHT MEIN TABDILI KARNA, SHISHT KI JAGAH CHUNNA, HAWA KA HAQ RAKHTE HUYE HARKATI TGT PAR POA CHUNNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA TARTIB S/NO 1. (a) (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. (d) Rif, Mag, Drill Carts, Fig 11 Tgt, Long Aiming Rest, Sabhi prakar ke bd. Q1. Line of sight kise kehte hai. A. Firer ki ankh aprature ke bicho bich fore sight tip se POA tak jo farzia line banti hai use line of sight kehte hai. Q.2. Goli ki udar par asar dalne wali kon TIME Actual Running (e) (f) 01 01 01 02 REMARKS (g) Nirikshan class se karwaya jae. Dohrai pahle lesson se ek ya do sawal puchhkar le sakte hain. 67 kaun kaun si baten hai? A. Zamin ki banawat aur hawa. (a) 3. (b) PAHUNCH (c) Larai ke maidan mein shayad hi ek jawan ko itna mauka mile ki who hatiyar ki sight par tgt ki sahi range laga kar us par kargar fire dal sake. Us halat mein tgt bhi chal raha ho ya hawa bhi chal rahi hogi is liye jaruri hai ki weh harkti tgt par POA chun kar kargar fire dal sake yeh tabhi ho sakta hai jab ek frier sighton mein tabdili karna , shist ki jagah chunna aur hawa ka hak rajhte hue POA chun sake. (d) (e) (f) (g) 01 03 Pahunch sabaq se sambandhit ho. 4. UDDESH 5.56 mm INSAS Rif ki shist mein tabdili karna, shist ki jagah chunna, hawa ka hak rakhte hue harkti tgt par POA chunne ka triqa sikhana hai 01 04 Do bar bataya jayega. 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS Rif, As per mag, Dill carts, fig 11 trg tgt, long Aiming rest, aids. Sahi Shist ki board, hawa ki lead table, tgt 01 05 Saman ko point karke bataya jaye. 68 ki lead table, shist ki vyavsthith bidu ki board , long easel, black board, chalk, duster, Pointer aur sheet ground. 6. (a) BHAGON MEIN BANT (b) BHAG –I NAMUNA Bhag -I Shist mein tabdili karna. Bhag -II Shist ki jagah chunna. Bhag -III Harkti tgt par POA chunna. Bhag- IV Hawa ka fire par asar. (c) 01 (d) Shist mein Tabdili Karna. Jab ek firer apne hathiyar par tgt ka sahi range laga kar fire karta hai to uski golian Rif, Mag, POA par lagti hain. Trajectory Agar ground range Bd. kam aur sight range ziada ho to golian POA se upar lagti hain. Agar sight range kam ho aur ground range ziada ho to Golian POA se niche lagti hai. Yeh kitna upar ya niche lagti hai yeh hathiyar par lage range aur tgt ke fasle par nirbhar karta hai. Alag alag range par goli kitna upar ya niche lagti hai yeh aap trajectory board 06 (e) (f) 04 10 Sabak ko tartibwar chalane ke liye. (g) Bayan ke sath samjhayen. 69 ki madad samajhen. se Isse yah saf jahir hota hai ki agar tgt 300m par hai aur sight par 200m rg laga hai to firer ko shisht thora upar lena chahiye aur agar sigth rg 400m hai aur tgt 300m par hai to shist thora niche lena chahiye taki goli tgt ke centre mein lage. ABHYAS Class se abhyas liya jaye BHAG-II Shist ki Jagah Chunna. INSAS rif ko is prakar zero kiya jata hai ki 200m par goli nishane ki jagah par lage. Is tarah 100m se zero ki gai rif se jab ham 30.5m rg par fire karte hain toh goli 12.5mm shist ki jagah se upar lagti hai. Is lie 200m se kam rg ke tgt ko engage karne ke liye shist tgt ke madhaya se thora niche aur 200m se jaida ke liye shist madhaya se thora upar lena chahiye. Is prakar shist lekar 200m se kaam rg par nikalte tgt ko engage karne ke liye do bare faide hain :4 NAMUNA INSAS Rif, Long Aiming Rest, Fig 11 tgt, Shisht ka bd. 06 16 Sawal jawab se. 04 20 Ustad class ko tgt par POA ki jagah baten 70 (a) (b) ABHYAS BHAG III NAMUNA (c) (a) Agar goli zamin par takra kar ricochet hota hai to tgt hit ho sakta hai. (b) Firer mar ko dekh kar dusri goli se correction dekar tgt brabad kar sakta hai. Class se abhyas liya jaye. (d) (e) (f) (g) 0 5 2 5 Sawal jawab se. 4 5 Black Bd ki madad se samjhaye n. Harkati Tgt par POA Chunna. Harkati tgt ko hit karne ke liye zaruri hai ki shist age liya jae. Kitna age shist lena hai yani kitna lead lena hai tgt ke rg aur tgt ki rafter par nirbhar karta hai. Firing Black 2 ke lihaz se tgt ki teen Bd, 0 rafter mani gai hain :Chalk Duste (a) Chalta tgt. r, (b) Daurta tgt. Lead (c) Tej daurta tgt. Table ka Bd. Teenon kisam ke tgt par badali rg mein lead bhi badalti hai. Kitne rg par kis kisam ke tgt par kitna lead liye jayega yah tgt ki speed aur bullet ke time of flight par nirbhar karta hai. Is ko madhaya nazar rakhte hue sikhlai ko asan karne ke liye mote taur par lead table is prakar se hai :Lead = Range x Stage 100 71 5 (a) Range/ Tgt ki Stag 100 M 200 M 300 M 400 M (b) ABHYAS BHAG-IV NAMUNA Chalta Daurta Tgt 01 02 02 04 03 06 04 08 (c) Class se abhyas karaya jaye. (d) Tej Daurta Tgt 03 06 09 12 (e) (f) 15 60 (g) Class ko sawal dekar abhyas karayen. Hawa ka Fire par Asar. Firing ke lihaj se hawa ki teen kisme hoti hai :(a) Halki Hawa. Jis hawa ke chalne se chhoti jharion ki paihiti aur stop butt par lega flag 22-23 degree ke angle par lahrati hai us ko halki hawa kahte hai. Black bd, Chalk duster 10 70 Ustad black bd par ek question nikal kar bataye (b) Tej Hawa. Jis hawa ke chalne se pedon ki chhoti tahniyan hil rahi hon, hawa ko chehre par mahshoosh kiya ja raha ho ya stop butt par laga flag 45 degree ke angle par lahra raha ho use Tej hawa kahte hai. (c) Bahut Tej Hawa. Jis hawa ke chalne se bari bari tahniya hil rahi hon, dhul aur garda urh raha ho ya stop butt par laga flag 90 degree ke angle par lahra raha ho use Bahut Tej hawa kahte hai. Jo hawa 3 se 9 baje ki 72 line mein chalti hai use cross wind kahte hain. Jo hawa 11 se 5 aur 1 se 7 baje ki line mein chalti hai us ko tirchhi hawa kahte hain. Tirchi hawa ke liye hawa ke lead se ek lead kam kar diya jata hai. Sikhlai ko asan karne ke liye mote taur par alag alag rg par alag alag hawa ke liye lead table is prakar se hai :6 (a) 7. (b) Hawa ka Lead ABHYAS Class se abhyas karaya jaye. SANKSHEP Q. 1. Firing ke lihaj se hawa ki kitni kismen hoti hai ? Ans. Teen, Halki, Tej hawa aur bahut tej hawa. Q. 2. 400m ragne par tgt tej daurta hai us ke liye kinte POA lenge ? Ans. 12 POA tgt ke age. (d) (e) (f) 0 8 7 8 0 2 8 0 (g) Class ko sawal dekar abhyas karayen. Pratyek bhag se ek sawal poochhn a zaruri hai. Q. 3. 200m se kam niklne wale tgt par shist ki jagah 73 Range 100 200 300 400 Halki Tej Hawa Hawa 01 01 02 02 03 kaha hai ? Ans. 200m se kam ragne par niklne wale tgt ke shist niche liye jati hai. M M M M Bahut Tej Hawa 02 03 04 ****************************************************************** INSAS 116-127 5.56mm INSAS RIF KI TRIGGER MECHANISM KE BARE MEIN JANKARI DENA TARTIB S/NO 1. (a) (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. (d) 5.56mm INSAS Rifle, TRB model, ground sheet. Q1. Fauri ilaz se kaun kaun se rokon ko dur kar sakte hain? A. Khali mag, Misfire aur Body mein atka hua rd ya case. Q.2. Chamber mein case katne ka kya kaaran hain ? TIME REMARKS Actual Running (e) (f) (g) 01 01 Nirikshan class se karwaya jae. 01 02 Dohrai pahle lesson se ek ya do question puchhkar le sakte hain. 74 A. Chamber ka jaida garam hona. (ii) Carts case ke metal ka kamjor hona. 3. PAHUNCH INSAS Rif se single shot aur three rd cont burst fire karne ki suvidha di gai hai. Is liye zaruri hai ki har firer iske trigger mechanism ke bare mein achhi jankari rakhe takih samay parne par ise asani se istemal mein laya ja sake. 01 03 Pahunch sabaq se sambandhit ho. 2 (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 4. UDDESH 5.56 mm INSAS Rif ke trigger mechanism ke bare mein jaankari dena hai. 01 04 Do bar bataya jayega. 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS Rif, TRB As per ka model, black board, trg chalk, duster, pointer aur aids. sheet ground. 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag -I Trigger mechanism aur TRB box ko kholna, naam, kaam 01 06 Sabak ko tartibwar chalane ke liye. 75 aur jorna. Bhag -II TRB ki chaal. BHAG-I NAMUNA Trigger Mechanism ko Kholna, Naam, Kaam aur Jorna. (a) Change Lever. Stem, Right Lug, Left Lug, Rib. 10 16 (b) Trigger Sear. Trigger, Trigger Sear Head, Claw, Neck. (c) Auxillary Sear. Head, Claw, Arm. (d) Hammer. Hammer, Hammer spring, Platform, Pawl, Pawl Spring. (e) Trigger Axis Pin. (f) Hammer Axis Pin. 3 (a) (b) (c) Change lever ki posn ‘S’ par. Jab change lever ki posn ‘S’ par hoti hai to stem ka dahina wala lug trigger sear par sawar hota hai. Jab trigger ko dabate hain to trigger nahin dabta hai kyonki trigger sear tail ko stem ka lug upar nahin uthane deta. (d) (e) (f) (g) Change Lever ki Posn ‘R’ par. Jab changer lever ki posn ‘R’ par hoti hai to stem ka dahina lug aage ki posn mein para rookh mein hota hai jisse trigger sear tail ko upar uthane ke liya jagah mil jata hai. Jab trigger ko dabaya jata hai to trigger sear thora aage aur niche dabta hai. Trigger sear aur auxillary sear ke ek hi axis 76 pin par hone ke karan is dauran auxillary sear apni jagah se aage aa jata hai. Trigger sear ke aage dabne se hammer platform aur trigger sear ka milap tut jata hai aur hammer spring ki takat se aage ki taraf harkat karta hai aur rd fire ho jata hai. Gas ke dabav se purje peechhe ate hain, saath hi hammer bhi peechhe aata hai. Trigger par dabav hone ke karan trigger sear hammer ko nahi pakar pata lekin auxillary sear hammer ko pakar leta hai, jisse ek roubd fire hokar ruk jata hai. Agla round tab tak fire nahi hoga jab tak trigger ko relayase karke dubara na dabaya jaye. Jab trigger ko relayase kiya jata hai to auxillary sear peechhe jata hai aur trigger sear upar ki taraf aata hai. Is dauran auxillary sear hammer ko chhor deta hai aur trigger sear use pakar leta hai. ABHYAS Trigger mechanism abhyas liya jaye. ke upar 08 24 Sawal jawab se. 4 (a) (b) BHAG-II NAMUNA TRB ki Chal. purje. (c) TRB ke hisse (d) (e) (f) (g) (a) TRB Box. (b) Axis Pin. (c) Plate Selector aur Plate selector ka agla projection. (d) Ratchet Wheel. (Pichhla aur upar wala projection, pichhla aur neece wala projection). (e) Ratchet Wheel Spring. 77 (f) Tripping Plate ya Ratchet Plate. (Tail, Neechla projection aur upr wala projection). 10 34 Jab change lever ki posn ko B par kiya jata hai to change lever stem ka baen wala lug plate selector ko neeche daba deta hai, jisse plate selector aage se upar uthta hai. Is daural plate selecotr ka agla projection ratchet wheel ko thora upar utha deta hai, jisse ratchet wheel pawl ki sidh mein aa jata hai. Jab trigger ko dabaya jata hai to hammer trigger sear se azad ho jata hai aur firing pin ke peechhe wale hisse par chot marta hai aur round fire ho jata hai. Is dauran pawl ratchet wheel ke upar wale daant mein phans jata hai aur ratchet wheel ko thora upar utha deta hai. Isi samay ratchet wheel ka pichhla aur nichla projection auxiliary sear arm ke upar dabav dalta hai aur auxillary sear ko apni jagah se peechhe dhakel deta hai. Jab purje peechhe ki harkat karte hain to trigger ke upar dabav hone ke karan trigger sear se hammer ka milap nahi hota hai, sath hi auxillary sear ke peechhe hone ke karan hammer ka milap auxillary sear se bhi nahi hota hai aur hammer aage chala jata hai, jisse dusra round fire ho jata hai. Is samay ratchet wheel ka dusra daant pawl ke saath phans jata hai aur ratchet wheel ko aur upar utha deta hai. Isi dauran ratchet wheel ka pichhla aur upar wala projection auxiliary sear ke arm par dabav dal deta hai, jisse auxillary sear apni jagah se aur pichhe dab (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 78 jata hai. Karwai hu-ba-hu pahle round ki tarah hoti hai. Jab hammer pichhe ata hai to na to trigger sear pakar pata hai aur na hi auxillary sear. Hammer age ki harkat karta hai aur teesra round fire ho jata hai. Is dauran pawl ratchet wheel ke teesre dant mein phans jata hai, jisse ratchet wheel aage se poora upar uth jata hai. Jab ratchet wheel poora upar uthta hai to uska peechhla hissa neche jata hai. Is dauran ratchet wheel ka peechhla hissa ratchet plate ke neechle projection par dabav dalta hai, jisse ratchet plate neeche jata hai aur ratchet plate ka tail auxillary sear arm ke upar dabav dal deta hai. Yeh karwai us samay ki hoti hai jab teesra round fire ho gaya ho aur chal wale purje aage hi hon. Jab chal wale purje peechhe harkat karte hain to pawl ka milap ratchet wheel ke dant se tut jata hai. Ratchet wheel apne spring ki takat se apni normal posn mein jata hai. Is karwai ke dauran ratchet wheel ratchet plate ke upar wale projection ki madad se use upar utha deta hai, jisse auxillary sear arm ke arm se dabav hat jata hai aur auxillary sear apni normal posn mein aa jata hai. Jyonhi hammer peechhe ata hai auxillary sear pakar leta hai aur teen round fire hone ke baad fire band ho jata hai. Ab agla round tab tak fire nahi hoga jab tak trigger ko relayase karke dubara na dabaya jaye. ABHYAS Class se chal ka abhyas karaya jaye. 04 38 Pure class se. 79 7. SANKSHEP Sawal aur jawab se. Sabhi bhagon se ek ya do sawal puchh kar. 02 40 Sawal aur jawab se. ************************************************************************************* ************************************************************************************* ********************************************************************************** (2) 5.56 mm INSAS LMG (LMG-IN) LMG-IN 1-9 5.56 mm INSAS LMG KA AAM BAYAN,VISHESHTAYEN, KHOLNA,JORNA AUR SAFAI KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA 80 TARTIB S/N O (a) 1. (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. (d) LMG,Mag,Saf ai ka Saman, Monopod, Black Board, Easel. Q1 7.62 mm LMG ka kargar range kya hai? Ans :500x. TIME Actua l REMARKS Runnin g (e) 01 (f) 01 (g) Nirakshan ka tqriqa class ko bataya jae. 01 02 Chale hue class se. Q2. 7.62 mm LMG ka muzzle velocity kitni hai? Ans;2700m/sec . 81 3. PAHUNC H 5.56 mm INSAS LMG, INSAS pariwar ka ek kafi accha aur lambe range tak mar karne wala ek matra automatic hathiyar hai. Isse larai ke dauran mein bahut kamyabi hansil kar sakte hai. Is lie inf sec ke har LMG gp ko is ki khubian aur maintenanc e ke bare mein puri tarah se jankari honi chahiye taki zarurat parne par is se bharpur faida uthaya ja saken. 01 03 Lesson se sambandh it ho. 2 (a) 4. (b) UDDESH (c) 5.56 mm INSAS LMG KA AAM BAYAN,VISHESHTAYEN, KHOLNA, JORNA AUR SAFAI (d) (e) 01 (f) (g) Dohraya 04 jae. 82 KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA HAI. 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS LMG, Mag, Siling, Assy Bag, Monopod, Sand Bag, Safai ka Saman, Ground sheet. 01 05 Point karke bataya jai. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag -I INSAS LMG ki Visheshtayen aur Tech Data. Bhag -II LMG ko Kholna, Hisse Purjon ke Naam, Kaam aur jorna 01 06 Class ko asani se sikhane ke liiye. 05 11 Bhag III Accessories se jankari aur safai karne ka tariqa. BHAG-I NAMUNA INSAS LMG ki Visheshtayen aur Tech Data. (a) Halka Hathiyar - 7.62 mm LMG se 30% halka hai. (b) Recoil Kam – 70% recoil kam ke karan Accuracy achhi hai. (c) Jyada MV – Trajectory chapti banti hai aur tgt par hit probility jyada hai. (d) Lamba range – Jyada muzzle velocity ke karan kargar range bhi jyada hai. (e) Auto Fire – Yeh hathiyar auto mode par bhi bhari tadad mein fire kar sakta hain. (f) Accurate – Achha ballistics, kam recoil aur sight systemhone ke karan kafi accurate hai. (g) Lethality – Achhi ballistic hone ke karan bullet ko achhi stability milti hai aur lethality jyada hai. 3 83 (a) (b) Wazan (c) (d) (a) LMG without mag (e) (f) (g) 6.23 Kg 0.11 Kg 0.50 Kg 0.75 Kg 6.73 Kg (b) Khali mag (c) Bhari mag (d) Bipod ka wazan (e) Bhari LMG (f) Lambai (i) Fixed butt 1050 mm 535 mm - 475 mm (ii) Barrel (g) Sight Radius (h) Chaurai (i) Bipod extended ( Low posn) – 241 mm (ii) Bipod extended ( High posn) – 318 mm (j) Grooves - 04 (RH) (k) MV - 925 m/s (l) Penetration - 03 mm on 700m (m) Rate of fire (i) Single Shot - 60 rds/min. (ii) Automatic 150 rds/min. (iii) Cyclic rate of fire 600-650 rds/min. (n) Amn. Ball, Trace, Blank. (o) Range 700m 4 84 (a) (b) ABHYAS (c) Bhag-I ka abhyas karaya jaye. BHAG-II Kholna, Hisse Purjon Naam, Kaam aur Jorna . (d) (e) 05 (f) 16 05 21 (g) Sawal aur jawab se. ke Sabse pahle mag ko utaren, cock Karen, cover assy ko kholen, piston extension assy ko nikalen, rotating bolt ko alag karen, gas tube ko kholen, firing pin, extractor, mag ke plate form ko bhi khol sakte hai. Hisse Purjon ke Naam. INSAS LMG 13 assy ka bana hua hai. 1. Barrel assembly. (a) Flash eliminator. Paida hone wale shole ki teevrta ko kam karta hai aur gren projector ka bhi kaam karta hai. (b) Barrel. Goli ko sahi disha mein jaane mein madad karta hai. Ismein grooves aur land goli ko spin deta hai jisse goli ko sthirta milti hai. (c) Gas Block and Plug Gas. Gas vent ke upar lagi poori accessory ko block gas kahte hain. Jisse gas cylinder mein dakhil hoti hai. (d) Gas Regulator, Gas Scape Hole. Gas regulator ki matra ko cont karta hai. Iski do posn hain. Low aur High. (e) Loop Front Sling. Sling lagane ke kaam ata hai. 85 (a) (b) 2. (c) Hand Guard. (d) (e) (f) (g) 3. Cocking Handle Assy. Rifle ko cock karne mein madad deta hai. Slide ke pichhle hisse laga hota hai. Iske purjon ke naam is prakar hain :(a) Cocking Handle. (b) Slide. (c) Plunger. (d) Pin. 4. Body Housing Assy. Yeh 1.8mm Sheet Metal ka bana hai. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) 5. Left Channel Right Channel Safety Sear. Ejector. Spacer. Rear Block. Cover Assy. (a) (b) (c) Hinges. Male Dovetail. Rear Sight Housing. 86 6 (a) (b) (c) 6. Trigger 10. Rotating Mech Assy. Bolt Assy. (a) Cam. (a) Change (b) Firing Lever. Pin. (b) TRB. (c) Locking (c) Lug. Hammer. (d) Feed (d) Trigger Piece. Sear. (e) (e) Extractor. Auxillary Sear. 11. Recoil Spring Assy. 7. Pistol Grip (a) Stopper. Assy. (b) Guide. (c) Spring. 8. Butt Assy. 12. Mag Assy. (a) Butt Plate. (b) Butt Trap. (c) Rear Sling Loop. (d) Shoulder Pivot. 9. Piston Extension Assy. (a) Piston. (b) Cam Way. (c) Stem. (d) Recoil Spring Housing. (e) Right Lug. (f) Bottom Surface. (d) (e) (f) (g) (a) Lips. (b) Platform. (c) Bottom Plate. (d) Dimpal. (e) Retainer. (f) Spring. 13. Bipod Assy. (a) Shoes. (b) Catch. (c) Legs. 7 87 (a) (b) (c) Jorna. Jis sequence mein khola gaya hai thik uske viprit karwai karte huye joren. Akhir mein cock karke trigger press Karen. Safai Karne ka Tariqa. teen stage hote hain :(a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) Safai ke Aam Safai. (i) Rojana ki safai. (ii) Weekly Safai. (iii) Monthly. Firing Ke Lihaj se. (i) Firing se Pahle. (ii) Firing ke Dauran. (iii) Firing ke baad. Mausam ke Lihaj se. (i) High Alt. (ii) Desert. Lubrication. (a) 4 degree se above - OX 52. (b) 4 Degree se -18 Degree - OX –13. (c) -18 Degree se -40 Degree - OX 13 + Superior quality K/Oil 1:1. (d) -40 degree se -50 degree - OX 13 + Superior quality K/Oil 2:3. 8 (a) (b) ABHYAS (c) Class se kholne jorne ka abhyas karaya jaye. (d) (e) (f) 05 26 (g) Pure class se. 88 BHAG-III Accessories se jankari aur safai karne katariqa INSAS LMG ke sath 07 prakar ki accessories ati hain :(a) Muzzal cover (b) BFA (c) Siling (d) DLTS (e) PNS (f) BLS (g) Monopod Monopod se Jankari aur LMG ko Fix Line par Lagane ka Tariqa. Monopod LMG ke sath assy ke taur par aata hai, jisi madad se LMG ko fix line par lagaya jata hai. Monopod ke hisse purje :(a) Elevation Drum (Nut aur Screw). (b) Leaf Spring. (c) Sleeve aur Pin. (d) Shoe. (e) Spikes. (f) Plastic Grip. (a) (b) Monopod ko Lagana. Monopod lagane ki jimmewari LMG No-1 ki hoti hai. Iske lie sabse pahle LMG ko fixed line ki disha mein karen. Monopod ke sleeve se pin ko nikalen. Sleeve ko rear lug mein fix karen aur pin ko lagayen. Bipod ki wajah se LMG sthir rahegi. Monopod ke elevation drum ki madad se LMG ko upar niche ki 9 (c) 80mm tak harkat di ja sakti hai. 05 (d) (e) 31 (f) (g) Fixed Line. Kisi bhi auto hathiyar ko fixed line par lay tab mana jata hai jab woh kharab mausam, raat, kam roshni, dhuyen, dhundh mein pahle se nirdharit disha mein fire karne ki kabiliyat rakhta ho. 89 Fixed Line ka Chunav. Def mein LMG ka primary task padosi sec ke defended post ki suraksha karna hota hai. LMG ko is prakar sight kiya jata hai ki donon sec mutual support mein ho taki dushman ko kam se kam do LMG ke fire se gujarna pare. Fixed line ka fire padosi sec ke jitna najdik se gujrega utna hi kargar hoga. Lekin ismein kam se kam 5degree ka safety angle rakhna jaruri hai. 700m se jiada duri ke tgt par LMG ko fixed line par lay nahi karna chahiye, kyonki 700m tak golion ki trajectory 4.5 feet se jiada nahi uthti. Improvised Tariqe se Fixed Line par Lagana. Agar Monopod na ho to bhi LMG ko fixed line par lagaya ja sakta hai. Iske liye LMG ke butt ke niche munasib unchi sand bag ka istemal kiya ja sakta hai ya kisi anya improvised tariqe se bhi lagaya ja sakta hai. Safai Karne ka Tariqa. teen stage hote hain :- Safai ke Aam Safai. (i) Rojana ki safai. (ii) Weekly Safai. (iii) Monthly. (b) Firing Ke Lihaj se. (i) Firing se Pahle. (ii) Firing ke Dauran. (iii) Firing ke baad. 10 (c) c) Mausam ke Lihaj se. (a) (a) (b) (i) (ii) (d) (e) (f) (g) High Alt. Desert. Lubrication. (a) 4 degree se above 90 - OX 52. (b) 4 Degree se -18 Degree - OX –13. (c) -18 Degree se -40 Degree - OX 13 + Superior quality K/Oil 1:1. (d) -40 degree se -50 degree - OX 13 + Superior ABHYAS 7. SANKSHEP quality K/Oil 2:3. Bhag No 3 ka abhyas karaya jaye. Q1. INSAS LMG ka kargar rg kitna hai ? Ans. 700m. Q2. INSAS LMG kitne assy ki bani hui hai ? Ans. 13 assy ki. Q3. Monopod se upar neeche kitni harkat di ja sakti hai ? Ans. 80mm. 06 37 03 40 Class ko gp mein banta ja sakta hai. ************************************************************************** LMG-IN 10-18 5.56 MM INSAS LMG KE MAG KO BHARNA,KAHLI KARNA ,LMG KO BHARNA ,READY MAKE SAFE AUR KHALI KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA 91 TARTIB S/N O (a) 1. (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI 3. PAHUNC H TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (c) (d) (m) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (n) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan. (o) Bandoba st ki karwai. 5.56m m INSAS LMGle, mag, Drill Carts, Assy Bag Ground sheet, Q1. INSAS LMG ki MV kitni hai ? Ans. 925 m/sec. Q2. INSAS LMG ki safai ke liye chindi ka scale kya hai ? Ans. 4” x 1 ½”. 5.56mm INSAS LMG Inf sec ka ek matra lambi duri tak maar karne wala auto TIME Actua l Runnin g (e) (f) 01 01 01 02 01 03 REMARK S (g) Nirikshan class se karwaya jae. Pichhle lesson Pahunch sabaq se sambandhi t ho. 92 hathiyar hai. Is liye jawan ko kholna, jorna aur safai karna jan lena hi kafi nahi hai balki larai ke maidan mein LMG ka pura faida uthane ke liye LMG ko bharna aur khali karna ana chahiye Sath hi bhari LMG ko ek jagah se dusri jagah le jane ke liye make safe ki karwai bhi achhi tarah ani chahiye. (a) (b) 2 (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 4. UDDESH 5.56 mm INSAS LMG ke mag ko bharna,khali karna , LMG ko Bharna, Ready, Makesafe aur Khali Karne ka tariqa Sikhana Hai. 01 04 Dohraya jaye. 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS LMG, As per Mag,drill carts,accessory trg bag, chindi, long easel, aids. black board, chalk, duster aur ground sheet. 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag No-I. Mag ko bharna aur khali karna Bhag No-II. Sight lagana aur range hasil karna Bhag No-III. LMG ko bharna,ready,makesafe aur khali karna. 01 06 BHAG NOI MAG KO BHARNA AUR KHALI KARNA :- 10 16 93 NAMUNA Amn ki Safai. Rounds ko len aur saaf kapre se round ko ek ek karke saaf Karen. Agar samay kam ho to kai roundon ko ek saath kapre mein lappet kar safai ki ja sakti hai, lekin dhyan rahe ki roundon ka aapas mein ragad nahin hona chahiye. Amn ko saaf karke kisi saaf jagah par rakhen. Mag ka Bharna. Bharne se pahle mag ka mulahija karen. Agar mag ki body tuti ho ya lips tute hon to aise mag ko na bhara jaye. Dusre mag ko len aur isi tarah mulahija karen. Agar thik ho to bharne ke liye istemal karen. INSAS LMG ke mag ko bharne ka tariqa bhi SLR ke mag ki tarah hi hai. Iska mag fibre glass ka bana hone ki wajah se ismen 3 (a) (b) (c) rds bahar se hi dikhai dete hain. Ismen ham filler ka istemal nahin karte hain kyonki iske rds cortons mein band hokar aate hain. Mag ko len aur is prakar pakren ki mag ka chhota mehrab andar ki taraf aur bada mehrab bahar ki taraf ho. Mag ko ground sheet , boot ki toe ya raan par rakhte hue saaf kiye hue rds ko len aur dono haathon ki anguliyon aur anguthe ki madad se ek ek rd bharen. Bharte samay agar koi rd niche gir jata hai to use aakhir mein saaf karke (d) (e) (f) (g) 94 bharen. Is prakar ek mag mein 30 rds aate hain aur 30 hi bhare jate hain. Mag ko Khlai Karna. Mag ko len aur baen aur is prakar pakre ki haath ki char ungliyan upar se aur angutha andar se pakarte hue chhota mehrab zamin ki taraf ho. Kisi nukili cheej ki madad se rd ke bairkhilaf dabate huye mag ko khali Karen. Dhayan rahe agar rd ka istemal kiya jar aha ho to hare k ya do rd ke baad iski badli kar di jaye. Roundon ka girav saaf jagah par hona chahiye. Roundon ko saaf Karen aur cartoon mein band Karen. ABHYAS Mag ko bharna aur khali karna par abhyas karaya jaye. BHAG NO-2 SIGHT LAGANA AUR RANGE HASIL KARNA :Char prakar ki sighting ki subhidha hai :(d) Open sight (e) Day light telescopic sight (f) Passive night sight (g) Beta light sight 05 21 05 26 Pure class se abhyas karaya jaye. 4 (a) (b) (c) a) Open Sight. Open Sight ke hisse purje :(ii) Fore Sight. Fore sight protractor. Fore sight tip, locking nut. (ii) Rear Sight Housing rear sight, Lips, Rear sight apparture, leaf spring, screw axis, plunger (d) (e) (f) (g) 95 Abhyas BHAG-III NAMUNA Range Hasil Karna. Rear open sight par do lips bane hue hain. Pahle par 2 ka ank likha hai, jo 200m ke rg ko zahir karta hai. Dusre ke upar 4 ka ank likha hai jo 400 m ke rg ko zahir karta hai. 100m aur 300m ke rg hasil karne ki koi suvidha nahin hai. Day light telescopic sight aur passive night sight ke bare mein aap ko pichhle lesson mein bataya gaya hai. Sight lagane par abhyas liya jai. LMG ko Bharna, Ready, Makesafe aur Khali Karna. Jab LMG par khali mag chadhi ho, chamber khali ho aur change lever ki posn ‘S’ par ho to LMG khali mani jati hai. Jab bhari hui mag chadhi ho, chamber khali ho aur change lever ki posn ‘S’ par ho to LMG bhari hui mani jati hai. Jab Bhari mag chadhi ho, chamber mein rd ho, change lever ki posn ‘R’ ya ‘B’ par ho, kalmewali ungali trigger par ho to LMG ko ready mana jata hai. 02 28 06 34 Bhar Posn. Bhar posn ke adesh par baen paon ko chalti halat mein aage len, dahine haath se LMG ko badan kea age uchhalte huye taul wali jagah se pakren. Is posn mein dekhnewali baten. Dono paon kad ke mutabik khule huye hon, badan ka bojh dono paon ke upar, baen haath ki pakar forehand guard oar, dahine haath ki pakar pitol grip par, LMG 5 (a) (b) (c) dahini bagal mein dabi hui. (d) (e) (f) (g) 96 Bharne ke Hukam par Karwahi. Jab firer ko tgt dikhai de ya hukam mile bhar, to karwahi is prakar Karen. Change lever ki posn ‘S’ par Karen, mag catch ko dabate hue mag ko utaren aur pouch mein band Karen. Pouch se bhara mag len, mag ka mulahija karte hue mag way mein fit karen aur yakin Karen ki mag thik tariqe se lag gaya hai. Baen hath ki pakar fore hand guard par wapis le jaen. Ready. Jab firer fire karne ka irada rakhta ho ya hukam mile ready, is adesh par change lever ki posn ‘R’ ya ‘B’ par Karen, butt kandhe ka milap Karen, kalme wali anguli trigger ke upper rakhen aur agle hukam ka intezar karen. Make Safe ki karwahi. Jab bhari hui LMG ko ek jagah se dusri jagah par le jana ho to makesafe ki karwai ko amal mein laya jata hai. Karne ka tariqa. Sabse pahle kalme wali anguli ko trigger se bahar karen, LMG ko kandhe se niche layen, LMG ko dahine turn karte huye do baar cock Karen, durust shisht lete huye trigger ko press karen, LMG ko kandhe se niche layen, change lever ki posn ko ‘S’ par Karen, pouch se bhari mag ko len, mag ka 97 mulahija karte huye mag way mein dakhil Karen, yakin Karen ki mag thik baith gaya hai, kneeling posn akhtiyar Karen, eject huye rd ko len, saaf karke dusri mag (a) (b) (c) mein bharen. (d) (e) (f) (g) abhyas 04 38 Abhyas pure class se karaya jaye. Q1. INSAS LMG ki mag mein kitne rds bhare jate hain? Ans. 30 rds. Q2. INSAS LMG ke sath kitne prakar ki sighting system ki subhidha hai ? Ans. 04 prakar ki. LMG-IN 19-27 02 40 Khali Karna. Khali kar ke aadesh par make safe ki tarah hi karwahi karte hain aur aakhiri mein khali mag chadha dete hain. ABHYAS 7. SANKSHEP Bhag-III ka karaya jaye. 5.56 MM INSAS LMG SE PAKAR, SISHT AUR FIRE KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA 98 TARTIB S/NO 1. (a) (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM TEACHING POINTS (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. TRG AIDS (d) TIME REMAR Actual Running KS (e) (f) (g) 01 01 Niriksha n class se karaya jaye. 2. DOHRAI Q1. LMG ka sight radius kitna hai ? Ans :- 475mm. Q2. Monopod se kitni harkat di ja sakti hai ? Ans :- 80mm upar niche. 01 02 Dohrai pahle lesson se ek ya do question puchhka r le sakte hain. 3. PAHUNCH Ek firer agar, durust posn aur pakar hasil karne ke baad durust 01 03 Pahunc h sabaq se samban dhit ho. 99 shisht lekar fire karta hai to woh, ek golo ek dushman ka mudha hasil kar sakta hai. Is lie LMG firer ko accha natiza hasil karne ke liye LMG ki sahi pakar, durust shist tgt ki kisam ke anusar fire karna ana chahiye taki tgt ko jaldi barbad kiya ja sake. a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) 4. UDDESH 5.56 mm INSAS LMG se Pakar, Shisht aur Fire Karne ka Tariqa Sikhana Hai. 01 04 Do bar bataya jayega. 5. SAMAN 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT LMG, Mag, Drill cart , As per INSAS Rifle, Field of trg aids. View ka board, Tgt 1x1 , black board, easal, duster, chalk, ground sheet. Bhag -I Durust Pakar. Bhag -II Durust Shisht Lena. Bhag -III Fire Karna. 01 06 BHAG-I NAMUNA Sabak ko tartibwar chalane ke liye. Durust Pakar. Kisi bhi firer ke fire ka star kafi had tak uske durust pakar par nirbhar karta hai. 5.56mm INSAS Rif aur LMG ki pakar do 100 students ki posn dikhakar. LMG mein bipod ki suvidha hone ke karan baen hath ki pakar small of the butt ke upar hoti hai is lie firer ka badan line of fire ki sidh mein hoti hai. Rif mein sahara dene ke liye baen hath ki posn forehand guard par rakhna parta hai. Is lie firer ka badan line of fire se tirchha hota hai. (b) Durust Pakar Hasil Karne ki Karwai. Sabse pahle tgt ko dekhkar bipod ko tgt ke madhya mein karen. Lying posn ke adesh par durust posn ikhtiyar karen. Range milne par sahi range lagayen. LMG ko kandhe par le jayen. Kandhe par le jate samay shoulder pivot ko khara karen. LMG ko cock karen aur kohnion ko harkat dekar posn durust karen. Yadi shisht POA se upar ya niche ho to bipod ko munasib kholkar niche ya upar karen. (c) Durust pakar hasil karne mein sharir ke alag alag angon ke kaam :- LMG, mag, ground sheet 05 11 (d) (e) (f) (g) (a) Kandha. Kandha butt ko tikne ki jagah deta hai. Butt ko kandhe jo gadha banta hai wahan rakha jaye na ki haddi ke upar. Yadi butt aur kandhe ka milap thik se nahi ho raha ho to sharir ko munasib aage ya 101 pichhe ki harkat dekar butt kandhe ka milap karen na ki LMG ko aage ya pichhe khinchkar. (b) Bayan Hath. Baen hath se LMG ke small of the butt ko pakra jaye, charon unglian upar se aur angutha niche se. Bayan hath LMG ko pichhe aur niche khinch kar rakhta hai. (c) Dayan Hath. Dayan hath ki pakar pistol grip par, teenon unglian bahar se, angutha andar se aur kalmewali anguli trigger guard ke aar paar. Dayan hath LMG ko pichhe khinchkar rakhta hai aur LMG ko samanantar rakhne mein madad deta hai. (d) Sir. Sir ko butt ke upar is prakar rakhen ki gaal ka naram wala bhag butt ke upar tik jaye. Gaal baen hath ki kalmewali anguli ke paas is prakar rakhen ki eye relief takriban 3” se 4” ke beech ho. (e) Puri Pakar ko Mazboot Karna. Puri pakar ko mazboot karne ke liye gaal se baen hath aur butt ko dabate huye donon kohnion ko andar ki taraf karen. Is karwai ko clamping action ke naam se jante hain. ABHYAS Durust pakar hasil karne ka abhyas karaya jaye. 03 14 Puri class se. 102 4 (b) BHAG-II NAMUNA (c) (d) Durust Shisht Lena. Jab ek firer apne aankh aur dimag ka sahi talmel karte hue apne hathiyar ke upar lagi hue sighton ka istemal karte hue shist ko POA par milata hai use shist lena kahte hain. INSAS Rif aur LMG mein pakar aur posn mein antar hone ke karan LMG mein eye relief jiada banta hai jisse field of INSAS view kam banta hai. LMG, mag, Shist ka kaida. INSAS LMG INSAS mein shisht lene ka kaida hu- Rif, mag, ba-hu Rif ki tarah hi hai. LMG Field of mein auto fire karne ki view ka kabiliyat hone ki wajah bd, tharthrahat jiada hoti hai. Is ground liye firer ko fore sight tip ko sheet, aperture ke madhya mein black bd, rakhne par jiada dhyan dena chalk, chahiye aur mazboot pakar duster. barkrar rakhne ki jarurat paregi. (e) (f) 10 24 (g) Hatkar Shisht Lena. LMG se bhi hatkar shisht lene ka tariqa rif ki tarah hi hai, lekin tgt ko engage karne mein farak hai. LMG se tracking aur trapping donon tarikon se tgt engage kiya ja sakta hai. (a) Trapping. Is tarike se tgt ko engage karne ka tariqa is prakar hai :(i) Tgt ka sahi rg malum karen aur sight ke upar rg lagayen. (ii) Tgt ki raftar ke mutabik lead nikalen. (iii) Tgt ke age koi mashhoor nishan chunen 103 aur LMG ko fix kare. (iv) Masjhoor nishan se tgt ki taraf nikale gaye lead ko baten aur koi madad ka nishan chunen. (v) Jab tgt madad ke nishan ke paas pahunch jae to mashhoor nishan par 6-8 rds ka burst fire karen, tgt barbad ho jayega. (a) (b) (c) (b) Tracking. Is tarike se tgt ka pichha karte huye barbad kiya ja sakta hai. Trapping ka tariqa Tracking ke tarike se achha mana gaya hai. ABHYAS Class se abhyas karaya jaye. BHAG-III Fire Karne ka Tarika. Alag alag halaton mein nikalne wale tgt par kargar fire karne ki kabiliyat se INSAS LMG ko banaya gaya hai. INSAS LMG se do tarikon se fire karte hain :- NAMUNA (a) Single Shot. (b) Automatic. (i) Burst Fire. (ii) Rapid Fire. Single Shot Fire. Sahi posn ikhtiyar karen. Natural alignmeny ko check karen. LMG ko bhar aur ready karen. Dimagi taur par sharir ke un angon ko check karen jo LMG ko pakarne mein madad dete (d) INSAS LMG, mag, ground sheet, black bd, chalk, duster. (e) (f) (g) 05 29 Pure class se. 05 34 104 hain, jaise bayan hath, dahina hath, kandha aur sir. Durust sight alignment aur sight picture hasil karen. Change lever ki posn ko ‘R’ par karen. Sans ko chand sec ke liye roken aur durust trigger operation ki karwai karen. Is prakar se 1 min mein 60 rd ke hisab se fire kiya jata hai. (a) (b) (c) Stop. Fire karte samay tgt ilake mein koi jaandar vastu aa jaye ya trg ke dauran aadesh mile ‘stop’ to karwai is prakar karen. (d) (e) (f) (g) (a) Kalme wali anguli ko trigger se baahar nikale. (b) LMG ko kandhe se niche laen aur change lever ki posn ko ‘S’ par karen. (c) Iska mag ardh pardarshi hone ke karan mag ka yakin karne ki jarurat nahi padti. Agar mag khali hone wala hai to mag ki badli karen aur agle hukm ka intezar karen. Go On. Agar tgt ilake se jandar vastu hat jae ya trg ke dauran aadesh mile ‘GO ON’ to change lever ki posn ko pahle wali posn mein karen aur LMG ko fire mein shamil karen. Burst Fire. Jab ek firer change lever ki posn ‘A’ par karke trigger dabata hai aur 2 ya 2 se adhik rds fire ho jaye use burst fire kahte hain. (a) Burst kitna lamba ho yeh tgt ke rg, kism aur firer ki kabiliyat par nirbhar karta hai. 105 (b) 2 se 3 rd ka burst sabse achha mana jata hai. (c) 4 se 5 rd ka burst tgt par phailkar lagta hai, jisse firer apni maar ko dekhkar munasib correction de sakta hai. (d) 6 se 8 rd ka burst harkat tgt ko barbad karne ke liye sabse achha mana gaya hai. Rapid Fire. Rapid fire mein lagatar fire kiya jata hai. Ismein Stop aur Go On ki karwai single shot ki tarah hi hoti hai. Lekin stop ke adesh par LMG ko cock kakr HOD laga diya jata hai taki brl thandha ho jaye. Ismein 1 min mein 150 rd ke hisab se fire kiya jata hai. 7 a) 7. (b) (c) Limber Up. Firing se pahle firer ko chahiye ki woh durust posn ikhtiyar karne ke baad tgt par sahi shisht lete huye LMG ko aage aur pichhe ki harkat dekar apni posn check kare. Agar fore sight tip 12 baje aur 6 baje ki line mein harkat kar rahi ho to firer ko apni posn durust man leni chahiye. Is karwai ko Limber Up ki karwai kahte hain. Yeh karwai firing ke dauran bhi mauka milte hi kar leni chahiye. ABHYAS Class se abhyas karaya jaye. SANKSHEP Q1. Shisht lete samay firer kin kin karwai ko amal mein lata hai ? Ans. Sight Alignment aur Sight picture. Q2. LMG se kitne prakar ka fire kiya jata hai ? (d) (e) (f) (g) 04 38 Puri class se. 02 40 106 Ans. 2 prakar ka. LMG-IN 28-35 5.56mm INSAS LMG KI CHAAL, PARNE WALI ROKEN AUR UNHEN DUR KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA TARTIB TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS KAM (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. (d) LMG, Mag, Drill Carts, 1X1 Tgt, , Assy Bag, Black Bd, Chalk, Duster, Ground Sheet.. DOHRAI Q1. 300 m S/NO 1. 2. (a) (b) SHURU SHURU KA TIME Actual Running (e) (f) 01 01 01 02 REMARKS (g) Nirikshan class se karwaya jae. Dohrai 107 par tej daurte tgt ke liye kitne lead aage shist liya jata hai? A. 9 lead aage shist liya jata hai. pahle lesson se ek ya do sawal puchhkar liya jaye. Q.2. Sight alignment aur sight picture mein kiski ahmiyat jyada hai? A. Sight alignment ki ahmiyat jyada hai. 2 (a) 3. (b) PAHUNCH (c) INSAS LMG gas ke dabav aur recoil spring ki takat se kaam karne wala hathiyar hai. Isse auto fire bhi kar saskte hain. Lagatar firing se ismen chand ek roken par sakti hain, yadi har ek firer iski chal ke bare mein achhi tarah janta hai to ismen parne wali rokon ko aasani se door kar sakta hai. yeh tabhi sambhav hai ki yadi jawan ne achhi sikhlai hasil ki hue ho. 4. UDDESH 5.56 mm INSAS LMG ki chaal , parne wali roken aur unhen door karne ka tarika (d) (e) 01 (f) 03 (g) Pahunch sabaq se sambandhit ho. 01 04 Do bar bataya jayega. 108 sikhana hai. 5. SAMAN 6. BHAGON Bhag -I MEIN BANT ki chaal. 5.56mm INSAS LMG, As per mag drill carts, 1X1’ trg tgt, , accessory bag, aids. chal ka diagram, black bd, chalk duster aur ground sheet. INSAS LMG 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. 01 06 Sabak ko tartibwar chalane ke liye. 10 16 Bhag -II Parne wali roken aur unhen dur karne ka tariqa. BHAG-I NAMUNA (a) (b) INSAS LMG ki Chaal. INSAS LMG ki chaal 8 actionon mein poori hoti hai. Fire, Unlock, Extract, Cock, Eject, Feed, Load, Lock. (c) Chal mein kaam karne wale hisse purjon ke naam:Change lever, Trigger, Hammer, Firing pin, (d) (e) (f) (g) 109 Chamber wala rd, Gas vent, Gas plug, Gas cylinder, Piston extension, cam way, Locking lug, Barrel locking lug, Rotating bolt, Recoil spring, Barrel locking surface. INSAS LMG ki Chaal. Fire. Jab ek firer change lever ki posn ‘S’ se ‘R’ ya ‘A’ par karke trigger press karta hai to hammer azad hokar firing pin retainer par chot marta hai jisse firing pin apne surakh se nikal kar rd ke primer par thokar marta hai aur rd fire ho jata hai. Ise fire ka action kahte hain. Unlock. Fire hue rd se paida hui gas bullet ko aage barrel mein dhakelti hai, jyon hi bullet gas vent ke paas se hokar gujrata hai kuchh gas, gas vent ke hole se cylinder mein dakhil ho jati hai. Cylinder mein dakhil gas piston head par dabav dalta hai, jisse piston extension peechhe ki harkat karta hai. Piston extension ke peechhe ki harkat ke dauran rotating bolt ka cam cam way mein dahine se baen itna ghumta hai ki rotating bolt ke locking lug barrel extension locking surface se alag ho jaten hai. Is karwai ko unlock ka action kahte hain. Extract. Unlock hone ke baad rotating bolt aur piston extension ek saath peechhe ki harkat karte hain, isi dauran extractor fired case ko apne munh mein pakar 110 kar peechhe lata hai, is karwai ko extraction ki karwai kahte hain. 4 (a) (b) (c) Cock. Chal wale purjon ki isi harkat jaari rahti hai. Isi douran piston extension ka stem shuru shuru mein hammer ko thora niche dabata hai baad main piston extension ka bottom surface hammer ko pura niche daba deta hai, jisse safety sear ke nose ka milap hammer vent se ho jata hai. Is karwai ko cock ka action kehta hai. (d) (e) (f) (g) EJECT. Chal wale purje ki isi harkat ke dauran fired case ejector se se takrakar ejection slot ke raste dahine aur niche gir jata hai, Is karwai ko eject ki karwai kahte hain. FEED. Recoil spring apne housing mein sikur jata hai. Jab recoil spring apne tanao ko poora karta hai to piston extension ko age dhakelta hai. Is duran rotating bolt ke feed piece mag ke upar wale rd ko chamber mein dakhil kar deta hai. Is karwai ko Feed ki karwai kahte hain. LOAD. Extractor rd ke pende par sawar ho jata hai. Is karwai ko load ka action kahte hain. yahan par rotating bolt ki age ki harkat samapat ho jati hai lekin piston extension ki harkat 111 baki rahti hai. Lock. Piston extension ki aage ki harkat jari rahti hai , Isi harkat ke dauran rotating bolt cam ki madad se cam way mein baen se dahine itna ghumta hai ki rotating bolt ke locking lug barrel extinsion locking surface ke saath lock ho jate hain. Is karwai ko lock ka action kahte hain. Lock hone ke baad bhi piston extension ki kuchh harkat baki rahti hai. Jab piston apni aakhri harkat poora karta hai to piston extension ka nichla, pichhla aur dahina pehlu safety sear head par dabav dalta hai, jisse safety sear ki notch hammer vent se alag ho jati hai aur LMG dubara fire ke liye taiyar ho jata hai. 5 (a) (b) ABHYAS BHAG-II NAMUNA (c) Chaal ka abhyas karaya jaye. Parne wali roken aur unhen dur karne ka tarika. Trigger dabane par LMG fire na kare ya fire karte karte ruk jae to karwai fauri ilaz ki karen. Karne ka tariqa Sabse pahle kalmewali unguli ko trigger se bahar karen. LMG ko cock karen holding opening device ko lagayen. Mag catch ko (d) INSAS LMG, mag, ground Sheet (e) (f) 10 26 09 35 (g) Abhyas pure class se karaya jae. Namuna bayan ke sath diya jaye 112 dabate huye mag ko utaren pouch mein band karen. Pouch se bhari hui mag ko len. Mag ka mulahija karte huye mag way mein dakhil karen. Yakin karen ki mag thik tarah se baith gaya hai. LMG ko fire mein shamil karen. LMG thik fire karega. Is prakar ek baar LMG ko cock karne aur mag ki badli karne se teen prakar ki roken door hoti hain. Khali Mag, Misfire aur body mein atka hua round ya case. Fauri ilaz ki karwai karne par bhi LMG fire na kare ya fire karte karte purje pichhe na aayen to iske do karan ho sakte hain. Shakhat Khinchav ki Rok ko Dur Karna :- Kalmewali anguli ko trigger se bahar nikalen. LMG ko kandhe se niche laen. Kneeling posn ikhtiyar karen. LMG ko uthayen. Baen haath ki pakar forehand guard par. Mag baen taraf aur ejection slot neeche ki taraf. Dahina ghutna poora dahine. Butt dahine ghutne ke saath laga hua. Dahina ghutna butt ko peechhe jane se rokta hai. Cocking handle ko khara karen. Dahine haath ki charon anguliyon ka huk banate hue LMG ko cock karen. Yakin karen ki shakhat khinchav ki rok door ho gai hai. Shout karen shakhat khinchav ki rok door. Shakhat khinchav ki rok door. Dubara posn ikhtiyar karen. Butt kandhe ka milap karen. LMG ko fire 113 mein shamil karen. LMG thik fire karega. Sakhat khichav ki rok parne ke karan:(a) Chamber mein jyada gas jama hona. (b) Amn aur chamber ka jyada ganda hona. 6 (a) (b) ABHYAS (c) Yeh tha namuna abhi hoga abhyas. Abhyas ke liye aadesh is prakar honge. LMG thik fire karta rukta ke aadesh par aap fouri ilaj ki karwai mein cock tak ki karwai karenge. Munasib rok ka naam milne par aap use door karenge. Cock nahi ke aadesh par shakhat khichav ki rok samajhkar door karenge. Bhag-I ka abhyas karaya jaye. Gas ki Kami ki Rok ko Dur Karna :Kalme wali anguli ko trigger se bahar nikalen. LMG ko cock karen. Purjon ko aage jaane den. Change NAMUNA lever ki posn ‘S’ par karen. LMG ko kandhe se niche layen. LMG ke baen badan ko aage le jayen. Gas regulator ki posn ka mulahija karen. Agar gas regulator ki posn low par ho to kisi saaf kapre ya chindi ki madad se low se high par karen. Shouting karen low se high par kiya. Low se high par kiya. Dhyan rahe hath barrel ke sath touch nahi hona chahiye. Yadi gas regulaon ki posn pahle hi high par ho to gas plug ko kholen aur gas vent wa gas plug hole ki safai karen. Gas plug ko jor den. Gas regulator ki posn ko kapre ya chindi ki madad se high se low par karen. Shouting karen high se low par kiya. High se low par kiya. Change (d) (e) (f) (g) 10 45 Pure class se. 05 50 BHAG-III 114 lever ki posn ko pahlewali posn par karen. LMG ko kandhe par le jaen durust shist len aur fire karen LMG thik fire karega. Gas ki kami ki rok parne ke kaaran. Gas ka jiada fouling hone se gas vent ya gas plug ke hole ka band ho jana. Yeh tha namuna abhi hoga abhyas. Abhyas ke liye aadesh is prakar honge. LMG thik fire karta rukta, ek do round ke baad rukta ke aadesh par gas ki kami ki rok samajhkar dur ki jayegi. ABHYAS Gas ki kami ki rok dur karne ka abhyas liya jaye. 10 7 (a) (b) BHAG-IV (c) Anya Roken Dur Karne ka Tariqa. Kalme wali anguli trigger se bahar nikalen. Mag catch ko dabate huye mag ko utaren. LMG ko cock karen. Purjon ko aage jane den. LMG ko NAMUNA kandhe se neeche layen. LMG ko khol den. Firing pin aur extractor ka mulahiza karen. Yadi tute hue hon to unki badli karen. Abhi ke liye firing pin extractor thik, to ho sakta hai chamber mein kata hua case. Donon haathon se pistol grip se LMG ko pakren aur LMG ko jisam se aage karte hue chamber ka mulahiza karen. Dekhne mein aaya chamber mein kata hua case to LMG ko jor den. LMG ko cock karen aur HOD ko lagaen. Clearing plug ko len. Clearing plug ke teen bade hisse purje Base, Sleeve aur center pin. Base aur center pin ko tight karen, chamber mein dakhil karen. Purjon ko aage jaane den. LMG ko cock karen aur HOD lagayen. Yakin karen ki kata hua case clearing plug ke sath bahar aa gaya hai. Pehla mauka milte hi unscrew karen. LMG ko kandhe mein le jaen. Bhari hui (d) 60 Pure class se. (e) (f) 08 68 (g) 115 mag ko len aur mag ka mulahija karte huye mag way mein fit karen. Yakin karen ki mag thik lag gaya hai. Purjon ko aage jaane den. durust shist len aur fire karen, LMG thik fire karega. Chamber mein case katne ke kaaran:(a) Chamber ka jayda garam ho jana. (b) Cartridge case ke metal ka kamjor hona. Yeh tha namuna abhi hoga abhyas. Abhyas ke liye aadesh is prakar honge. LMG thik fire karta rukta, fire nahi ke aadesh par anya roken samajhkar dur ki jayengi. ABHYAS (a) 7. (b) SANKSHEP Anya roken dur karne ka abhyas liya jaye. (c) Q1. INSAS LMG ki chal kitne action meinpuri hoti hai ? Ans. 08 action mein. Q2. Fouri ilaj se kitne prakar ki roken dur hoti hai ? Ans. Teen prakar ki. Q3. Gas ki kami ki rok parne ke kya karan hain ? Ans. Gas ka jiada fouling hone se gas vent ya gas plug hole ka band ho jana. Q4. Chamber mein case katne ke kya karan hai ? Ans. Chamber ka jiada garam hona, rd ke metal ka kamjor hona. 10 (d) 78 Pure class se. (e) (f) 02 80 116 (g) LMG-IN 36-45 5.56mm INSAS LMG KO ACTION KE DAURAN HANDLING KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA TARTIB S/NO 1. (a) (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAM 2. DOHRAI 3. PAHUNCH TEACHING POINTS (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. Q1 LMG ki chal kitne action mein puri hoti hai ? Ans :- 08 actionon mein. Q2. Gas ki kami ki rok parne ke kya karan hain ? Ans;- Gas ka jiada fauling hone se gas vent ya gas plug ke hole ka band ho jana. Infantry sec ke pas LMG hi ek TRG AIDS TIME REMARKS Actual Running (d) (e) (f) (g) As per 01 01 Class se trg hathiyar ka aids nirakshan karwaya jayaga. 01 02 Pichale lesson se. 01 03 Pahunch ustad ki 117 aissa hathiyar hai jisse bhari tadad mein lambe rg tak fire dalkar dushman ko barbad kiya jata hai. Larai ke maidan mein is hathiyar ka pura pura faida uthane ke liye No 1 aur No2 ki zarurat parti hai agar firing ke dauran koi rok par jai to No 2 No 1ke madad karta hai, rok ko dur karta hai aur LMG ko dubara fire mein shamil kiya jata hai. (a) (b) (c) 5.56 mm INSAS LMG ko Action ke Dauran handling karne ka tariqa sikhana hai. apni apni saaf lekin sabaq se sambandth. (d) (e) (f) 01 04 (g) Uddesh ko do bar bataya jae. 4. UDDESH 5. SAMAN 5.56 mm INSAS LMG, Mag, Drill carts, Assy bag, 9 mm CMG , drill carts, Mag , Fig 11 Tgt, black bd, chalk aur duster. 01 05 Kneeling posn se point karke bataya jae. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag -I Firing Posn ka Chunav. Bhag -II Action mein LMG ki Handling. 01 06 Leson ko tartibwar chalane ke liye. BHAG –I Bhag –I Firing posn ka 118 chunav NAMUNA (a) 1 se 1.5 ft Ki Arh. Is prakar ki arh lying posn se asani se istemal ki ja sakti hai. Is mein LMG ko on bipod ya bipod fold karke istemal kar sakte hai. Jahan tak ho sake on bipod par hi istemal karna chahiye kyon ki on bipod se ziada sthirtha milti hai. Yadi bipod fold karke istemal kar rahe hai to yakin kar lena chahiye ki mag arh ke sath nahi lagna chahiye. 05 11 (b) 2 se 2.5 ft ki Arh. Is prakar ki arh ko kneeling,sitting aur squading posn se on bi[pod ya bipod fold karke donon tariqon se istemal kiya ja sakta hai. Is ke liye arh ko apne baen chhorte hue asani se istemal kar sakte hai. (a) (b) (c) (c) Gol Arh ka IstemaL Is prakar ki arh ko apne baen chhorte hue, yani dahine se istemal kiya jata hai. Gol arh ka matlab sirf gol hona hi nahi hai,aissi arh koi divar koi bara darkhat ho sakti hai. Is prakar ki arh mein No 1 takriban aur (d) (e) (f) (g) 119 No 2 pura arh ki peechhe surakshit rahta hai. (d) Dhalwandar Zamin. Dalwandar zamin ka istemal karte samay agar zamin aur samay izajit de to dhalwan ke upri taraf ke bipod shoe ke niche ki mitti khodkar, LMG ko zamin ke samantar karen, aisa karne se zaida sthirta milti hai agar zamin izajit na de to jis taraf dalwan hai us taraf ka bipod kholkar LMG ko zamin ke samanatar kiya jae. Sath hi us taraf ka paon ko fold karen jis taraf zamin ki dhalwan ho aisa karne se badan ko sthirta milegi. (e) Unchi Arh ya Fire Tranch ka Istemal Is prakar ki arh milte hi standing posn ka istemal karna chahiye jaise 4 se 4.5 ft ki arh ya fire trench is arh ka istemal karte samay jahan tak ho sake LMG se on bipod par hi fire Karen dhyan rakhen ki ejection ki karwai mein koi rukawat nahi honi chahiye. (a) ABHYAS Class se arhon karaya jaye. (b) (c) BHAG-II Action mein Handling ka abhyas 05 (d) LMG (e) 16 (f) Puri class se. (g) ki 120 (a) LMG ko action mein lane ke liye No-1 puri tarah se LMG aur saman ka nlrikshan karta hai. LMG ko make safe ki halat mein karta hai aur spare mag ko pouch mein band NAMUNA karta hai. Assy bag ko belt ke baen kinare mein lagata hai. Dahine hath se carrying handle ko pakarta hai aur No2 ki report ka intezar karta hai. No-2 carbine ka nirikshan karta hai. Carbine ko makesafe ki halat mein karta hai, mag ko pouch mein band karta hai aur No-1ko report deta hai No-2 ka hathiyar saman thik. No-2 ka report mil jane ke baad No-1 sec cdr ko report deta hai No-1 LMG group action mein handlimg ke liye taiyar .Trg ke dauran yeh karwai sthan lo ya take post ke adesh par kiya jata hai. LMG, mag, drill carts, CMG, mag, drill carts, assy bag. 05 21 Bayan ke sath namuna diya jaye. (b) No-1 LMG Gp take post ke addesh per class se No-1 aur No-2 sthan leten hain aur ustad unki karwai ko check karta hai sath hi unki galtion ko sudarta hai .No-1 LMG group harkat ke liye tayiar ke report per ustad LMG group ke picche aa jata hai aur unko axis of advance deta hai. Suraksha ke hisab se class unke dahine se harkat karta hai. Ustad LMG group ko sakhat fire ka addesh deta hai. Arh pakarne ke baad LMG No2 ko line tor ka addesh deta hai aur khud No-2 ki duty ka bayan ke sath namuna deta hai, Is samay class ko apne pass close karta hai. Mag ki Badli. LMG thik fire karta rukata ke addesh per 121 No-1 LMG ko cock karta hai aur HOD lagata hai aur sath hi mag ko utarta hai, No-2 baen hath se bhara hua mag No-1 ko deta hai aur No-1 mag ko LMG par chara deta hai aur chaal wale purjon ko age jan deta hai sath hi fire ko jari karta hai. 5 (a) (b) (c) Gas ki Kami ki Rok. LMG ek ya do round ke bad rukta ke addesh per No-1 LMG ko cock karta hai aur tab tak kalme wali ungali ko bahar rakhta hai jab tak No-2 Gas regulator ki posn Low se High par nahi kar deta. No2 pukarta hai Low se High par, is samay No 1 LMG ko fire mein shamil karta hai. (d) (e) (f) (g) Fire Nahi. No-1 LMG ke mag ko utarta hai aur LMG ko cock karta hai aur sikhe hue tariqe se LMG ko kholta hai firing pin aur extractor ko check karta hai . Agar inmein se koi purja tuta hua ho to sikhe hue trariqe se uski badali karta hai agar dono thik ho to chamber mein kata hua case ho sakta hai, is par No-1 LMG ko jor deta hai aur LMG ko cock karte huye HOD lagata hai. N-2 clearing plug ke base aur centre pin ko tight karta hai aur No-1 ko deta hai, No-1 clearing plug ko chamber mein dakhil karta hai aur chal wale purjon ko age jane deta hai. LMG ko cock katra hai aur HOD ko lagata hai sath hi yaqin karta hai ki kata hua case clearing plug ke sath kata hua case bahar aa gaya hai. No-1 butt kandhe ka milap karta hai. No2, No-1 ko bhara bua mag deta 122 hai, No-1 mag ko chadhata hai aur LMG ko fire mein shamil karta hai. No-2 unscrew ki karwai karta hai. One Two Badli. Agar No1casulaty ho jae to No-2, No-1 ko LMG se alag karta hai uske upper se jakar No-1 ki jagah leta hai aur LMG ko fire mein shamil karta hai. Dobara Harkat ke liye taiyar ho . Is addesh par LMG ko make safe Karen jis prakar arh ko pakra tha usi prakar se arh ko chora jaye. Jate samay pure saman ko check Karen. Agar wahan per LMG ko make safe karne ka mauka na mile to change lever ki posn ‘S’ per karen aur munasib arh ke paas pahunch kar make safe Karen. 6 (a) 7. (b) ABHYAS SANKSH EP (c) Arh pakarne, chhorne aur handling ka abhyas karaya jaye. Q1. 1 se 1.5 feet ki arh ko kaun se posn se istemal kiya jata hai ? Ans. Lying posn se. Q2. Gol arh ko kis taraf se istemal kiya jata hai ? Ans. Aam taur par dahine taraf se. (d) (e) (f) 15 36 04 40 (g) Puri class ko No1 LMG Gp mank ar abhya s karay en. 123 ************************************************************************************ LMG-IN 46-53 5.56mm INSAS LMG KE UPAR ISTEMAL HONE WALE SIGHTON KE BARE MEIN JANKARI DENA TARTIB S/NO TEACHING POINTS (a) 1. (b) SHURU SHURU KA KAAM 2. DOHRAI 3. PAHUNCH 5.56mm INSAS (c) (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant. (b) Hathiyar saman ka nirikshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. Q1. 1 se 1.5’ ki arh ko kaun se posn se istemal kiya jata hai ? Ans. Lying posn se. Q2. LMG Gp mein No-2 pi posn kahan hoti hai ? Ans. Aam taur par No-1 ke baen. LMG ke upar alag alag prakar ke sighton ki suvidha di gai hai, jisse is hathiyar ki kabiliyat badh jati hai. Is hathiyar ke upar 4 prakar ki sighton ka istemal kiya jata hai. Zaruri hai ki TRG AIDS (d) TIME Actual Running (e) (f) 01 01 01 01 02 03 REMARKS (g) Nirikshan class se karaya jaye. Pichhle lesson se. Chhota aur sabak se sambandhit. 124 firer ko sighton ke bare mein achhi jankari ho taki samay parne par munasib sighton ka istemal karte huye fire karke dushman ko asani se barbad kar sake. 2 (a) 4. (b) UDDESH (c) 5.56mm INSAS LMG ke upar Istemal honewale Sighton ke bare mein Jankari dena Hai. 5. SAMAN 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT (d) (e) 01 (f) 04 (g) Dohraya jaye. 5.56mm INSAS LMG, Mag, TDLS, PNS, Beta Light Sight, Black Bd, Chalk, Duster, Ground Sheet. 01 05 Point karke bataya jaye. Sabak ko tartibwar chalaya jayega. 01 06 Class ki asani ke liye. 50 56 Open Sight (a) Fore Sight. Fore sight protractor, fore sight tip (pole type), fore sight tip locking nut. Zeroing ke dauran upar neeche ki galti fore sight tip ko munasib upar neeche ki harkat dekar dur ki jati hai. Isko jiada se jiada 18 chakkar diya ja sakta hai lekin 16 chakkar diya jata hai. 100m ke rg par ek chakkar 4” ka farak dalta hai. Is prakar kul 64” ki galti ko dur ki ja sakti hai. 125 (b) Rear Sight. Rear sight slide type hai aur iske bed par 200 se 1000m tak ke ank khude huye hain. Sam ank baen aur visham ank dahine taraf hain. Iske hisse purje – Slide, Bed, Plunger, Aperture, Adjusting Wheel, Screw Axis Rear Sight. Jitna rg hasil karna ho us ank ke niche khudi hui line ke sath slide ke agle kinare ko milane par woh rg hasil hota hai. Zeroing ke dauran dayen baen ki galti rear sight se dur ki jati hai. Isko kul 14 chakkar diya ja sakta hai, lekin 12 chakkar diya jata hai. 100m rg par ek chakkar 4” ka farak dalta hai. Iske wheel ko pura ek chakkar dene par 20 click ki awaz aati hai. Ek click 100m par 5mm ka farak dalta hai. 3 (a) (b) (c) Telescopic Day Light Sight. Larai ki halat aur kam roshni ke dauran firer mansik aur sharirik thkawat ke karan open sight ko kargar tarike se istemal nahi kar pata hai. Firer ki firing kabiliyat aur accuracy badhane ke liye TDLS ka istemal kiya jata hai. (d) (e) (f) (g) (a) Tech Data (i) - 610 Gms. (ii) - 288mm (iii) - 9 degree (iv) - 4X Wazan Lambai Field of View Magnification 126 (v) Range - 800m (vi) Objective - Refractive (vii) Eye Piece - Fixed Focus Monocular Pattern (viii) Eye Clearance - 40mm (ix) Operating Temp - -40 degree se 55 degree (x) Storage Temp - -40 degree se 70 degree (b) Hisse Purje. Yeh mukhya taur par 5 assy ki bani hui hai. (i) Objective Glass Housing Assy Module. (ii) Erector Assy. (iii) Mounting Bracket Assy. (iv) Eye Piece. (v) Graticule Assy. Ismein 16 divisions hain, har ek division 200m rg par 50mm ka farak dalta hai. 4 (a) (b) (c) Graticule pattern mein ek vertical aur do horizontal equispaced bore sighting lines hain. Verticle bore sighting line ke neeche 6 dots diye gaye hain jo 200, 400, 500, 600, 700 aur 800m rg ko jahir karte hain. (d) (e) (f) (g) 127 (c) Istemal Karne ka Tarika. (i) Mounting. TDLS ko FRP case se bahar nikalen aur check karen. TDLS ke female dovetail ko LMG ke male dovetail mein slide karen. Thimble ko lock karen. (ii) Dismounting. Jab TDLS istemal na kiya ja raha ho to use LMG ke upar se utar dena chahiye. OG aur EP ko lagayen. Thible ko unlock karen aur TDLS ko age ki taraf slide karte huye utaren. TDLS ko FRP case mein band karen. 5 (a) (b) (c) Passive Ni Sight. 5.56mm INSAS LMG ke sath Passive Ni Sight di gai hai. Yeh ek compact, halka aur micro channel image intensifier system ke sidhant par kaam karne wali sight hai. Yeh sight raat ke waqt sitaron aur chand ki roshni ke dauran surveillance aur firing ke lie istemal kiya jata hai. (d) (e) (f) (g) (a) Tech Data (i) - 1.279 Kg (ii) - 281mm (iii) - 10 degree (iv) - 4X (v) Wazan Lambai Field of View Magnification Range 128 - Detection - 300m Recognition – 200m (vi) Objective - Refractive (vii) Eye Piece - Monocular Variable Focus -5D to +5D (viii) Eye Clearance - 22mm (ix) Sensor - 18mm Micro Channel Image Intensifier Tube (x) Operating Temp - -30 degree se 45 degree (xi) Storage Temp - -30 degree se 65 degree (xii) II Tube ki life - 2000 Hrs (b) Hisse Purje. Yeh mukhya taur par 5 assy ki bani hui hai. (i) Objective Glass Housing Assy Module. (ii) Tube Housing Module (Image Intensifier tube, Reticle assy, power supply unit). (iii) Eye Piece. 6 (a) (b) (c) Power Supply Unit (ON/OFF Switch, Potentiometer, Battery Housing) (d) (e) (f) (g) (iv) Graticule Assy. Ismein 16 divisions hain, har ek division 100m rg par 30mm ka farak dalta hai. Graticule pattern mein ek vertical aur do horizontal equispaced bore sighting lines hain. Verticle bore sighting line ke neeche 1 dot diya gaya hain jo 200m rg ko jahir karta 129 hain. (c) Istemal Karne ka Tarika. (i) Mounting. PNS ko FRP case se bahar nikalen aur check karen. PNS ke female dovetail ko LMG ke male dovetail mein slide karen. Thimble ko lock karen. (ii) Dismounting. Jab PNS istemal na kiya ja raha ho to use LMG ke upar se utar dena chahiye. OG aur EP ko lagayen. Thible ko unlock karen aur PNS ko age ki taraf slide karte huye utaren. PNS ko FRP case mein band karen. 7 (a) (b) (c) (d) Precautions. (i) Tej roshni ya dhoop ke waqt OG aur EP cap na nikalen. (ii) Lens ko hath na lagayen. (iii) ON/OFF switch ko istemal karte waqt OFF posn mein rakhen. (iv) Batteries ko thik se +ve aur –ve marking dekh kar fit karen. (v) Knobs aur thimble par jor na lagayen. (vi) Agar sight lambe samy tak istemal na kiya ja raha ho to kisi andhere kamre mein har 15 din mein ek baar 15 min ke liye sight ko ON karke (d) (e) (f) (g) 130 rakhen. Beta Light Sight. Beta Light Sight ka istemal karte huye iron sight dwara raat ke samay LMG se shisht lekar fire kar sakte hain. Roshni dene ke liye glass tube mein tritium gas bhari hui hoti hai. Front beta light sight ko gas block ke upar fore sight ke peechhe aur rear beta light sight ko leaf ke upar lagaya jata hai. Donon front aur rear beta light iron sight flip type hain aur jab istemal na ho raha ho to inhen neeche gira diya jata haih. ABHYAS 7. Class se abhyas karaya jaye. Mounting aur Dismounting ka bhi abhyas karaya jaye. 22 78 SANKSHEP Q1. LMG par kitni prakar ki 02 80 sighten istemal ki jati hain ? Ans. Teen prakar ki. Q2. Telescopic sight ka rg kitna hai ? Ans. 800m. ************************************************************************************* ************************************************************************************* ********************************************************************************** (3) 7.62 mm SELF LOADING RIFLE( SLR) SLR 1-2 7.62 MM SELF LOADING RIFLE SE WAQFIAT,SAFETY,KOLNA ,JORNA AUR SAFAI 131 ZARURI TECTICAL DATA Ustad ke gyan ke liye rifle ke bare kuch jaru ri baten niche di gayi hai : (a) Rifle ki 7.62MM Bolt action 7.62MM SLR lambai 1117.60MM -1126.50MM (1) Chote butt 1130.30MM -1139.20MM (2) Normal butt 1145.50MM 1151.90MM (3) Lamba butt (b) Bayonet ke sath lambai (c) Barrel ki lambai (d) Grooves (e) Khali Rifle ka bajan (f) Rifile aur bahri magazine ka bajan (g) Bayone ka bajan (h) Magazine ka bajan (1) Khali (2) Bhari 1435.10MM 640MM 5 3.934kg 0.483kg - - - -1397.00MM -533.40MM 6 -4.4kg -5.1kg -0.283 kg -0.255kg -0.709kg 132 (i) Sight redius (j) Muzzle (K)velocity - 743.71 Mtrs per second -0.553MM 815 mtrs per second (2700 ft) SAFETY, KHOLNA AUR SAFAI UDDESH Rifle se waqfiat karna, rifle ko kholna, jorna aur safai karna sikhna hai. SAMAN Rifle magazine, bayonet, scabbard, seling, oil bottle, phultru, cleaning kit box aur drill cartridges. PAHUNCH Rifle jawan ka jati hathiyar hai, issliye rifle ko thik halat mein rakhna jawan ki apni jimmewari ha. Agar ek jawan apni rifle magazine aur ammuniation ko saf rakhta hai aur thik tarah se uski dekhbal karta hai to rifle kabhi bhi jarurat parne par dhoka nahi degi. SHURU SHURU KA KAM (SURAKSHA SAMBANDHI UPAY) Rifle ka mulahiza karne ki liye “NIKRAKSHAN KE LIYE JANCH SASHTR KE LIYE” ke hukam par karwai is prakar karo : (a) Baen paon ko age lo sath hi rifle ko dahine hath se badan ke samne is prakar uchalo ki rifle baen hath se hand guard aur dahine hath se pistol grip se pakri jaye. Muzzle upar rifle taqriban 45* ke angle par ho. (b) Yakin karo ki safty catch ‘S’ par hai aur rifle ko cock karo. Cock karne ke liye cocking handle ko khara karo aur piche kincho. Agar baen hath ki bich wali ungli se holding opening catch ko lagao aur baen hath hand guard par le jao. (c) Apni rifle to thoda aur baen taraf turn karo aur ijection slot se dekho ki magazine aur chamber khali hai. (d) Apni rifle ko dekho aur apni jagah jao. Sqd ko batao ki is ke age ap karwai nahi karenge “CHAL WALE PURJE AGE KAR” ke hukam par karwai is prakar karo : Cocking handle pura piche kincho aur age jane do. Safety catch ko dahine hath ke anguthe se ‘R’ par karo aur trigger dabao. Safety catch’S’ par karo, rifle ko niche lao aur dono gutno ke bich mein pakaro. (e) Pouch se khali magazine aur drill cartridge nikalo, mulahiza karo. Mulahiza ke bad magazine aur drill cartiridge ko pouch mein band karo aur rifle ko pakarkar sabdhan mein khade ho jao, ustad apni rifle rakh kar sqd ki rifle ka mulhaiza kare, uske bad apni magazine aur drill cartiradge ko dekhe, phir pouch mein band karke sqd ki magazine ko drill cartiradge ka mulahiza kare aur yakin kare ki magazine khali hai aur prade par koi zinda round toh nahi hai. Pouch mein band kare aur button band kare. Rifle ko dahine hath mein pakro aur aram se khare ho jao. 133 BAYAN Yeh suraksha sambandhi upay in moukon par zarur kar lene chahie. (a) Sabaq, abhiyas aur range p[ar fire karne se pahle aur bad mein. (b) Camp duty ya petrol se bapis ane ke bad. (c) Rifle ko lete samaye aur dete samaye. (d) Jab bhari hui rifle kisi ko deni ho toh safty catch ‘S’ par aur muzzle ko surakshit disha mein karte hue di jaye. Sath hi lene wale ko bata diya jaye ki rifle bhari hui hai. (e) Kabhi mazak mein bhi muzzle kisi sathi ki taraf mat karo. ABHIYAS Sawal-o-jawab se abhiyas lo. KHOLNA SHURU SHURU KA KAM (a) Yakin karo ki rifle khali hai. (b) Safety catch ‘S’ apr karo aur magazine utaro. (c) Rifle ko cock karo. Yeh baat khas dhyan dene ki hai, ki bagair cock kiye rifle ko na khola jaye. (d) Stud ko dabate hue bayonet ko utaro, yakin karo ki back sight slight pura piche hai aur leaf niche baithi hui hai. GAS PLUG AUR PISTON (a) Jab ki gas plug wala ammuniation fire karne ke liye set hota hai (gas plug ka katao wala hissa upar hota hai) toh gas plug plunger ko drill cartiradge ya combination tool ki madad se dabao aur gs plug ko gahri ki suian ke rukh mein ghumao, taki plug gas block se alag ho jaye. Agar gas plug grenade firing ke liye set hai (ab ki katao wala bhag niche ki taraf hota hai) to gas plug par kholte waqt dabao rakho taki gas plug ucchal kar dur na gir pade. (b) Piston aur spring ko bahar nikalo. Piston ko spring se alag karne ke liye, isko ghuma ghuma kar nikalo. SLIDE AUR BRIDGE BLOCK (a) Baen hath se hand guard ko majbooti se pakro. Muzzle niche ki taraf. (b) Body locking catch ko piche khinchte hue butt ko niche badakar rifle ko todo. (c) Jab is tarah se rifle khuli ho to kabhi bhi hammer par qabu paye bagiar trigger ko na dabaen. Nahi to trigger mechanism kharab ho jayega. (d) Body cover ko piche kinchte hue utar do. (e) Return rod ko pakar kar piche kincho. Bridge block ko niche girne se rokne ke liye uske niche ungli rakho. (f) Return rod apni taraf rakhte hue slide ulta karo. Bridge block ko slide mein pua bich mein karo. Byen hath ki unglion se bridge block k 134 eagle kinare ko uthao aur unguthe se firing pin ke pichle wale hisse k odabate hue bridge block ko slide se alag kar do. JORNA Bridge block aur slide (a) Slide ko ulta pakaro. Dayen hath se bridge block ko uthao aur firing pin ka dusra hissa slide ke surakh mein dal do. Bridge block ko thoda piche dabate hue slide mein thik se bithao. (b) Rifle ko uthao, muzzle niche ki taraf karo, slide aur bridge block ko baen hath se uthao, bridge block ke niche ungli rakhte hue slide eur bridge block ko body ke ander dakhil karo aur body cover ko laga do. (c) Yakin karo ki safety catch ‘S’ par hai. Rifle ko band karo(agar rifle ka safety catch ‘R’ par rakh kar jor to ho sakta hai rifle na jure, trigger na dabe aur safety catch na lage).Isko dur karne ke liye rifle ko kholo, safety catch ko ‘S’ par karo aur jor do, jorne se pahle yakin karo ki returning spring rod butt ke centre ki sidh mein hai. Agar aisa nahi hoge to rod aur butt cap dono ko nuksan hoga. Piston aur gas plug (a) Piston spring kisi bhi taraf se pistion par charao, yeh dhyan rakhen ke spring piston agle upari sire tak pahunche. (b) Piston aur spring ko cylinder mein dakhil karo aur gas plug ko lagate hue ulta niche lagao yahan tak ki plug asani se ja sake. Drill cartradige ya combination tool ki madad se, gas plug plunger ko dabao aur gas plug ko ghari ki suion ke ulte rukh itna ghumao ki plug ka kata hua hissa upar aa jaye. Plunger par dabao ko hatao aur yakin karo ki gas plug thik se judh gaya hai. (Rifle wala ammuniation fire karne ke liye tayar hai. Agar rifle grenade fire ke liye tayar karne ho to gas plug ko iske ult ghumao. Abhiyas : Kholne aur jorne ka abhiyas karao. Magazine kholna : Magazine ko kholne se pahle se iske spring ko dabakar test karo. Ab magazine ko baen hath mein is taraf pakaro, ki bottom plate upar ki taraf aur magazine ki bhari side age ki taraf ho. Retainer stud ko itna niche dabao ki bottom plate azad ho jaye, ab bottom plate ko ahista nikalo, dahine rahe ki magazine spring ke upar baen hath ke anguthe se kabu rakh jaye. Magazine spring aur plate form ko alag karo, magazine ko us halat mein khopla jaye, jab ki uski safai zarurai hai, taki spring jaldi kamzor na ho jaye. Jorna : Magazine plate form, spring aur retainer ko magazine case ke andher dalo, spring ko dabate hue bottom plate ko lagado. Yakin karo ki retainer stud thik se bahar nikal aye. Platform ko dabate hue magazine ko check karo. Abhiyas :Isi kam ka. SAFAI 135 Yeh zarurai hai rifle ko saf aur acchi halat mein rakha jae. Iski safai ke liye yeh saman hota hai : (a) Rifle ke butt ke ander. Is ke ander ek pullthrouh aur ek oil bottle hoti hai, phulthrough se barrel aur cylinder dono saf kiye jate hai. Phulthrough ka wazan kalam tarash hota hai, jo ki gas plug, cylinder ke upari hisse aur flash hinder se fouling saf karne ke liye istemal mein laya jata hai. Jo tel ordance mila hai usi ka istemal kiya jaye. (b) Cleaning kit box saman : (1) Ek combination tool gas regulator, ki screw driver, swivel jis par ki cylinder chamber cleaning brush lagaya ja sakta hai aur fore-sight adjust karne wala tool hota hai. (2) Cylinder chamber cleaning brush. (3) Rifle cleaning brush. (4) Graphite grease ka tube. (5) Chindi. ROZANA KI SAFAI (a) Yeh yakin kare ki bad ki rifle khali hai, rifle ko sikhe hue tariqe se khol do. (b) Combination tool par chamber cleaning brush lagakar chamber ki safai karo. (c) Barrel ki safai : (1) Pulthrough ko pura kholo aur yakin karo ki yeh istemal ke kabil hai. (2) 10 X 5cm ki chindi bich wale loop mein lagao. Akhari loop (phanda) armour ke liye hota hai. Rifle ko band karo aur breech ki taraf se pulthrough dalo aur muzzle ki taraf se nikalo. Dhyan rahe ki rassi ka koi bhi hissa flash hioer ke sath ragar na khae. Yeh karwai us waqt tak karo jab tak rifle saf na ho jao. (3) Barrel mein 10X3.75 cm ki chindi ka istemal karte hue tel lagao. (d) Cylinder ki safai : Phulthrough ko cylinder ke age wale hisse se dalo, niche wali taraf se nikal do aur phultrough ke dono kinaron ko pakarte hue cylinder ki satai karo. Dahyan rakhen ki kabhi bhi chindi cylinder ke niche wale ya chote surakh mein na dakhil ho aur rassi ka koi bhi hissa cylinder ke sath ragar na khaye, chindi ka size 10X5cm hai. (e) Cylinder mein tel lagana 10X5cm. Chindi ka istemal karte hue tel ka istemal karo. (f) Brush aur tel wale kapre ka istemal karte hue niche wale hisse ki safai karo : 136 (1) Body ke andher wale hisse khas taur par guide grooves, chaber ki diwar hammer aur trigger mechanism ejector, locking shoulder, safety ser aur magazine catch. (2) Slide aur body cover, safai ke bad in ko jor do aur rifle ko band kar do. (3) Gas plug, piston, rodf aur spring ko saf karo aur jor do. (4) Flash hider bayonet base force sight, gas block aur gas regulator, seling swivel aur hand guard, yakin karo ki hand guard ke do fouling poles aur cylinder saf hai. Body ka bahar wala hissa cocking handle, safety catch, trigger aur trigger guard, butt frame, joint pin, magazine catch, houlding opening catch, back side aur carring handle pistol grip, butt lower selling, swivel aur butt plate. (5) Magazine filler ander/bahar se saf karo. (6) Bayonet aur scabbard saf karo aur jod do. (g) Rozana ki safai ke bad ki karwai (1) Oil bottle pulthrough ko butt trap mein band karo. (2) Cleaning kit box ka sab saman wapis box mein band karo. KHAS ILAQON MEIN SAFAI (a) Namindar ilaqe mein (bavan). Aam ilaqe ki safai ki tarah hi is ilaqe mein safai karo. Lakin rifle ka mulhaiza bar bar karo. Khas taur par yadi jung laga hai to use saf karo aur tel lagado. (b) Retile va gardile ilaqe mein (1) Aise ilaqe mein zarurai hai ki rifle ke chal wale purje aur magazine bilkul sukhi, khas taur par firing pin aur extractor khol karke bridge block ko acchi tarah se sukhane ke liye dyr cleaning solvent (Safai wale lotion) ka istemal kiya jaye ya rifle ko doop mein rakh kar sweat (rasne diya) kiya jaye aur jo tel nikalta hai use saf kiya jaye. Cleaning brush ko sabun aur pani se dhone ke bad sukhakar istemal kiya jaye. Magazine ko ubalte hue pani mein dal kar saf Karen. (2) Is tarah se rifle ko sukha karne ke bad mein jung lagne ka khatra ha, agar jung lag jata hai to tel lagakar utaro aur rifle ko kushak kar lo. (c) Barfani ilaqe mein : Jab ilaqe bahut sard ho to rifle ko khushak rakho aur lo cold test tel ka istemal karo. Abhiyas Safai par aur sawalo jabaw se. SANKSHEP (1) Sawal-o-jawab se. (2) Thik se rifle kholna aur jorna safai aur sambhal ki ahimat par zor do. 137 Instructor’s Note (a) Sabaq ke dauran rifle ke jis hisse ke purje ka istemal Karen, uske hisse purjon kenam mote taur par unke kam sath sath batate jao. (b) Jawan ko batao ki rifle ko cock karne ke liye cocking handle ko pura piche aur puri taur par chod do, kabhi bhi cocking handle ko pakre chal wale purjon ko age na jane do. (c) Kabhi kabhi khuli rifle ki seling ko tight na kiya jaye, aisa karne se body hinge pin body locking catch par jor parta hai aur butt selling loop ke damage hone ka khatra hai. Hamesha pahle rifle puri jodh li jaye aur bad mein seling lagaya jaye ya tight kiya jaye. --------------------------------*******************------------------------SLR 3-4 MAGAZINE BHARNA, SIGHT LAGANA, RIFLE BHARNA AUR KHALI KARNA SHURU KA KAM Suraksha sambandhi upay. DOHRAI Rifle kholne aur jorne ki mashq aur sawal-o-jawab. UDDESH Magazine bharna, sight lagana bharna, khali karna aur make sale ki sikhlai dena hai. Saman Rifle, magazine, drill cartiradges, charger clip aur filler. PAHUNCH Is rifle se bagair rim wala ammuniation fire kiya jata. Ek charger mein 5 round ate hai aur 10 charger ek baddolier mein band hokar ate hai. Jahan tak ho sake ammuniation ko dhup, nami aur barish se bachaya jaye aur har waqt saf rakha jaye. MAGAZINE KA BHARNA 138 Ammuniation ki safai Charger ka khali karna aur bharna : Yad rakho ki rokon se bachne ke liye bharne se pahle ammuniation ko acchi tarh se saf kar lena chahie, rounds ko clip se nikalo, saf kapde se saf kar aur charger clip ki spring rounds ke painda se dabate hue rounds ko charger mein bhar do. Bharte samaye rounds ka painda clip plate (Spring) ke sath thik baitha ho. Hath se bharna : Magazine bharne se pahle uska mulhaiza karo, magazine aur spring ko check karo aur dekho ki magazine case kahin se daba to nahi hai phir magazine ko kisi hath se is prakar is prakar se pakro ki bhari side bahar ki taraf ho, dusre hath se munasib round is prakar bharo ki round ka painda ap se door wali magazine wali diwar se mil jaye, magazine bharte waqt round ki ginti ki jaye agar koi rounad niche gir jata hai toh us ke bad mein aur saf karke bharo. Am taur par magazine mein 20 round bhare jate hai lakin retile ya gradile ilaqe mein, rok se bachne ke liye 15 round bahre jate hai. Filler se magazine bharna : Filler ko magazine mein fit karne ke liye charger guide ko magazine ki bhari side ki taraf rakhte hue, upar ko fit karo, magazine ke is prakar se pakro ki magazine bhari side apni taraf ho. Charger ko lo aur charger guide mein rakho, upar se anguthe se itna dabao ki char ger ka upar wala round magazine ki lips mein phas jaye. Ab charger clip ko nikal do, is prakar se zarurat ke mutabik round bharo aur filler ko magazine se alag kar do. SIGHT LAGANA Back side ke teen bade hisse hote hai. Bed, slide aur leaf, leaf ko khada kiya ja sakta hai aur is mein aperture hota hai. Bed par teen se lekar 6 tak hindse khude hue hote hai, jo ki 300 se 600 gaz ki range ko jahir karte hai, jab slide pura piche hota hai to side 200 gaz laga hota hai. Sight lagane ke liye catch ko dabate hue slides ko itni harkat do ki zarurat shuda range wala number slade ke pichle bhag mein dhikegirane ke liye. Slide ko itna piche 139 kincho ki leaf bed par zarurat ke mutabik range ka number aa jaye. Am taur par sight 200 gaz par laga hona chahie. Abhiyas sight lagane ka RIFLE BHARNA AUR KHALI KARNA Jab rifle par bhari magazine chadi hui aur safety catch ‘S’par ho to rifile bhari mani jati hai. Jab rifle cock hoti hai aur chamber ke ander zinda round hota hai aur safety catch’R’par ho to rifle ready mani jati hai. Jab rifle par khali magazine hoti hai aur chamber mein round nahi hota hai aur safety catch ‘S’ ho to rifle khali mani jati hai. Ready : Ready ka hukam milne par, range milne par jab target dikhai de rifile ko cock karo, yakin karo ki chamber mein round chala gaya hai, safety catch ‘R’ par karo aur kalmen wali ungli trigger par ho. MAKE SAFE : “Make safe” ke hukam par karwai is prakaro : (a) Kalmen wali ungli trigger se alag karo. Safety catch ko ‘S’par karo, pouch ka button kholo, bhara hua magazine utaro aur pouch mein rakho. (b) Rifle ko dahine tarraf karte hue cocking ko piche kincho aur yakin karo ki chamber wale round niche(Bahir) ghir gaye hai. Cocking handle ko age jane do. (c) Safety catch ko ‘R’ par karo aur trigger dabao. (d) Safety catch ‘S’ par karo. (e) Bhari hui magazine chrao. (f) Zamin par ghire hue round ko uthao, saf karo aur dusre magazine mein bhar do aur pouch mein band kar do. KHALI KAR : “Khali kar” ke hukam par make safe ki karwai karo. Sirf akhir mrin bhari hui magazine ki bajai khali, magazine charo aur yeh karwai sawal-o-jawab se karo. Abhiyas : Magazine bharna rifle bharna, ready, make safe aur khali kar. SANKSHEP 1. Squad se sawal-o-jawab se. 2. Squad ko khas taur par yeh baten batayi jayen : (a) Ammuniation ki safai. (b) Tezi aur sahi tariqe se rifle ko bharna aur khali karna. Tezi ke bajae brust par zaida zor diya jaye. -------------------------------------*******************-------------------SLR 5-6 FIRE KARNA SHURU KA KAM Suraksha sambandhi upaye. Dohrai Durust pakar aur shist lene ki dohrai. UDDESH Lying position se rifile se fire karna sikhana hai. SAMAN 140 Rifle, magazine, drill cartiradges, eye disc,32X32cm target aur firing data card. PAHUNCH Rifle se chahe kisi bhi position se fire kiya jaye, is ke mul sidanth ek hi jaise hai, who yeh hai : (a) Rifle ko majbooti se pakaro, khas kar dahine hath se joki controlling hath hai(sahi prakar). (b) Bagair shist hilaye fire karo. FIRE KI QISMEN Larai mein teen prakar ke fire ki zarurat parti hai : (a) Delebrate. (b) Snapshooting. (c) Rapid fire. DELIBRATE FIRE Who fire hai jab kisi zamini nishan ko dekhkar ya dushman ke fire ka faisla ya dona ko dekh kar, shatru ki position janch kar us par fire karte hai. Aise fire us waqt bhi kiya jata hai, jab ki kam lambhe range par munasib hathiyar ka istemal karke target ko barbad karte hai. Hukam “Let kar position”, ‘Ready”, “Bhar” ya range do : (a) Fire ke hukam par safety catch ‘R’ par karo aur shist lo. (b) Sans par qabu rakhte hue, jab sight picture accha mil jata hai aur rifle kam se kam harkat karti hai, to ahista se trigger dabao. (c) Fallow through: Har ek goli ko follow through kare. Fire hone ke bad chand seconds ke liye majboot pakad kayam rakho, aisa karne se 141 firer ko goli lagne ki jagah aur aiming pointing ke bich ka anter malum ho jayega. (d) Trigger par se dabao kohota hai aur rifle ko niche lao. (e) Dobara kandhe mein jayen aur 1 minute mein 5 round ke hisab se fire karo. Firing ke dauran magazine mein bache hue round ki dil mein ginti rakho. Fire data card : Delibration fire ka namuna dene ke bnad ustad khade hoke batyen ki firing data card kaise bhara jata hai : (a) Firing data card mein do target hote hai : (1) Call out : Firer fire karte samaye jo bolega uske anusar target par nishan laga de, yeh nishan coach lagayega. (2) Hit target : Fire ki goli ki jagah ko dekh kar hit target mark kiya jata hai. (3) Agar in dono targets ke nishan ek dusre se milte hai, to firer ki tamam karwaian thik hai. Note Is baat par khas zor diya jaye ki jab tak rifle thik zero nahi hai tab tak yeh zaruri nahi ki goli shist wali jagah par hi lage isliye zero karne se pahle agar jawan ki goli thik jagah na lage to unhe gabrana nahi chahie aur “Fallow through” karke har goli ko pukarna chahie taki yeh baat adat mein shamil ho jaye. Jab rifle zero ho jati hai tab jawan ko thik natija hassil hoga. Abhiyas Delibrate fire ka abhiyas karo. SNAPSHOOTING Chand second ke liye nazar ane wale target par jo fire kiya jata hai use snap shooting fire kahte hai. RAPID FIRE Jab ki golian jo ki lagatar aur jaldi se fire ki janyen aise fire ko rapid fire kahte hai. Yeh fire bhi snapshooting jaisa hi hai farq sirf itna hai ki isme zaida round fire kiya jata hai. Abhiyas se fire is qabil hona chahie ki who mukhtalif target par ek minute 20 round ya is se zaida durusti se fire kar sake. Rapid fire ke dauran jab fire na ho to rifle ko thanda kiya jaye. Aisa karne ke liye cocking handle ko piche se kincho aur holding open catch lagao. Is se garam chamber se zaida round bahar aa jayega aur chamber aur bore mein se thandi hawa guzaragi. Doubara fire karne ke liye cocking handle ko thoda piche kincho aur age jane do. Abhiyas Squad ko aur bhi zaida abhiyas is prakar do : (a) Sab magazine khali kra do. (b) Drill cartiradger ka istemal na karte hue squad ko do ya teen ki tolion mein banto aur sab qism ki firing ka abhiyas do. (c) Pahle duruati aur phir tezi ka asul mat bhulo. SANKSHEP 142 (a) Squad se sawal-o-jawab se. (b) Students ke tariqe ke tariqe ke bare mein jo unhone ki hai batao. Note ki baten (a) Ek firer ko thik tarah se fire karna ho to range par hi sikhaya ja sakta hai, lakin is squad mein uski firing ka durust tariqa bataya ja sakta hai sath hi uski pakar ko majboot banana ke bare mein bataya jaye. (b) Shuru ke abhiyas ke bad, tranning mein vastivakta lane ke liye agar jawan figure target par fire kar raha ho to do do aur agar eye dise ka istemal ho raha ho to teen teen ki tolion mein bant do. Do do ki tolion mein ek jawan fire karta hai jab ki dusra uske bina gutne tikate hue rifle ka trigger dabate hue rifle ko cock karta hai. Jab eye dise ka istemal kiya jata hai to teen teen ki tolion mein kam kiya jaye. Is mein 1 eye dice dikahata hai, ek fire karta hai jab ki tesra cock karta hai. Jab eye dise ya zinda target ka istemal kar rahe ho, to drill cartiradge ka hargis histemal na kiya jaye. (c) Jab ustad khud namuna de to woh wahin rifle ko cock karne ke liye ek jawan ko bulaye. (d) Jab rifle fire ke bad automatic cock, load aur lock hoti hai, to dacha sidha balance aur mamuli hota hai. Dusre adami ki madad se cock ki karwai par side mein jhatka parta hai, lakin firer ko apni position se harkat na karni pade, isliye dusra jawan cock karta hai ------------------------------------*******************---------------------- DOHRAI (a) (b) (c) ke). (d) SLR 7-8 RIFLE KI CHAL AUR HONE WALI ROKEN Rifle ke kholne aur jortne ki dohrai lo. Ek rifle puri khali(ustad ke liye). Akhir mein rifle bhari aur ready position mein(bagair body cover Sabhi rifle ke body cover utre hue. UDDESH Rifle, ke chal rokon ke sabab unka bachao aur roken dur karne ka tariqa sikhana hai. SAMAN Rifle, magazine,drill cartridges 32X32 cm target chal ka diagram, cleaning kit box carinn plug aur cuta hua case. PAHUNCH Agar ek jawan ko rifle ki chal malum ho to use rokon ke sabab ko malum karna aur unhe dur karna asan ho jata hai. 143 CHAL (a) Jab riger ko dabaya jata hai to hammer azad hokar firing pin retainer par thok kar marta hai. Jis se firing pin apni suraksha se nikal kar chamber wale round ke pained mein cap par thokar marta hai, jis se goli fire hoti hai. (b) Goli fire hone par gas paida hoti hai, jo ki goli ko age barrel mein dakelti hai, jab goli gas bent kr pas se pahunchti hai to kuch gas bent se gas plug ki jhiri hoti hai. Gas cylinder mein dakhil ho jati hai aur piston ko piche dakelti hai. Kuch gas regulator ke surakh se bahar nikal jati hai, kitni gas bahar nikalti hai, yeh gas regulator ki setting par nirbhar hai. (c) Jab pistion piche ki harkat karta hai to uska pichla hissa slide k eagle bhag par thokar marta hai jis se slide aur bridge block dono piche ki harkat karte hai ab piston apne spring ki takat se wapis age jata hai. (d) Ab rifle doubra fire karne ke liye tayar hai (judi hui rifle par bhi chal, sawal-o-jawab se samjao). 144 ABHIYAS Jawan apni rifle dekhen aur jawab den. FAURI ILAJ AUR ROKEN Agar rifle saf hai aur gas regulator thik tarah se set hua hai to rifle mein bahut hi kam roken parege. FAURI ILAJ “LET KAR POSITION” “READY” SAME TARGET FIRE AGAR RIFLE SHURU SE HI FIRE NA KARE, YA FIRE KARTE KARTE RUK JAYE TOH FAURI ILAJ KI KARWAI IS PRAKAR KARO : (a) Kalmen wali ungli trigger se alag karo aur rifle ko niche lao. Cocking handle ko pura piche kincho aur holding open catch lagao. (b) Agar rifle ko thoda piche aur baen tariqa karo aur ijection slot se ander dekho : (1) Agar magazine bhari hui hai aur chamber mein round laga hua hai to firing pin ki badly karo. (2) Agr firing pin bahar nikala hua nahi hai, to latke hue round ko bahar nikalo aur doubara fire zari karo. (3) Agar chamber aur magazine dono khali hai to magazine ki badly karo aur purjon ko age jane do aur doubara fire jari kao. (4) Gas ki kami ki rok : Agar fauri ilaj karne ke bad bhi, rifle 1 ya 2 round fire karne ke bad ruk jaye aur mulhiza karne par magazine bhara aur chamber khali ho to chal wale purjon ko age jane do. Safety catch ‘S’ par lagao aur regulator ko pahle se chote no. par set karo. Safety catch ko’R’ par lagao kandhe mein jao aur doubara fire jari karo. Abhiyas : Squad se gas ki kami ka abhiyas karao. ANYA ROKEN : Agar rokon ko dur karne ki karwai karne ke bad bhi rifle fire na kare is ke sabab purjo ki tut-phut ya puri tarah se folding ho sakti hai. Rifle ka mulhiza is prakar karo : (a) Saftey catch ko ‘S’ par karo, magaxzine utaro, rifle ko cock karo aur bridge block ko nikalo,. Firing pin aur extractor ka mulhiza karo, agar in mein se koi purza tuta hai to badly karo. (b) Agar firing pin aur extractor tute na ho, to body cover ko utaro aur chamber mein dekho, Agar chamber mein kata hua case ho to rifle ko jor do. Cocking handle ko piche kincho, holding opning catch lagao, clearing plug ko joro. Clearing plug ko chamber mein dakhil karo. GARDILE AUR RETILE KE ILAQON MEIN KARWAI (a) Yeh rifle is prakar kji banayi gayi hai yeh kafi gardile retile ilaqe mein fire kar sakti hai, garda aur ret rifle ki body mein bane hue guide group slide mein bane hue katao mein ikatha ho jata hai jis se rifle thik tarah se fire karti rahti hai. (b) Agar bahut zaida dhul ya fahi ho to rifle ko ready ki halat mein rakho aur saftet catch ‘S’ par lagao, aisa karne mein chamber wala round gardhe ko chamber mein jane se rokega. 145 (c) Jab bhi mouka mile to rifle ko kholo, saf karo aur grease lagao. ABHIYAS Sawal-o-jawab se. SANKSHEP (a) Sawal-o-jawab se. (b) Is bat par khas zor doki agar rifle ki thik dekh bal ki jaye to kam rokne paregi. ---------------------***************-------------------------------SLR 9-12 TUBE LAUNCHING MK-I SE WAQFIAT AUR RIFLE GRENADE KO FIRE KARNE KA TARIQE SIKHANA 146 TARTIB S, NO 1. 2. TEACHING POINTS SHURU SHURU KA KAM (p) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (q) Tube launching,weap on aur saman ka nirakshan. (r) Bandobast ki karwai. DOHRA Q1 No 36 Hand Grenade ka mar dalne ka ilaqe kitna hai ? I TRG AIDS E TIM S REMARK As per 0 0 Ustad trg aids. 1 1 nirakshan khud Karen 1 0 2 0 HE Hand Gren ke visheshatye n per sawal Karen. 0 Sabaq se sambandat aur saaf aur chhota hona chahiye. Ans :- 8 Mtr charo taraf. Q2. 7 sec wala ignitor set ka kya pachan hoti hai? Ans :- Fuse ka colour pila aur chhalla nahin hota. 3. PAHUN CH No 36 Hand grenade ko ek jawan 25 se 35 gaz tak phank saketa hai lekin ismein 7 sec wala fuse lagakar rifle se fire karke kam se kam 50 m aur ziada se ziada 150 m tak gren ko dur gira kar dushman ko barbad kar sakte hain jo ki rifle se hum tube launching MK-I ki madad se aur HD carts ke sath fire karte hai. Is lie harek jawan ko rifle grenade ko fire karne ka tariqe achchhi tarah se ana chahiye. 1 0 3 147 4. H UDDES 5. SAMAN 6. BHAGO N MEIN BANT Tube Launching MKI se waqfiat aur No-36 HE Grenade ko rifle se fire karne ka tariqe sikhana hai. Tube Launching MKI, Grenade, Ignitor set, Drill carts, Arming ring, Rifle , Sand Bag, Fig 11 Tgt. Yeh sabaq tartibwar sikhaya jayaga. Tube Launching MK-I se Waqfiat Tube Launching MK-I ki banawat ek khokli nali se sakal mein hai. Jo ki ek taraf se khalui aur dusre taraf se band hota hai. Band wale sire par ek stud laga hota hai aur ismein churiyan bani hoti hai. Is stud ke zariye rifle grenade ke base plug bane surakh se fit kiya jata hai, khule wale surakh ke zarie tube ko band barrel mein bane hue jagah par charaya jata hai. Is hole ka rang OG colour ka hoat hai is ko nap taul is prakar hai. Lambai – 15 CM , Wazan - 127 gm. Tube par kuchh surakhen bane hue hote hain jis mein range control pin lagaya jata hai. Is grenade ko fire karne ke lie gren par ek arming ring lagaya jata hai, jo ki lever ko apni jagah se nikalne se rokhta hai. Arming ring ka wazan – 33 gm hai. 1 1 0 0 4 5 0 Uddesh ko dohayara jai. 0 Rifle, 2 2 Baen ke Grenade, 0 5 sath Tube naumna . launchin g MK-I, HD Carts , Ground sheet, Sand Bag. 148 Visheshtyan (i) 50, 100, aur 150 m tak fire kar sakte hain . (ii) Dono range control pin ke sath fire karne se 50 m range hasil hota hai. (ii) Ek range pin ko nikalne se 100m ka range hasil hota hai. (iv) Dono range pin ko nikal kar fire karne se 150m range hasil hota hai. Grenade ko Prime aur Unprime Karna (i) Grenade ka nirakshan aur safai ke bad arming ring ko grenade ke bichwala katav par milana chihiye. (ii) Arming ring charhate samay grenade ko niche se charakar bichwala katao par milana chahiye. (iii) Arming ring ka katao lever ke viprit hona chahiye. (iv) 07 sec wala ignitor set (fuse) ko centre sleeve mein dakhil Karen aur base plug fit Karen. (v) Grenade ko tube launching per chadhana. Unprime karan (i) Base plug ko khole aur fuse ko alag Karen aur box mein rakhe. (ii) Base plug ko 149 lagaen aur base plug key ki madad se fit katren. (iii) Grenade ko box mein band Karen. Rifle fire ke liye taiyar karna (i) Grenade sight ko 90 degree ke angle mein khara Karen. (ii) Change lever ki posn ‘R’ ya ‘B’ par karen aur rifle ko cock karen aur HOD lagayen. (iii) HD carts ko len aur chamber mein dakhil Karen. (iv) Yekin Karen ki chamber mein round achhi tarah se fit ho gaya hai aur chalwale purzon ko age jane den. (v) Change lever ki posn ‘S’ pe rkarne. Grenade ko bharna (i) Taiyar kiya hua grenade ko nirakshan karte hue grenade ko chahiyen. Check Karen ki grenade thik tarah se fit ho gaya hai. (ii) Range milne par range contrl pin ko nikalen aur tube launching ko achchhi tarah se fit Karen. (iii) Firing posn akhityar Karen aur safety pin ko nikalen. Firing Posn (i) Kneeling posn :Baen paon ko tgt ki sidth lagayen aur fiel ke butt ke age wala 150 bhag zamin par laga hua ho aur pichhla bhag sand bag per laga huwa ho baen hath se front hand guard par pakaren. (ii) Sitting Posn :Dayen paon ko lamba aur baen paon ko adha close Karen. Baki kneeling posn ki tarah. Grenade ki Chal Trigger dabane se HD carts fire hota hai jisse gas paida hoti hai. Gas tube launching ki flash eleiminator se alag kar deta hai. Uran ke dauran chand second bad arming ring set back ked hake se gir jata hai aur lever azad ho jata hai striker spring ki takat se .22 cap par chot marta hai aur aag ki chingari paida hoti hai aur safety fuse ko aag lag jati hai. Jisse detonator fat jata hai sath hi detonator sleev phat jata hai aur HE barud ka upper aad lagta hai aur chur chur hoker fat jata hai. Bina fire khali karan (i) Change lever ko ‘S’ per Karen. (ii) Tube launching ko baen ahth se pakarte hue safety pin ko lagyen. (iii) Tube launching ko flash eliminator se alag Karen. (iv) Range pin ko 151 lagayen. (v) Rifle ko khali kar ki karwai kareyn aur HD carts ko rakhen. (vi) Grenade ko surakshit jagah per rakhen. Fire aur misfire (i) Sabse pahle sikhe tariqe se fire ke lie taiyar Karen. Tube launching aur grenade ko taiyar karne ke baad firing posn akhityar Karen aur ley ki karwai Karen. (ii) Tgt, grenade ka shoulder aur fire ka sir ek sidh mein ko aur change lever ko safe par. (iii) Fire ke hukam par change lever ko ‘R’ par karen aur trigger ko dabaen, Grenade fir ho jayega. (iv) Misfire hone par change lever ko ‘S’ par karen dayen ahth se safety pin ko lagayen. Tube launching ko rifle se alag karen. (v) Dusra HD carts ko lagyen aur dobara fire ke lie taiyar ho hayen. 7. 8. S ABHYA SANKS HEP Sabhi student ko chal, fire aur misfire ki karwai par abhays karwaya jai. Q. 1. Tube launching MK-I ka wazan kitna hai? 3 2 1 0 8 0 3 4 Her ek bhag per ek ya do sawal puchayen. 152 Ans. 127 Gm. Q. 2. Deno range control pin nikalne poar kitna range hasil hota hai ? Ans. 150 Mtr. Q. 3. Rifle grenade ko kaun kaun si posn se fire kiya jata hai ? Ans. Kneeling posn aur sitting posn se fire karte hain.. ********************************************************************************* ********************************************************************************* ****************************************************************************** (4) 7.62 mm LIGHT MACHINE GUN(LMG) LMG 1-15 7.62MM LIGHT MACHINE GUN SE WAQFIAT, KHOLNA, SAFAI AUR JORNA 153 BUNYADI BATEN LMG ek asan hathiyar hai, is liye is ki sikhlai bhi asan honi chahie, jis hisse purje ki handling ho rakhi ho uska nam sath sath batane chahie. Lakin is bat ko hi samay jaya nahin karna chahie ki jawan hisse purjon ka nam jawani yad karlen. Kyonki is sikhlai ke dauran nam apnea p yad ho jata hai. Bar bar LMG ko nahi kholna chahie kyonki is ke purjon ko nuksan pahuchega. Agar DP LMG mil sake to us se sikhlai dena behtar hoga. LMG KI VISHESHTAIN Lmg ek gas se chalne wala, hawa se thanda hone wala, magazine se feed hone wala aur kandhe se kabu pakar fire jane wala hathiyar hai. Is mein roken bahut kam parti hain. Agar parti bhi hainto jaida gande ammuniation, kharab magazine ki wajah se. LMG KI KUCH TECHNICAL BATEN IS PRAKAR SE HAIN. (a) Qutar 7.62MM 154 (b) Muzzle velocity 2700 feet par sa. (c) Wazan 9.2 kg (d) Barrel ke sath 1130mm (e) Barrel ki 621mm lambai (f) Cycle rate of 450-500 Rds per mint fire (g) Khali magazine 395.89 grams ka wazan (h) Bhari magazine 1.106 kg ka wazan SHURU SHURU KA KAM SURAKSHA SAMBANDHI UPAY : (a) Q. Kisi bhi hathiyar ko istemal karne se pahle kya karna chahie ? (b) Ans. Nirikshan. (c) Isliye zarurai hai, ki LMG ko istemal karne se pahle is ka nirakshan kar liya jaye. Isi kam ka namuna dunga ap dekhen. Mere lie hukam “LMG ke piche line ban”, “Kneeling position”. Nirikshan is karwai is prakar karo : (1) Yakin karo kiLMG ke upar koi magazine nahi hai. (2) Magazine opening cover ko kholo. (3) Dahine hath se, cocking handle ko piche khainchte hue LMG ko cock karo aur phir cocking handle ko age jane do. Baen hath se ejection opening cover kholo. (4) Yakin karo ki chamber mein koi round nahi hai aur body mein koi rukawat nahi hai. (5) Change lever ko ‘A’ ya ‘R’ par karo. Trigger dabao. Dahine hath se magazine opening cover ka aur baen hath se ejection opening cover ko band karo. (6) Pouches, drill cartridges aur magazine ka mulahiza karo. Yakin karo ki ZINDA ROUND NAHI HAI. UDDESH LMG se waqfiat, kholna,jorna aur safai karna sikhana hai. SAMAN LMG, magazine, holdall, spare part wallet pura, utility pouches, drill cartiridges aur safai ka saman. PAHUNCH 7.62mm LMG ek gas se chalne wala hathiyar hai, jis se kafi tadad mein brust aur single round fire kiya ja sakta hai. Yeh banabat mein kafi sada aur mazbut hathiyar hai. Yeh sikhlai pana aur handle karne mein bahut asan hai. Is se bipod se 500 gaz tak tripod par mount karke 1000 gaz tak 155 kafi kargar fire dal sakte hai. In mein feeding ki karwai, ek magazine daura ki jati hai, jis mein 28 round bhare jate hai. KHOLNA AUR JORNA LMG ko jab tak khola na jaye us waqt tak is ki safai nahi ki ja sakti. LMG ko kholne ke liye am taur par yeh tartib hai jaise hisse khole jayen unhe saf jagah par rakha jaye. Is bat ka yakin kiya jaye, ki koi purja gum na ho ya koi nuksan na pahunche, shuru shuru ke darje mein mashware ke taur par purjon ko usi tartib se rakha jaye, jis tartib se khola gaya ho taki jorte waqt sahi tartib se jora ja sake. PISTON GROUP (a) Kholna (1) Yakin karo ki chall wale purje age hain(opening cover kholo). (2) Body locking pin ko baen se dahine ko dhakelo aur dahine taraf itna kincho jahan tak ja sakti ho. (3) Butt ko itna piche kincho, ki return spring rod, body se bahir nikal se. (4) Return spring rod, ko baen taraf rakhte hue cocking handle ko jatke se piche khincho aur age jane do. (5) Agar is tarah piston piche nahi ata hai ,to ejection slot mein se ungli dal kar piche nilako. (6) Ab piston aur bridge block ko bahir nikalo. (7) Bridge block ko thoda piche khincho aur piston ko alag kar do, purjon ken am batao. JORNA (1) Yakin karo, ki bridge block aur piston ke registered number apas mein milte hai. (2) Bridge block ko piston par rakho. (3) Yakin karo, ki body locking pin pura bahir hai. (4) Yakin karo, ki piston group pura body ke ander aa gaya hai. Ab ko age dakelo aur body locking pin laga do. (5) LMG ko cock karo. Change lever ko’A’ ya ‘R’ par karo, trigger ko dabado yakin karo ki piston group thik jud gaya hai. (6) Trigger ko dabae dabae kabhi bhi change lever ko ‘S’ se ‘A’ par na kiya jaye, aisa karne se LMG fire nahi karegi, yani aisa kabhi ho jaye to karwai is prakar karo : Trigger par se dabao ko hatao change lever ko ‘A’ se ‘S’ karo aur phir ‘A’ par le jao, phir trigger ko dabao LMG thik fire karegi. Abhiyas Squad se abhiyas lo aur aur akhir mrin piston group ko khula choor do. BARREL GROUP Kholna 156 (1) LMG ko dahine taraf karo aur carring aur carring handle ke upar uthao. (2) Barrel nut catch ko dabaoaur jitna upar ho sake utna upar uthao. (3) Carring handle ki madad se barrel ko body se bahar nikalo. Dhyan rahe ki yeh karwai karte waqt, barrel ke pichle bhag ko koi nuksan na pahunche. (4) Gas regulator ki char position hoti hain aur hare k ke baen taraf ek nishan hai. Sab se chota nishan sab se chote surakh se sath hai jis ko no.1 aur sab se bare ko no.4 kahte hai. Gas block ke upar bhi ek zero mark hai. Gas regulator ko us sab se chote mark par set karna chahie yahan LMG tassali baksh fire kare aur jo ki amuman no.2 hai. (5) Gas regulator retaning pin ko housing ki sidh mein rakhte hue, regulator ko kisi round kin ok se ya kisi combination tool se bahir ki taraf dakelo aur nikal lo. Yakin karo ki nikalte waqt yeh niche nag ire. JORNA (1) Gas regulator ko kholne ke ulat apni jagah par rakho. (2) Gas regulator ko no.2 par set karo. (3) Yakin karo magazine opning cover pura band hai aur barrel nut catch pura upar utha hua hai. (4) Barrel ko body ke andher bina zor lagaye hue dakhil karo. (5) Bare nut catch ko laga do aur yakin karo ki yeh thik tarah se lock ho gaya hai. (6) Carring handle ko niche bitha do. Abhiyas Barrel ke kholne aur jorne ka. BUTT GROUP (a) Kholna : Body ko pakro aur butt ko piche kinch lo. (b) Jorna : Body ko pakro aur dahine hath se piston group ko pakarte hue guide ribs ka agla sire ko body ke recce mein rakhte hue age dakhil karo. Body aur bipod group (a) Kholna : Bipod ko pakro aur body ko thora baen taraf turn karte hue ise bipod sleeves se bahir nikal lo. (b) Jorna : Jorne ke liye kholne ki ult karwai karo. Abhiyas : Squad se body, bipod aur butt ko kholne jorne ka abhiyas lo. MAGAZINE (a) Kholna : LMG ke magazine ko kholne aur jorne ka tariqa 7.62MM SLR ki tarah hi hai. Butt group 157 (a) Return spring rod, combination tool ki madad se, butt ke bich mein laga bada screw ko bahir nikalo. Spring par quabu rakhte hue cap return spring aur spring rod ko bahir nikalo. Is ko jorne ke liye kholne ki ulti karwai kao. (b) Abhiyas : Isi kam ka. Body group (a) Magazine catch aur ejector assembly (1) Magazine catch aur ejector ko kholne ke liye, retaning pin ko baen se dahine ko dabao aur phir jitna ho sake pin ko dahine ki taraf nikalo. Phir magazine catch ejector ko age dabate hue upar nikal do. (2) Jorne ke liye kholne ki ulti karwai karo. (b) Magazine opening cover (1) Kholne ke liye magazine opening cover ko pura piche khincho aur bahir nikalo. (2) Jorne ke lie, magazine opening cover ko is ki recess mein dakhil karo aur yakin karo ki is ka bara bhag age hai. (c) Barrel nut catch : Barrel nut retainer plunger ko pura niche dabao aur barrel nut catch upar uthate hue bahir nikal lo, is ko jorne ke lie, plunger ko pura niche dabaoaur barrel nut ki is ki socket mein rakh do aur phir plunger ke upar se dabao ko chor do. Yakin karo ki thik lag gaya hai. (d) Abhiyas : Isi kam ka. (Akhir mein LMG khuli choro). Holdall and wallet : Hare k LMG ke sath holdall hota hai aur is mein yeh saman hota hai : (a) Ander : Spare barrel aur cylinder cleaning rod. (b) Bahar (1) Upar aur baen : Spare breech block, agar issue kiya gaya ho. (2) Bahar aur bich mein : Mop, wire brush, double pullthrough aur tool removing kiye. (3) Upar aur dahine : Oil bottle ya graphite grease tube. (4) Bich mein pura spare part wallet. (5) Niche tel ke liye oil can, low cold test oil ka can. (c) Wallet ke ander yah saman hota hai : (1) Upar aur combination tool. (2) Bich mein ‘A’ oil ka bhara hua can. (3) Upar aur dahine single phultrough aur chindi. (4) Niche spare part box, jis mein clearing plug, extractor, extractor stay aur spring pin aur spring aur wire guaze hoti hai. 158 (d) Yadi section ke pas holdal nahi hai toh graphite tube section ke spare part wallet ke spare part tenmein rakhi ja sakti hai. Iike ilawa sardi wale ilaqe mein oil can ke badle low cold oil ki can rakhi jaye. Abhiyas : Squad se LMG ko kholne jorne aur am safai ka abhiyas karao. SANKSHEP Squad se sawal-o-jawab karo batao ki service LMG ko kewal safai ke liye hi kholna chahie. -------------------------------------*****************-----------------------LMG 16-30 MAGAZINE KA BHARNA AUR SIGHT LAGANA SHURU SHURU KA KAM LMG aur saman ka nirikshan karo. Yakin karo ki koi zinda round nahi ho. UDDESH Magazine ko bharna, LMG ko bharna,khali karna, sight lagana aur make safe sikhana hai. SAMAN LMG Magazine, wallet, drill cartridges utility pouches. PAHUNCH LMG acchi handling ke liye zarurai hai, ki hare k jawan LMG ko bharna, sight lagana aur khali karna janta ho. MAGAZINE LMG ke magazine ko hath se bharna aur khali karne ki karwai 7.62mm SLR ki hi tarah hai. Lekin sirf anter itna hai, ki is mein 28 round bhare jate hain. Yad rakho ki bharte waqt roundon ki ginti rakhi jaye. 159 Khali karna : Batao ki round saf jagah par girna chahie. Abhiyas : Magazine bharne aur khali karne ka. BHARNA AUR KHALI KARNA Bharne ki position : Is position ko akthiyar karne ke liye Ya hukam mile “Position” to karwai is prakar karo : (a) LMG ki piche side ki taraf let jao, ki tange aur paon mile hue ho. (b) Baen hath se small of the butt ko pakro, ki angutha niche se aur unglian hon aur dahine hath ki pakar pistol grip par angutha ander se ungalian bahir hon, kalmen wali ungli trigger guard ke ar par ho. Nazar samne rakhen. Is position mein dekhne ki baten. Trigger LMG aur number 1 line mein hona chahie. BHARNA (a) Baen hath se change lever ko ‘S’ par karo aur dahine hath se magazine opening cover ko kholo. (b) Utility pouch mein se magazine ko nikalo aur mulhazia karo ki yeh thik bhara hua hai aur acchi halat mein hai. (c) Dahine hath se magazine is prakar se pakro, ki lips niche ki taraf aur bullet wala hissa age ki taraf ho. (d) Magazine ke agle hisse ko pahle magazine housing mein dakhil karte hue ise niche aur piche ki taraf kincho. (e) Yakin karo ki magazine thik tarah se laga gaya hai, dahine hath ko wapis pistol grip par lao. Bharne ki akhri harkat. (f) Khali karo : Khali karne ke liye karwai is prakar hai : (1) Dahine hath se hatheli ke gadde se magazine coach ko dabate hue, magazine ko nikalo. (2) Butt ko kandhe mein le jao aur LMG ko cock karo. (3) Change lever ko ‘A’ ya’R’ par rakho. Yakin karo ki barrel surakshit disha mein hai, trigger ko dabao, LMG ko phir cock karo aur trigger ko dabao. (4) Butt ko niche lao. Dahine hath se magazine opening cover aur baen hath ke ejection opening cover ko band karo. (5) Magazine ko utility pouch mein band karo. Yadi sight khara hai to use niche girao. (6) Dono hath ki madad se chatki se khade ho jao aur “LMG THIK” ki report do. Agar ek se zaida LMG hon to pahla aur akhri number bolega, baqi thik ki report denge. Yadi hukam mile “ Badli kari” to dusrs jaran no. 1 jagah lega yadi hukam mile “line tor” to dahine turn karo aur apni jagah mil jao. (7) Agar LMG ek se zaida aur hukam mile report do squad ke baen se dahine Ko number report do. Abhiyas : Bharne aur khali karne ka lo. 160 SIGHT LAGANA (a) Back sight leaf ke upar 2 se 20 tak ke nishan kate hue hote hai. Yeh nishan gazon ko zahir karte hai. Visham (Odds) numbers yani (3,5,7,11,13,15,17, aur 19) dahine taraf aue sam (Even) numbers yani (2,4,6,8,10,12,14,16,18, aur 20) yeh baen taraf, likhe hue hote hai. 50 gaz ke liye koi katao nahi hota, lakin yeh range andzk ke upar wale aur niche wale hisson ke bich se hasil kiya ja sakta hai. (b) Drum sight : Yadi Drum sight wali LMG ho. to uske bich 2 se 20 tak ke hinds likhe hote hai, lakin 50 gaz ke liye koi nishan nahi hota, lekin 50 gaz ki range drum ki click se hasil ki ja sakti hai kyonki ek click 50 gaz ko zahir karti hai. (c) Back sight leaf wali LMG par sight lagane ke liye, sight leaf ko uthao aur adjusting screw ko us waqt tak ghumao, jab tak ki slide ka upar wala kinara zarurat shuda range ke hinse ki line se na mil jaye. (d) Jab bhari hui LMG par range mile to karwai is prakar karo : Ustad lying position se sight lagane ka namuna de aur sqd ko wapis apni jagah par bhej den. Diya hukam range lagao. Butt ko kandhe mein le jao aur LMG ko cock karo aur agle hukam ka intezar karo. Abhiyas : Sight lagane ka abhiyas lo. SANKSHEP : Sawal-o-jawab se, yadi koi shak ho to use dur karo. ------------------------------*****************--------------------------LMG 31-43 SHIST , PAKAR AUR FIRE KARNA SHURU SHURU KA KAM 161 Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan karo,yakin karo ki koi round parade par nahi hai. DOHRAI Bharne aur khali karne ka abhiyas lo. UDDESH Fire karne ki sikhlai dena hai. SAMAN LMG magazine, utility pouch, wallet, drill cartiradges, eye dises aur shist ka diagram. PAHUNCH Am baten : LMG ki shist ka qaida SLR ki hi tarah hai, lekin iska backsight aperture bara hone se iski fore sight kin ok ko aperture ke center mein rakhne ke liye zaida dhyan dena parega. Dusre iski back sight baen hai islye es mein baen ankh ko hi band karna parega. “Shist ka qaida”. Baen ankh ko band karo, aperture ke bich se fore sight ko dekho. Fore sight kin ok, aperture ke bichon bich target ke centre mein milao. PAKAR LMG ki position : Hukam mile bhar position to, bharne ki position akhtiyar karo aur rnge milne par : (a) Sight lagao. (b) LMG ko handle mein le jao aur cock karo. Target milne par karwai is prakar hogi : (a) Jism aur LMG ko tab tak harkat do, jab tak ki jism, LMG aur target ek line mein na aa jaye. (b) Yaqin karo ki bipod target ki sidh mein hai. (c) Khonion ko harkat do ya bipod legs ko zarurat ke mutabik upar niche karo, taki target ke upar shist lene mein asani ho. Durust pakar hasil karne ke liye yeh karwai karo : (a) Kandhe (1) Butt se milane ke liye kandhe ko age karo. (2) Kabhi kabhi butt aur kandhe ka milap karne ke liye butt ko piche na kincha jaye. Aisa karne se bipod shoes ki position bigar jayegi. (b) Baen hath (1) Small of the butt ko baen hath se is tarah pakro ki charon unglion ki pakar upar se aur angutha niche se ho. (2) Khoni ko age rakho. (3) Butt ko piche aur niche ki taraf daba kar rakho. Dahina hath (1) majbuti (2) (3) Dahine hath ki akhri teen ungalion se pistol grip ko se pakro. Kalmen wali ungli ko trigger guard ke bahir rakho. LMG ko kicho aur kandhe mein jamao. 162 Sir : Sir ko is prakar butt par tikao, ki gal bayeb hath ke piche wale hiss eke uppar ya iske sata hua ho. Puri prakar : Majboot pakar hasil karne ke liye gal se baen hath ko butt ke sath dabate hue donon kalion ko andhar ki taraf modo. Abhiyas : Squad se abhiyas karao aur pakar ko check karo. FIRING SINGLE SHOT ‘FIRE” KA HUKAM PAR KARWAI IS PRAKAR HO. (a) Target par shist lo. (b) Change lever ko ‘R’ par karo aur trigger ke dhile pan par qabu pao. (c) Jab durust shist mil jati hai, to trigger ko dabao aur mar ko pukaro. (d) Baen ankh ko kholo aur dekho, yadi zaurat ho to shist ki badly kar. (e) Trigger par se pura dabao hatao aur 1minute mein 1 magazine ke hisab se fire karo. STOP KA HUKAM MILNE PAR, LMG ke butt ko niche lao, change lever ki ‘S’ par lao agar zarurat hai to magazine ko badly karo, aisa karne ke liye LMG ko cock karo. JARI KAR KE HUKAM PAR PAHLE KI TARAH FIRE JARI KARO. Yeh firer ki zimmewari hai, ki who har waqt, LMG par bhara hua ya karib karib bhara hua magazine charhae aur shist lete waqt hawa ka haq rakhe. Abhiyas : Squad se abhiyas lo. BRUST FIRE KARNA (a) Agar change lever ko ‘A’ par rakha hai, trigger ko itna dabaya jaye ki 2 ya is se zaida round fire ho jayen, to ham ise ck brust kahte hai. (b) Kitna lambha durust fire kiya jaye yeh target, uski range aur firer ki qabliyat par munhasir hai. (c) 2 ya 3 round ka ek accha brust hota hai, jinki target ke upar ek chota group banta hai. (d) 4 ya 5 roundon ka brust zaida phailta hai, lakin golion kimar asani se dekhi ja sakti hai. (e) 6 ya 8 round ka brust, harkati targaton ko mar girane ke liye, accha mauqa deta hai. Abhiyas : Squad se abhiyas lo. Sankshep Sawal-o-jawab se aur galatian batao. Note ki baten Ek jawan ki durust prakar se janch, live ammuniation se brust fire karwai kar li ja sakti hai, lekin is ke ilawa yeh bhi yakin karna chahie, ki jawan yeh baten janta ho : (a) LMG ko kaise pakarna aur kaise durust fire karna hai. 163 (b) Fire karne se pahle, uski pakar majboot hai aur jab tak fire kar raha ho, thar thrahat se uski pakar dili na ho jaye. (c) Dono hathon se LMG ko piche kainch kar rakhe, dono hathon ka dabao barabar rakhe aur LMG ko kisi bhi hath se dahine baen na khainche. Jawan ki majboot pakar ka yakin karne ke liye, LMG ko age se khaincho uski shist. Pakar, trigger operation aur who apni muzzle ko kaise upar niche karta hai, yakin, is ki janch ke liye eye disc ka istemal karo lekin yeh yakin karo ki LMG par koi magazine nahin hai. Drill cartiradges se abhiyas mein vastvikta lane ke liye, firer ke dahine ek jawan ko kneeling position mein karo, junhi firer trigger dabata hai jawan LMG ko cock karne ki karwai karega. Is tarah firer durust trigger dabega aur uski shist hare k bar vastav mein kharab hogi. ---------------------------***********************-----------------------------LMG 44-59 CHAL AUR ROKEN SHURU SHURU KE KAM (a) Hthiyar aur saman kanirikshan karo. (b) Sabaq no. 2 aur 3 dohrai lo. UDDESH Mote taur par LMG ki chal, hone wali roken aur umko door karna sikhana hai. SAMAN LMG magazine, utility pouches, holdal, wallet, chal ka diagram, drill cartiradges, kata hua case, khali case aur targets. PAHUNCH Agar LMG ki achhi tarah se dekh bhal ki jaye to roken bahut kam parengi lekin agar rok par jati hai to firer ko yeh malum hona chahie ki use kaise turant door kiya jata hai. LMG KI CHAL Firer kiye hue round se paida hui gas piston grip ko piche dakelti hon, jo khali khokhe ko piche lata hai. Return spring piston group ko age dhakelta hai jis se ek round load aur fire ho jata hai. Yeh karwai us waqt tak jari rahti hai jab tak trigger daba rahe aur magazine mein round rahen. FAURI ILAJ Agar LMg fire na kare yak arte karte ruk jaye to fauri ilaj ki karwai is prakar karo : (a) LMG ko cock karo. (b) Magazine ki badly karo. (c) Durust shist lo aur fire karo. FAURI ILAJ SE YEH ROKEN DOOR KI JA SAKTI HAI. (a) Khali magazine. 164 (b) Unfit magazine. (c) Misfire. (d) Sakhat khainchao, joki gande case ya maile chamber hone ki wajah se ho jati hai. Is mein LMG ko cock karne kie tarqe mein sirf yeh hai ki LMG pulthrough wallet ki strap se ya kisi aur tarqe se cock kiya jaya hai. Abhiyas Fauri ilaj ke karwai ka abhiyas lo. Hukam is prakar hoga “LMG” thik fire karta rukta”. Jab karwai puri ho jati hai to hukam do “LMG thik fire karta, khali kar”. DUSRI ROKEN GAS KI ROK : Agar fauri ilaj karne ke bad LMG ek ya do round fire kare aur phir ruk jaye, to yeh gas ki kami ki wajah se ho sakta hai. Is ko door karne ke liye karwai is prakar karo : (a) LMG ko cock karo, magazine ko utaro aur trigger dabao. (b) LMG ko dobara cock karo, butt kozamin par niche lao, LMG ko baen, pahlu ke ba leto. (c) Barrel nut ko kholo aur nut kalmen waliaur badi ungli ke bich rakhte hue, carring handle ko dono unglion se grip ko qaym rakhte hue, angutha se barrel ko itna age dakhelo ki gas regulator, cylinder locking bar se alag ho jaye. (d) Gas regulator ko kisi round kin ok se ya combination tool ki madad se pahle se bare marg par set karo. 165 (e) Pahla mouqa milte hi, tool ya round ko wapis apni jagah par rakho. (f) Ar se fire waqt yeh ar par nirbhar karega, ki gas regulator ko adjust karne ke lie, LMG ke baen aya jaye ya LMG ko hi piche kincha jaye. BODY CHAMBER KI ROK Agar fauri ilaj karne ke bad bhi, LMG fire na kare to fire is prakar karo : (a) LMG ko cock karo, magazine ko utaro LMG ko niche lao aur jism ko thoda age karte hue body ke ander dekho. (b) Agar koi khali case ya round body ya chamber mein phas gaya ho to use door karo. Magazine ko charao, shist lo karo aur fire karo. (c) Agar body mein koi rukawat na ho to chamber ki rukawat door karne ke liye clearing plug ko nikalo, base ko kas kar is mein chamber mein dakhil karo, trigger dabao aur LMG ko cock karo. Yakin karo, ki clearing plug kate hue case ke sath bahar nikal gaya hai, magazine ko charao, shist lo aur fire karo. (d) Pahla mauqa milte hi kate hue case ko plug se alag karo aur ise wapis wallet mein rakh do. ABHIYAS Isi kam ka abhiyas lo. Abhiyas ke dauran clearing plug ki jagah drill cartridges ka istemal karo. Is karwai karne ke liye karwai is prakar hain. Hukam Karwai (a) “LMG thik fire karte rukta”. Fauri ilaj 166 (b) “Fire nahin” Body ke ander dekho. (c) “Body chamber Munasib karwai karo. ki roke” (d) “LMG thik fire Khali kar karta, khali kar” Hisse purjon ki tut-phut : Kamazor ya tute phute purzo ke karan bahut kam roken parti hai. Lakin fauri ilaj aur rokon ko door karne ki karwai karne ke bad bhi, LMG fire hi na kare to, LMG ko clear karo aur nuqs ko door karne ke liye in baton ko dekho. Chinh Mumkin karan Cartridge par chot nahin Tuta hua firing pin Cartridges par puri chot nahin. Bar bar extract aur eject ki karwai na hona Kamzor return spring. Tuta hua extract ya ejector. SANKSHEP Sawal-o-jawab se sankshep karo. NOTE Rokon ko door karne ka abhiyas karte waqt LMG ka fire zahir karne ke liye magazine par pencil se tik ki awaz paida karo, ya koi aur aisa istemal karo ki jawan bina hukam ke karwai karna sikhe. Is ko hasil karne ke liye dusra tariqa yeh ho sakta hai ki jawano ko jorion mein abhiyas karaya jaye, jis mein helper LMG ko cock na kare jo ki rok ko jahir karega. ---------------------------***************------------------------------------ LMG 60-72 TRIPOD AAM BAYAN Yadi ap tripod, equipment ke andar, ab authorize nahin hai 167 lekin yeh sector store se issue kiye ja sakta hai, Is lie iske bhag mein iska ek sabaq rakha gaya hai, taki zarurat parne par iska asani se istemal kiya ja sake. Tripod LMG ko majboot aur sthir sahara deta hai jis se LMG fized line par ya di hui had ke ander, adhure mein, kam roshni mein bachao ke fire de sakti hai. LMG group tripod se fire karte samay bahut nazdik tak fire de sakte hain aur spare barrel ke sath kafi der tak aur zaida tadad mein fire dal sakta hai. Acchi roshini mein tripod ka istemal mein karna chahie. Kyonki bipod kafi lachadar fire de sakte hai. Yeh bahut zarurai hai ki tripod ka istemal karte samay ar ka pur faida uthaya jaye, is liye behtar hoga ki iss ark e piche mount kiya jaye kewal barrel hi uppar honi chahie. UDDESH LMG aur tripod ko mount aur dismount karne ke tariqa sikahana hai. SAMAN LMG sling ke sath, magazine, drill cartridges, utility pouch, tripod, doldall aur spare parts wallet. NOTE Is sabaq ko behtar tariqe se us jagah chalaya ja sakta hai, jahan par munasib ar mil sake jiske piche LMG aur tripod mount kiya ja sake. Jab LMG aur tripod ko mount kiya jar aha ho to squad ko dushman ki haisiyat se position dekhne ke liye wahan le jana chahie jahan par camonflage aur concealment rakhte hue position ko dekh saken. Bad mein squad se do jawano ko LMG aur tripod ko kisi khas ilaqe mein ark e piche mount karne ke liye detail laro, baqi jawan age se munasib duri par dekh sakte hai, aur unki karwai aur kitna samaye leta hai, is par naqtachini kar sakte hai. Ustad sath sath hisse purzon ken am batayega lekin is bat ki koshish nahin karega ki squad unko yad kare kyunki is se samay barbad hoga. Am suraksha sambandhi baton par dhyan do. LMG ke upar ek magazine lagi hui hogi. PAHUNCH Tripod ke upar LMG ko mount karke fixed line par andhere mein di hui haddon ke ander dhuen ya kohre mein fire dala ja sakta hai aur sath hi durusti ke sath lambhe region par target engage kiye ja sakte hain. GUNNER KI DUTIAN No.2 Kam karne ke liye squad se ek jawan lekar no.1, gunner ke kam ka bayan ke sath namuna do. LMG ko tripod ke upar mount karne ke liye front aur rear mounting pin ko nikalo . Dono mounting housing ko mounting ke upar rakho aur pin laga do. LMG ar se thora sa upar ho aur sear legon ko itna harkat dete hain ki taqriban LMG target ki sidh mein aa jaye. Iske bad agar zarurat hai to aur bhi thora tabdili karte hai aur is bat ka yakin karte hai ki : (a) Sabhi clamps kase hue hai aur tervising are samtal hai. (b) Legon ko thokar marker zamin mein mazbut kar do aur agar sambhav ho to legon par sand bag ya koi wazan rakha jaye. AIMING 168 Range milne par, sight lagao, LMG ko cock karo. Target dikhai dene par ankh ko durust aiming position mein rakhte hue target par shist lo. Traverse clamp handle ko dhila karke aur terversing slide ko ghumao kar disha hasil ki ja sakti hai. Ghumane ke bad clamping handle kas deye jate hai. Elevation hasil karne ke liye evelting nut clamp ko dhila kar do aur evelting nut ko ghumao. Agar zaida tabdili karne ki zarurat hai to elevating sleeve ko doubara tartib deni ki zarurat paregi. FIRING Jab LMG tripod se fire kar rahi ho to am taur par 4-5 roundon ka brust fire kiya jata hai, lakin kabhi kabhi is se bare brust bhi fire kie ja sakte hain. Fire karte samay yeh zaruri nahin hai butt kandhe mein ho, kewal shist check karte samay butt kandhe mein lagaya ja sakta hai. LMG AUR TRIPOD KE DISMOUNT KARNA LMG aur tripod k oar ke piche lao agar LMG bhari hui ho to khali karo. Phir mount karne ki tartib ke ulat karwai karke LMG aur tripod ko dismount karo. Dismount karne ke bad sabhi mounting pins apni jagah par laga deni chahie aur sabhi clamps ko doubara kas dena chahie. Akhir mein LMG ke upar magazine charhi hui chahie. ABHIYAS 169 Squad se mount aur dismount ka abhiyas karao. SANKSHEP Squad se sawal-o-jawab se. Kamzor baton par akhri abhiyas karo. Khud sankshep karo. ---------------------****************-------------------------------------LMG 73-87 FIXED LINE PARICHAY: Kabhi kabhi khas ilaqe mein jahan target dikhai nahi deta, LMG ko fixed line par laga kar fire karne ki zarurat parti hai, missal ke taur par rat key a kohre ya dhuen ke halat mein jab dikhai na de. Aisa am taur par defence mein kiya jata hai lakin khuck aur mauqe bhi ho sakte hai jab LMG ko fixed line par lagana parega. DEFENCE Defence ki halat mein LMG ka primary task apne parosi defended post ki raksha karna hota hai, jis se ek dusre ko mutual support de sakte hai. Is se is baat ka yakin ho jata haiki dushman ke kam se ka do LMG ke fire ke niche hokar guzarna parega. Fixed line defended post aur locality ke jitni nazdeek hogi fire utna hi kargar hoga. Phir bhi kam se kam safety angle rakhna zaruri hai. LMG KO FIXED LINE PAR LAGANA LMG ko tripod par mount karo yaqin karo ki tripod ki legs surakshit hain. Jis parosi locality ki raksha karni hai us ke agle kinare par LMG ko lay karo. Terversing arc par dekho aur LMG ko dushman ki taraf 5 degree harkat do. Yeh kam se kam safety angle hai jis se yeh nischit hota hai ki apni fauj surakshit hai, Is bat ka yakin karo ki line of sight ke bich koi rukawat to nahin bai jo ka rgar fire par aur dalegi. Is ke liye sabse acha ilaqa who hai jo am taur par chapta ho aur bich mein koi dabi hui jagah na ho. Jab tripod na mil sake to LMG ko improvise tariqe se fixed line par lagaya ja sakta hai. RANGE Aise targaton par jinki range 600 gaz se zaida hai fixed line nahina lagan chahie. 600 gaz tak LMG ki golian jawan ki unchain se upar nahin jati. Is bat se yeh yakin ho jata hai ki LMG se lekar target tak fire kargar hoga. FIRE KHOLNA Fire kholne ke liye signal muqarrar kar lena chahie aur sab ko malum hona chahie. LMG ka fire muqurrar kiye is signal par kholna chahie. Signal milne par sentry ko turant fire kholna chahie, aur dusre sentry baki section ke jawan ko jagayega aur alert karega. Ammuniation chahie, ti tadad aur fire ki raftar pahle se hi muqrrar ki hui honi chahie aur sab ko malum hona chahie. Isi baat ko dhyan mein rakhna chahie ki LMG ko fixed line par lagane ka mukhya maqsad defensive fire dena chahie aur chunkih iska milap battalion ke darje par hota hai is liye fire tabhi kargar hoga jab turant fire khola jaye. DI HUI HADDON MEIN FIRE KARNA 170 Tripod ka terversing aur 38 degree ki aur khabar karta hai. Tripad ke upar LMG ko mount kar ke fire karne ka tariqa fixed line ki tarah hai, jis ar ki andher fire dalne ki zarurat hai aur terversing arc par terversing stop ko kas kar hasil ki jati hai. jahan par aqni fauj ki suraksha shamil hai, 5 degree ka safety angle rakhna bahut zaruri hain. ************************************************************************* ************************************************************************* ********************************************************************** (5).9mm CARBINE MACHINE (CM) CM 1-7 9MM CARBINE-VISESHTAIEN, KHOLNA, JORNA AUR SAFAI 171 SHURU SHURU KA KAM Suraksha sambandhi upay ki karwai ka bayan ke sath namuna do. Nirikshan ke liye janch sashtr ke hukam par karwai is prakar karo. (a) Bharne ki position akthiyar karo. (b) Agar magazine laga hua ho toh use utar kar pouch mein rakho. 172 (c) Change lever ko ‘R’ ya ‘A’ par rakhte hue cock karo aur change lever ko dobara ‘S’ par karo. (d) Jab kabhi hathiyar ka khud mulahiza karna ho to carbine ko baen taraf turn karke ejection slot se dekhen aur yakin kare ki carbine khali hai. (e) Ustad hathiyaron ka nirakshan kare. (f) Tamam drill cartridges aur magazines ka nirikshan ka tariqa bataen aur nirikshan Karen. UDDESH Carbine machine 9MM IA ki visheshtaen, kholna, jorna aur safai sikhana hai. SAMAN Carbine machine 9MM, magazine, pullthrough, chindi, tel, kapra, sling aur bayonet. PAHUNCH Carbine machine 9MM ek CQB ka hathiyar hai jo ki blow back action se kam karta hai. Is hathiyar se single shot aur brust fire kar sakte hai. Is se pura faida uthane ke liye samay samay par durust safai ki jaye. VISHESHTAEN (a) Carbine ka qutar 9MM hai. (b) Iske butt ko fold karke ya khol kar fire kiya ja sakta hai. (c) Iski lambhai butt ko fold karne ke bad 19”(48cm) aur butt ko kholne ke bad 27” hai(68.6). (d) Bhare magazine aur bayonet ke sath iska wazan taqriban 3.75 kg hai. (e) Iske magazine mein 34 round ate hai lakin 32 rounds hi bhare jate hai. (f) Iske upar ek blade ki shakal ka fore-sight aur ek aperture back sight hota hai, jiske do position hai 100 gaz aur 200 gaz ke liye. (g) Iska kargar range 30 gaz hai. KHOLNA AUR JORNA Baen se namuna sath napal. Kholne ke liye karwai is prakar kare. (a) Magazine lagi ho to utaro, carbine ka nirikshan karo aur change lever ‘S’ par karo. (b) Bayonet aur selling utaro. (c) Bridge block ko nikalne ke liye karwai is prakar karo : (1) Carbine ko baen gutne par tikao, baen hath ke anguthe se body cap ko dabate hue catch ko ander ki taraf dabao. Butt ko body cap ki jhiri se alag karte hue niche bitha do. Dahine hath ke anguthe se butt plate catch ko dabate hue barrel casing ke upar betha do. 173 (2) Carbine ki muzzle ko baen boot ki toe par tika kar baen hath ke anguthe se body cap catch ko dabao aur dahine hath se body cap ko niche dabate hue gahrai ke ulte rukh gumao aur bahar nikalo. (3) Change lever ko ‘R’ ya ‘A’ par lagao. Carbine ko baen hath se aise pakro ki muzzle ka rukh thoda niche ho. Dahine hath se cocking handle ko pakrte hue piche kincho aur bahar nikalo. (4) Return spring aur bridge block ko bahar nikalo (bade aur chote spring ko alag na kiya jaye). MAGAZINE KO KHOLNA Magazine ka pura bhag apni taraf kaste hue magazine ko boot ki toe ya saf zamin par tikao. Magazine ke battom plate ko stud ko kisi nokili chiz se dabao aur spring par qabu rakhte hue plate ko bahar nikalo. Plate form aur spring ko wahi bahar nikalo is se zaida purjon ko nahi khola jaye. NOTE : Magazine plate form aur spring ko tab khola jayega jab magazine ke ander kafi garda ho ya gilla ho (aise purje ke nam aur kam batayen). JORNA (MAGAZINE) (Baen se namuna sath naqal). Magazine ka chota mehrab apni taraf karte hue spring ko is tarah ander dalo ki uske upar utha hua roller baen ki taraf ho. Baen hath se spring ko dabao aur dahine hath se bottom plate ke charo bhag ko age rakhte hue dabao, yaha tak ki stud apni suraksha mein baith jaye. Bridge block (a) Bridge block : Bridge block aur return spring ko body mein dakhil katne se pahle yaqin karo ki cocking handle ke liye bana hua surakh body mein banaye hue surakh ki sidhai mein hai. Dahine hath se bridge block aur spring ko body mein dakhil karo is par qabu rakhte hue dahine hath se cocking handle muda hua bhag age ki taraf karte hue surakh mein dakhil karo. (b) Triger wale purzo par qabu rakhte hue age jane do. Change lever ko ‘S’ par lagao. (c) Body cap ko return spring ki side par is tarah lagao ki baen wala lug body cap catch ki sidhai mein ho. Body cap catch ko dabao aur cap ko niche dabate hue ghari ki sidhe rukh gumao aur zakin karo ki baith gaya hai. JORNE KE BAD CARBINE TEST KARNA (a) Change lever ko ‘A’ par lagao aur cock karo, trigger ko dabao. Cocking handle ko pakarte hue chal wale purje age piche karo. Is samay bina suke age piche harkat honi chahie. 174 (b) Change lever ko ‘R’ par karkar upar likhe hue ke mutabik karwai kao, chal wale purje piche hi rukne chahie, trigger se dabao hatao aur dobara trigger dabao, chal wale purje age jane chahie. (c) Carbine ko cock karo chane lever ko’S’ par karo aur trigger dabao, chal wale purje piche hi rukne chahie. (d) Chal wale purjo ko age karke change lever ko ‘S’ apr karo, Is samay na hi cock hona chahie aur na hi trigger dabana chahie. ABHIYAS Squad ko abhiyas karwao, ant mein carbine ko khol kar rakho. Firing se sahle ki safai (Bayan karo) (a) Rozana ki safai ki tarah saaf karo kushak karo. (b) Bridge block ke age wale hisse ko saaf karo. (c) Barrel ko kushak karo. (d) Magazine ko chi kushak karo. FIRING KE BADKI SAFAI (BAYAN KARO) (a) Carbine ko kholo. (b) Barrel ko acchi tarah saaf karo aur mulahiza karo, agar zarurat hoto ubalte pani ka istemal karo. Yad rahe ki agar fire ke bad safai na ki jaye aur barrel mein gas ho to buldge ho sakti hai. (c) Barrel mein tel lagao. (d) Baki tamam hisson ko saf karo aur tel lagao. (e) Carbine ko firing ke bad lagatar teen din tak saf kiya jaye. ABHIYAS Pure sabaq ka abhiyas karo. Sankshep (a) Squad se prashan karo aur squad ke prashan ke uttar do. (b) Thore shabdo mein pure sabaq ko bayan karo. ----------------------------***************************________________________ CM 8-14 MAGAZINE KO BHARNA, CARBINE KO BHARNA, KHALI KARNA AUR FIRE KARNA 175 Shuru shuru ka kam Hathiyar aur saman ka mulahiza karo. Ground sheet ‘L’ ki shakal mein bichai hui ho. Dohrai Sabaq No. 1 par lo. Uddesh hai. Magazine bharna, carbine bharna, khali karna aur fire karna sikhana Saman Carbine, magazine, drill cartridges, sling aur CQB targets. Pahunch Larai mein carbine ko tezi se bharna jawan ki zindagi ke liye utna zaruri hai, jitna ki uske durusti se se goli fire karne mein hai. Is liye bharne aur fire karne ki karwai itni tezi aur drusti se honi chahie, ki ek bhi second barbad na ho. Magazine bharna aur khali karna (a) Yakin karo ki round thik aur saf halat mein ho. (b) Magazine ka mulhahiza karo aur baen hath mein is prakar pakro ki chota mehrab apni taraf ho. (c) Magazine ko gutne, boot ki toe ya saf zamin partikate hue, dahine hath se roundon ko ek karke magazine lips mein is tarah dakhil, ki round ka paida age ki taraf ho. (d) Baen hath ke anguthe se hare k round ko niche dabate hue age ki taraf itna khiskao, ki round ka painda magazine ki diwar ke sath lag jaye. (e) Bharte waqt roundon ki ginti karte jao. Agar koi round niche gir jaye to usko akhir mein saf karke bharo aur akhir mein chindi lagao. Chindi lagane ka faida yeh hai ki magazine mein miti ya garda dakhil na ho agar koi round gir jata hai toh malum ho jaye ki magazine ka round gir gaya hai. Magazine ko jaldi istemal karna ho to chindi lagane ki zarurat nahi hai. 176 Magazine ko khali karna : Magazine ko khali karne ke liye anguthe ya kaimen wali ungli se ek-ek round karke khali karo. Dhyan rahe ki round saf jagah par gir rahe ho. Abhiyas : Squad se abhiyas karao. Carbine bharna, le jane ki tariqe, ready position aur khali karo. (a) Bharna (1) Uthao carbine aur magazine ke hukam par dahine hath se carbine aur baen hath se magazine uthao. Magazine ko pouch mein band karo. Muzzle zamin ki taraf 45* ke angle par. (2) “Bhar position” ke hukam par bharne ki position akthiyar karo. Is position mein dakhne ki baten- bayan paon thoda age aur baen taraf rakhte hue tang mein kham do. (3) “Bhar” ke hukam par zakin karo ki change lever ‘S’ par hai. Baen hath se magazine ko pouch se nikalo. Agar chindi lagi hai to us ko nikalo aur upar wale round ko dekho aur magazine ko magazine housing mein is tarah dakhil karo, ki chota mahrab age ki taraf rahe aur puri tarah se fit karo. (b) Le jane ki tariqe : Carbine ko le jane ke teen tariqe hain : (1) Sling arm position: Sling ko dahine mein is tarah dalo, ki barrel upar ki taraf ho aur pith se laga hua ho. Dahina hath sling par ho. Is ke ilawa sling ko dahine kandhe mein is tarah dalo ki barrel ka rukh niche aur magazine bahar ki taraf ho. (2) Mala ya har position : Sling kogale mein is tarah dalo ki barrel baen taraf aur magazine baen bagal mein aa jaye. Is position se carbine ko asani se kafi dur tak le ja sakti hai. (3) Tol shashtra position : Yeh thik rifle ki tarah hai. Is surat mein magazine thik ran ke samne hota hai. Khali karna : Agar fire karne ki zaruratna ho, ya hukam mile “Khali kar” to karwai is tarah karo : (a) Kalmen wali ungli ko trigger se hatao. (b) Change levar ko ‘S’ par lagao. (c) Magazine catch dabate hue magazine utaro aur pouch mein band karo. (d) Change levar ko ‘A’ ya ‘R’ par karo. Yakin karo ki chamber mein round nahi hai. Purjo par qabu pate hue trigger dabao. Phir cock karo aur trigger dabao. (e) Carbine thik ki report do. Fire karna (a) Jab dushman thodi dur ho ya samaye ijazat de, to carabine ko tezi se kandhe mein le jao. Sighton ka istemal karte hue shist lekar fire karo. 177 (b) Jab dushman nazdik ho to carbine ko battle crouch position mein le jao, is position mein dakhne wali baten, age wali tang mein kham ho aur chote se chota position banao. Sidhai hasil karo aur fire karo. Stop aur make safe : Agar fire karte karte hukam mile “Stop” to trigger par se ungli hatao. Magazine badly karna ho to badly karo, nahin to agle hukam ka intezar karo. Jab thori der ki liye fire na karna ho ya hukam mile “Make safe” to karwai is prakar karo. (a) Kalmen wali ungli trigger se hatao. (b) Magazine ko utaro aur pouch mein bandh karo. (c) Carbine ko clear karo. (d) Carbine lever ko ‘S’ par lagao. (e) Carbine par bhara hua magazine pouch se nikal kar charao, koi shak, khali kar, line tod. Abhiyas Isi kam ka aur phir pure sabaq ka. Sankshep (a) Sawal-o-jawab se. (b) Acche jawano ka namuna dikhao. -------------------------********************---------------------------------------------178 CM 15-22 TURANT UPAY AUR ROKON KO DUR KARNA Shuru shuru ka kam Hathiyar aur squad ka mulahiza kar. Durusti Sabaq No. 2 par kholne jorne aur khali karne par, akhir mein magazine bhare hue . Uddesh Turant upaye aur rokon ko door ki sikhlai dena hai. Saman Carbine machine, 9mm magazine, drill cartridges sling aur CQB targets. Pahunch Agar carbine shuru se fire na kare ya fire karte karte ruk jaye, to doubara fire shuru karne ke liye turant upay kiya jaye. Is ke liye har jawan ko is kabil hona chahie ki who tezi aur drusti se rokon ko dur karke fire shuru kar sake. Sabak Ak ko Do bhagon mein sikhaya jayega. Turant upaye 179 Agar carbine shuru se hi fire na kare ya karte karte ruk jaye, to carbine rukne ka in mein se koi karan ho sakta hai : (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) Khali magazine. Unfit magazine. Body ki rok. Misfire. Chamber mein mota round. Agar carbine shuru se fire na kare ya fire karte ruk jaye, to karwai is prakar kao : Carbine ko bhar position mein lao, kalmen wali ungli ko trigger se hatao. Carbine ko cock karo. Baen taraf turn aur ejection slot se dekho aur yeh karwai is tarah se karo : (a) Khali magazine hi rok : Agar magazine aur chamber donon khali hon, to khali magazine utare aur dusra bhara hua magazine chara kar fire shuru karo. (b) Unfit magazine ki rok : Agar magazine bhara ho aur chamber khali ho, to magazine ko pura fit karo aur fire shuru karo. (c) Body ki rok : Agar magazine mein rok ho to carbine dahine turn karo, hilao, yakin karo ki khali cash ya round bahar nikal gaya hai aur fire shuru karo. (d) Chamber ki rok : Agar chamber mein mota round ho to carbine ko upar 45* ke angle par karte hue, dahine turn karo aur zor se hilao. Agar round na nikale to magazine ko utaro, age wale paon ko piche lao. Ejection slot aur magazine housing ki sidhai mein dekho, ki 10gaz ki doori tak koi jandar chiz to nahi hai. Phir carbine ko kandhe mein le jao. Dono hathon se pistol grip ko pakro. Sir ko piche karo aur target ki taraf fire karo. Dobara fire karna ho to bhar ki karwai karo aur fire jari karo. (e) Misfire : Agar round misfire ho jaye to cock karo aur fire jari rakho. Abhiyas : Rokon ko door karne ka jab. Jab jawan ejection slot se dekhta hai to hukam is prakar hoga. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) Khali magazine. Unfit magazine. Body mein rok. Chamber mein mota round. Misfire. Rat ke waqt turant upaye Rat ke wat agar carbine fire karte karte ruk jaye ya shuru se hi fire na kare to turant upaye kis tarah se kiya jata hai iska namuna dekho : Namuna : Agar carbine shuru se hi fire na kare ya fire karte karte jaye to karwai is tarah karo : (a) Kalmen wali ungli trigger se hatao. (b) Carbine ko cock karo. 180 (c) (d) (e) (f) Change lever ko ‘S’ par lagao. Kneeling position akthiyar karo. Ejection slot ko hath se tatol kar rok ko malum kao. Rok ko sikhe hue tariqe se door karo, fire jari karo. ----------------------------------********************------------------------------------- CM 23-34 CQB ROLE MEIN CARBINE (IWT) Bandobast Training ka ilaqa lagbag 2 00 gaz khula ho taki jawan harkat kar sake, ilaqe mein chupao wali jagah ho taki demo tps dushman ka kam kar saken. Dushman ke fire ko blank rds, ya bicat strep se jahir kiya jaye, har jawan ke pas carbine, magazine, bayonet aur sling hona chahie. Shuru shuru ka kam (a) Sqd ki ginti groupon mein bant. (b) Hathiyar ka mulahiza. (c) Comouflage our coneelment. Uddesh CQB Role mein carbine ki handling mein aur bhi abhiyas dena hai. Hidayaten Ustad class ko saqab ke anusar zaruri hidayaten batayen. Dushman ke tps our fire jahir karne ki karwai batao. 181 : Jor dene wali baten Sabaq ke dauran in in baton par jaida dhayan diya jaye (a) (b) (c) (d) Field craft aura r ka istemal. Target ko khojna. Gutham gutha ki larai karna. Hathiyar ki roken door karna. Larai ki halat Class ko apne aur dushman ke bare mein khabar batao. Dushman ki karwai aur apne task batao. Yad dilao Class ka dhyan sabaq ki or lane le liye FC aur hathiyar se sambandit 3 ya 4 sawal puchhen : (a) (b) (c) (d) CQB se ap kya samajte hai. Carbine ko CQB ka sab se accha hathiyar kyun mana jata hai. Field craft se ap kya samajte hai. Turant upaye se kin kin rokon ko door kiya ja sakta hai. Sankshep Class ko kharab batn ke bare mein samjhao, taki dobara galtiyan na Karen. ************************************************************************* ************************************************************************* ********************************************************************** 182 (6).AKM ( CODE-AKM) AKM 1-16 RIFLE AK-47 SE WAQFIAT, KHOLNA, JORNA KA TARIQA AUR SAFAI 183 Parichay Rifle AK-47 insergency ilaqe mein kafi behtar hathiyar hai, ek jawan ko is rifle ki dekhbal karne ke liye zarurai hai ki who rifle ko kholna aur jorna achi tariqe se janta ho. Taki rifle ki samay samay par dekh bal kar sake. Uddesh Rifle AK-47 se waqfiat, kholna, jorna aur safai ka tariqa sikhana hai. Bhag-1 Rif AK-47 se waqfiat Technical Data (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) (i) (j) (k) (l) (m) Lambai -874mm. Lambai butt gold - 645mm. Barrel ki lambai - 414 mm. Grooves -4 Right hand twist. Sight radius -378 mm. Muzzle velocity -715 mtr/sec. Weight empty rif -3.15 kg. Weight filled rif -4.6kg. Weight empty mag. -322 gm. Weight filled mag. – 827gm. Round capacity -30 rounds. Rate of fire single shot -40rounds per mint. Rate of brust fire -100 rounds per mint. 184 (n) (o) (p) (q) (r) Rate of cyclic Bore Principle Locking Effective range -600 rounds per min. -39mm,7.62 mm. -Gas selective fire. -rotating bolt. -400mtr. Rif AK-47 ko kholte samaye dhyan mein rakhne wali baten : (a) (b) (c) (d) Sab se pahle yakin Karen ki rifle khali hai. Rifle ko tartib mein khola jaye. Chote hisse purjo ko sab se last mein khola jaye. Rifle ko kisi saaf jagah par khola jaye. Kholna :Sab se pahle mag catch ko dabate hue mag ko utaren, uske bad bayonet stud ko dabate hue bayonet ko alag Karen. Scabbard aur bayonet blade ko alag Karen. Sling ko khole rifle ko cock Karen. Cock karne ke liye change lever ko’R’ par Karen piston extension ko khole, isko kholne ke liye retainer catch ko dabate hue body cover ko bahar nikalen. Retainer catch ko dabate hue push Karen aur returning spring ko bahar nikalen. Cocking handle se dabate hue piston extension ko piche khinche aur bahar nikalen. Piston extension se rotating bolt ko alag kar de. Axis pin ko bahar nikalte hue extractor ko khole aur firing pin bahar nikale. Jorna Rifle ko samaye dhyan mein rakhne wali baten. (a) Agar ek se zaida rifle khuli hai to Regd no. mila lena chahie. (b) Yadi chote chote hisse purje khule hai to pahle unhe jor liya jaye. (c) Jo purja sabse bad mein khola hai use sabse pahle jora jayen. Jorne ke liye sabse rotating bolt aur bolt carrier ko joren, uske bad cylinder tube ko joren. Locking catch ko niche baithate hue piston extension ko jorne ke liye piston head ko cylinder tube mein dakhil karte hue piston ko niche dabaen aur aag dhakelen. Body cover ko age ki taraf milatte hue niche bithayen jis se retainer catch piche ki taraf nikal ayega. Sling ko lagayen. Bayonet ko lagan eke bad rifle ko cock Karen aur trigger ko dabaen. Ant mein ma ko chara de. Bhag-3 Safai ka tariqa Barrel ko saaf karne ke liye pulthrough ki zarurat parti hai. Pulthrough mein 10X7.5 cmsize ki chindi dal kar safai Karen. Tab tak saaf Karen jab tak rifle achi tarah se saaf na ho jaye. Cylinder ko saaf karne ke liye rod mein brush aur chindi lagakar saaf Karen. Saaf ho jane ke bad tel laga dena chahie. Chote hiss eke ilaqe ki safai baki hathiyaronk ki tarah Karen. Gas cylinder ko kholne ke liye cylinder locking catch ko 90* mein khada Karen. Cylinder tube ko piche se upar uthate hue bahar nikalen. Firing pin ko khone keliye axis firing pin ko bahar nikalen, firing pin kholne ke bad extractor locking pin ko kholen. Oil lagan eke liye 10X5 cm chindi istemal Karen. Sankshep 185 Rifle AK-47 ki sahi dekhbal karne ke liye jawan ko rifle kholna, jorna aur safai ka tariqa malum hona chahie. ----------------------------*************************---------------------------------- AKM 17-31 AK-47 KE MAGAZINE BHARNA, RIFLE KA BHARNA, SIGHT LAGANA, READY, FIRE, MAKE SAFE AUR KHALI KARNA Parichay Ek jawan ko Rif AK -47 ko kholna, jorna aur safai karne ka tariqa sikh lena hi kafi nahi hai, balki is rifle se bharpur faida uthane ke liye tezi ke sath magazine ko bharna, rif ko bharna, sight lagana, ready, fire, make safe aur khali karne ka tariqa bhi ana chahie. Yeh karwai tabi sambhav hai jab jawan ne achi squad post trg pai ho. Uddesh Rif AK-47 ke mag ko bharna, rifle ka bharna, sight lagana, redy, fire, make safe aur khali karna. Bhag-1 Rif AK-47 ke mag ko bharna aur khali karna Is rifle se bagair rim wala amn fire kiya jata hai. Ek carton mein 20 rounds aur 35 cartoon mein ek box mein pack ho kar ate hai. Zaruri hai ki amn ko dhup, name aur barish se bachaya jaye. Rounds ko cartoon se nikalen aur samay ke lihaz se ek ek, ya do do, ya char char rounds ek sath safai kiya jayen, Dhayan rahe ki ek sath adhik rounds ki safai kiya jar aha ho to rounds apas mein ragar na khayen. Rounds ko saaf jagah par rakh de. Magazine ko bharna Magazine ko len aur magazine ka nirikshan Karen, magazine ki body kahin se dabi ya pichki hui to nahi hai, platform aur spring sahi kaam kar raha hai, magazine lips zarurat se zaida dabe ya khule to nahi hai aur bottom plate aur stud thik jagah set hai. Agar in mein se kisi bhi prakar ki kami ho to aise magazine ko istemal mein na layen, dusremagazine ko le aur usi prakar nirikshan Karen. Yakin Karen ki magazine sahi hai. Bharne ke liye magazine ko baen hath ki charon unglian bahar se angutha khare rukh mein karte hue is prakar pakro ki magazine ka lamba mehra bahar ki taraf ho. Magazine ko support ke liye ground sheet, boot ki toe a anguthe ke upar rakhe. Dahine hath se munasib round ko le aurungalian aur anguthe ke madad se round ko magazine platform par rakh 186 do ab baen hath ke naguthe se round ko niche dabao aur dahine anguthe se age ki taraf tab tak dhakelo jab tak rounds ka painda ki ginti karliya jaye. Agar bharte samay koi rounds gir jayen to us ko saaf kar ke akhir mein bhara jaye. Magazine ko jaldi istemal na karna ho to akhir rounds ko chindi laga kar bhara jaye jis se do faide hai. (a) Rounds girne se pata chalta hai. (b) Magazine ke andher dhool aur garda jane se bachao hota hai. Is prakar is magazine mein 30 rounds hai aur 30 rounds hi bhare jate hai. Magazine ko khali karna Magazine ko le baen hath ki charon mehrav zamin ki taraf rakhte hue kisi nokili chij se har dusre round ke Madhya mein dabaen, akhiri rounds ko khali karne ke liye magazine platform ko dabaen, rounds nikal jayega. Dhayan rahe rounds ka girao saaf jagah par ho. Khali karne ke liye agar rounds ka istemal kar rahe ho to ek do rounds ke bad badly kiya jaye. Bhag-2 Sight lagana aur range hasil karna Rif AK-47 ke upar sighting system ki subhida di gayi hai. Jisse hum alag alag range mein dushman ko engage kar sakte hai. Is ka fore sight pole type aur back sight ‘U’ type ka hota hai. Open sight ke hisse purje ken am nimn prakar se hai : (a) Fore sight assembly (1) Fore sight tip. (2) Locking nut. (3) Fore sight protractor. (b) Back sight assembly (1) Bed (2) Slide. (3) Plunger. Range lagana Is rifle rear sight ke bed mein ek se lekar 10 tak ank khude hue hai. Sam ank baen aur visham ank dahine taraf hote hai jo ki 100 mtr se 1000 mtr ke range ko jahir karta hai. Range lagane ke liye dahine hath ke ungli aur anguthe se plunger ko dabate hue slide ke age wale hise ko munasib range ke lakir ke sath adjust kiya jata hai. Bhag-3 Rifle ko bharna, Ready, Fire, Make safe aur Khlai karna Jab rifle bhari magazine ho aur change lever’S’ par ho, to rifle bhari mani jati hai. Jab rifle cock ho, chamber mein rd ho aur change lever ‘R’ par ho to rifle ‘Ready’ mani jati hai. Jab rifpar khali magazine ho chamber mein rd na ho, change lever ‘S’ par ho to rifle khali mani jati hai. Rifle ko bharna 187 Jab firer ko target dikhai de ya trg ke dauran adesh mile ‘Bhar’ to karwai is prakar Karen. Change lever ki position ‘S’ par Karen. Magazine catch ko dabate hue khali magazine ko utaren, pouch mein rakhe. Pouch mein se bhari hui magazine nikale aur mulhiza karte hue magazine bay mein dakhil Karen. Yakin Karen magazine thik laga hai. Pouch ka button band Karen aur baen hath ko fore head gd par le jayen. Ready Jab firer fire karne ka irada rakhta ho, tgt dikhai de ya trg ke dauran adesh mile ‘Ready’ tokarwai is prakar Karen. Change lever ko ‘R’ ya ‘A’ par Karen. Dahina hath se rifle ko cock Karen. Butt kandhe ka milap Karen. Kalmen wali ungali trigger par rakhe aur agle adesh ka intezar Karen. Fire karna Alag alag halation mein nikalne wale tgt par akargar fire ki kabiliyat ke lihaz se is rif ko banaya gaya hai. Is rif se kism ka fire kiya jata hai. (a) Single shot. (b) Burst fire. Single shot Single shot fire karne wale ke liye change lever ki position ‘R’ par Karen . Durust shist lekar trigger ka ppahla khinchao hasil Karen. Ab kuch sec ke liye sans roke aur durust sight alignment aur sight picture hasil Karen uske bad pura dhyan fore sight tip par lao aur dhire se dusre khinchao ko bhi hasil karo gli fire ho jayegi. Is prakar ek min mein 40 rds fire kar sakte hai. Stop Fire ke dauran tgt ilaqe mein achan koi jandar vastu nikal aye ya trg ke dauran adesh mile ‘Stop’ to karwai is prakar Karen. Kalmen wali ungali ko trigger se bahir nikalo. Rifle ko niche ‘Bhar’ position mein lao aur change lever ki position ‘S’ par karo. Agar magazine badly karne ki zarurat ho to magazine ki badly kare. Go On (jari kar) Samne wale ilaqe se jandar vastu hat jaye ya trg ke dauran adesh mile ‘Go on’ to change lever ko pahle wali position par karo, butt kandhe ka milap Karen aur fire mein shamil Karen. Brust fire Brust fire mein change lever ki position ‘A’ par hoti hai. Jab ek bar trigger ko press karne se do ya usse adhik fire hote ho to use brust fire kehte hai. ‘Stop’ aur ‘Go on’ ki karwai hu-ba-hu single shot fire ke tarah hi hai. Is prakar ek minute mein 100 rds fire kar sakte hai. Make safe Jab bhari hui rifle ek jagah se dusri jagah le jana ho ya trg kr dauran adesh mile ‘Make safe’ to karwai is prakar hogi. (a) Kalmenwali ungali ko trigger se alag Karen. Rifle ko ‘Bhar’ position mein layen. (b) Magazine ko dabate hue magazine ko utaren, pouch mein rakhe. 188 (c) Rifle ko dahine turn karte hue do bar cock Karen aur trigger press Karen. (d) Change lever ko ‘S’ par Karen. (e) Bhari hui magazine ka mulhazia karte hue rifle par charha de. (f) Zamin par gire hue rds ko uthayen, saaf Karen aur dusre magazine mein bhar de, magazine ko pouch mein band Karen. Khali karna Khali karna ke hukam par make safe ki karwai Karen, par akhir mein bhari mag ki jagah khali magazine chara de. Sankshep Larai ke maidan mein AK-47 rifle ki pura faida lene ke liye jawan ko tezi ke sath bharna, khali karna, ready aur fire karna ana chahie. Sabaq par sawal Q1. Rifle AK -47 ke magazine mein kitna rds ate hai ? Q2. Rifle AK-47 ka back sight kis type ka hota hai ? Q3. Brust fire ke dauran change lever ki position kahan hona chahie ? ----------------------------------*******************-------------------------------------- AKM 32-34 AK-47 ASSAULT RIFLE KI CHAL , ROKEN AUR FOURI ILAZ Shirshak Vishay Prashiks han upkaran Samay 189 Shuru shuru ka kam Dohrai ddeyash Pahunch Tartib Class ki ginti va bant, Hatiyar evam Rifle saman ka nirikshan. jodiyon mein ek Rifle AK-47 assault rifle ki shista ka khula hua va ek kayada class se prashna puche. rifle ka receiver cover utara huaa Rifle cock ki ho. Magazine, drill cartridge tatha pointer. 01-02 Min Is path ki samapti ke pastchat prashiksharthi AKM assault rifle ki chal , padne wali roke tatha unko dur karne mein saksham honge. Agar jawan ko rifle ki chal malum ho to rokon ke sabab malum karma aur unhe dur karma aasan ho jata hai. Isiliye jaroori hai ki har jawan rifle ki chal janta ho taki jarurat padne par rokon ko aasani se dur kar saken. 03-04 Min Tadaiv 02-03 Min 04-06 Min Tadaiv Yah sabab aapko tartibwar sikhaya jayaga. Rifle chal ki Rifle ki chal 8 action mein puri hoti hai. Iska macenical Saftey lock aulock va safety siyer hai applied safety fire selector hai. 1- Fire 2- Unlock 3-Extrator 4-Ejector 5-Feed 6- Load 7- Lock 8- Cock Rifle ki Fire selector , Trigger hammer, Pin chal mein firing , Pin returner , Chamber wale kam aane round ka penda gas went, gas Tadaiv 06-08 Min Tadaiv 08-10 Min 190 wale hisse purjon ka nam Fire Unlock Extract Eject cylinder, Gas Escape hole, piston hade, path ve, locking lag, Rear cap wheel, Extractor, Receiver rocks, Hammer head ve, Recoil spring, Housing, Feed Pecs, Magazine ke upar wala round, Bullet guide, Chamber, Safety seer ki noch, Hammer ka katav, Trigger seer aur safety seer relayaser. Fire-Fire selector ko firing position par karke jab trigar dabate hai va trigger sear ka milap toot jata hai. Jisse hammer apne access par ghum kar firing pin returner par thokar marta hai. Jisase firing pin apne hole se nikalkar chamber wale round ke pende par thokar matrta hai jisase goli fire ho jati hai. Action fire ka hota hai. Unlock:- Goli fire hone par gas paida hoti hai,paida hui gas bullet ko barrel mein aage dhakelte hai jab bullet gas vent ke pass se gujarti hai to kuch gas gas went se hokar gas cylinder mein dakhil ho jata hai. Yah gas piston head par dabav dalti hai. Jisase receiver piche ki harkat karta hai. Receiver ki piche ki harkat ke douran rotating bolt ka guide lag path ve ki madad se dayen se baen itna ghum jata hai ki rotating bolt ka guide leg rear capable se front capable mein aa jata hai. Jissse rotating bolt ka locking leg dahine se baen ghumkar body locking mein recesses se alag ho hata hai. Karyawahi unlock ki hoti hai. Extract -unlock hone ke bad rotating bolt bhi receiver ke sath pichhe ki harkat karta hai. Esi dauran extractor khali kesh ko pakad kar cahimbar se bahar khich kar lata hai action extract ka hota hai. Eject - jab chal wale purje ki piche ki harkat ke dauran risiver roks hammer ko pahle thora niche daba deta hai ekse bad hammer head Tadaiv 10-12 Min Tadaiv 12-14 Min Tadaiv 14-16 Min Tadaiv 16-18 Min 191 Feed Load Lock Cock Fouri ilaj va roken hammer ko piche dabate huye piche piche jata hai jisse sefty siyar ki nose hammer ka katav se milap ho jata hai aur returning spring apne housing me pura sama jata hai eki dauran fire kes ejector se takra kar ejection slad ki raste se dahine va niche gir jata hai yah action eject ka hota hai. Feed %& Jab chal wale purje magazine ke upar wale round se piche jata hai to magazine spring round ko upar dhakelta hai jisse magazine ke upar wala roun feeding ke taiyar ho jata hai. Jab retrnig spring apne tanav ko pura karti hai to risiver va rotating bolt aage ki harkt karti hai jisse rotating volt ka feed pice magazine ka upar wale round ko chamber me dakhil kar deta hai yah action feed ka hota hai. Load - Jab round chamber me achchhi tarah baith jata hia to rotatig bolt ki aage ki harkat puri ho jati hai extector ron ki rim par saver ho jata hai action load ka hota hai. Lock - Jab rotatig bolt ki aage ki harkat puri ho jati aur risiver ki harkat baki rah jati hai jab risiver aage ki harkat ki dauran rotating bold ka guide leg path ve ki madad se baye se dahine ko ghum kar prant capable se riyar capable me aa jata hai. Sath hi rotating bolt ka locking body locking resij me fash jata hai action lock ki hoti hai. Cock - Receiver ki akhiri harakat ke dauran safty sear releser sefty siyar ko aage dhakelta hai jisse sefty siyar aage va niche dab jata hai jisse safty sear ki nose ka hammer ke katav se milap toot jata hia sath hi triggar siyar aur hammer siyar se milap ho jata ha rifle fire ke liye taiyar ho jati hai action cock ki hoti hai. Fouri ilaj va roken- Agar rifle ki safai va dekhbhal thik prakar se ki jay to roken bahut kam padti hai. Tadaiv 18-20 Min Tadaiv 20-22 Min Tadaiv 22-24 Min Tadaiv 24-26 Min Tadaiv 26-31 Min 192 Agar roke pad bhi jay to use fore ilaj se door kar sakte hai. Namuna Bhar Position ‘Bhar’ 200 guj samne target fire Rifle shuru se hi fire na karen ya fire karte karte ruk jay karyawahi fouri ilaj ki is prakar karen. Trigger se kalme wali ungli alag kare rifle nice laye cock karke cocking handle par kabu pate huye baye turn kare, agar magazine khali hai to dusri bhari magazine chadhaye va fire jari kare (khali magazine) Mulaija karne par agar magazine bhari hui hai aur chamber se round eject hota hai to chal wale purje aage jane de eject huye round ke pende ka mulaija kare agar roun ke pende par chot hai to rifle ko fire me shamil kare (Fouri ilaj va roken-) Mulaija karne par agar magazine bhar hui hai aur body me case ya jinda round hai to rifle ko dahine turn kare hilaye cesh ya roun nahi nikalta hai to cocking handle ko chhodh de magazine ko uttar de va chal wale purjo ko aage pichhe ki harkat kare aur yakin kare ki round nikal gaya hai, bhara huya magazine lagaye,cock kare, fire jari kare ( body ki rok) Akhr me khali kar ki karwahi kare. Jab aadesh milta hai . Rifle thik fire karta rukta es aadesh par jawan rifle ko cock kara hya aur ejection slot se mulaija karta hai a.) Magazine khali chamber khali (khali magazine) b.) Magazine bhara eject huya round (mis fire) c.) Magazine bhara body me case ya round (body ki rok) Annya roken:Agar batai gai rokon ko dur karne ke baad bhi rifle fire na kare to annay roken ho sakti hai jo nimmna prakar hai.1- Magazine spring ka kamjor ho 193 Ratri ke douran fouri ilaj va roken door karne ka tarika Abhyas Sankshep jana . 2- Magazine lips close yak hula huna. 3- Extract ya eject ka na hona. 4- Firing pin ka toot jana. 5- Purjon ka aazad harkat na karna. 6- In rokon se bachne ke liye fire se phale in purjon ko badli kar de. Sashtra balon ke kuch ek abhayan karne hote hai jo ratri ke douran hi pure kiye jate hai. Jawan un abhiyano mein bagh le rahe hote hai us wakt karyawahi ki dawaran hatayar mein padne wali roko ke door karna hota hai. Is ke abbhayas karne ke bad prashiksarthi uprokt karyawahi karne mein saksham honge. Ratri ke douran nimmnalikhit binduo ke anusar karyawahi karen. 1- Fori ilaj va annay roko padne par din ki taraha hi karyawahi. 2- Fori ilaj ki jariye roken door karne ke liye jawan hatiyar aawaz ko jahir na hone de. 3- Ratri ke samay fori ilaj karte samay nailing position akhtiyar karen. 4- Purjon ko tatol kar ke he purjon ko pahachana jaay. 5- Annya roken padne par purjon ki toot- foot ko ungliyao ki sahata se pata lagaye aur purjo ki badli karen. Sathe hi rifle ko fire mein samil karen. 6- Rifle thik fire karta khali kar. Class ke jaowan chal aur rokon ko door karne ki karyawahi karenge. Class mein di jayi sikhalai ki yuddha ke maidan mein fire karte samay AKM assault rifle ki chal aur rokon ke bare mein bayan, namuna va abhyas mein ki si jawan ko koi shak ya sawal hai to puch sakte Tadaiv 31-34 Min Tadaiv 34-39 Min Tadaiv 39-40 Min 194 hai. ************************************************************************************* ************************************************************************************* ********************************************************************************** (8).51 mm MORTAR (MOR) MOR 1-4 51 MM MOR AUR DIAL SIGHT SE WAQFIAT KARANA HAI. 195 196 TARTIB S,NO SHURU 1. SHURU KA KAM 2. 3. DOHRAI TEACHING POINTS (s) Class ki ginti Deton mein bant . (t) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (u) Bandobast ki karwai. Q1. 2” Mor ka kam se kam aur ziada se ziada kitna range hai? A. 180 Mtr se 480 Mtr ya 200 se 525 gaz hai. Q 2. 2” Mor mein range kis prakar se hasil kiya jata hai ? A. Angel se range hasil kiya jata hai, PAHUNCH 51 mm Mor ko hamari sena mein 2” Mor ki jagah par laya gaya hai. TRG AIDS As per trg aids list TIME REMARKS 01 01 Ustad khud karenga. 01 02 Class ko 2” Mor ke bare mein sawal puchhen. 01 03 Pahunch sabaq se sambandhit 197 2” Mor mein kuchh kamiyan thi in kamiyon ko dur karke 51 mm Mor ko diya gaya hai. Sath hi range lagane ke liye Dial Sight bhi diya gaya hai jisse ham range hasil karte hain. 4. UDDESH 51 mm Mor ka aam bayan aur dial sight ki visheshtayen ke bare mein jankari dena hai, 5. SAMAN 51 mm Mor, 2” Mor, Dial Sight, Spare part wallet, pointer stick. 6. BHAGON MEIN BANT Bhag -I 51 mm Mor se waqfiat. Bhag -II Dial Sight se waqfiat. 7. BHAG –I 51 mm Mor se waqfiat. (a) Wt – 4.88 Kg + siling and muzzle cover (b) Barrel 2.14 Kg 5.460 Kg (c) Base 2.74 Kg (d) Lambai 670 mm (e) Barel ki lamba540 mm (f) Kutter - Low – 51.18 mm High 51.28 mm (g) Barrel ki life 51.75 mm (j) Muzzle velocity 107 m / per sec (k) Rate of fire Normal – 8 Bomb ( 3 Min) ho. 01 04 Do bar bataya jayega. As per trg aids. 01 05 Saman ko point karke batayenge. Sabak ko 01 06 tartibwar chalane ke liye. 51 mm Mor, 10 16 Bayan ke 2”Mor sath bataya Pointer, jay. Ground sheet. 198 (l) Rate of fire Tej - 12 Bomb ( 3 Min) (m) Muzzle cover & sling - 300 Gm (n) Carrying strap - 280 Gm HE Mk – I - 180 Mtr se 850 Mtr HE Mk – II 180 Mtr se 850 M HE Mk – I CH- I 180 M se 850 M HE Mk – II – CH-I 200 M se 750 M HE Mk – I CH- II 600 M se 850 M HE Mk – II – CH-II 750 M se 1080 M (m) Breach case ki lambai - 190 mm (n) Chaurai - 110 mm 51 MM Mor aur 2” Mor mein Antar (i) 51 mm Mor ka upper wala bhag bell type ka hai. (ii) 51 mm Mor coular bracket laga hai. Jis mein dial sight fit kiya jata hai. (iii)Dial sight ki suvidha hai. (iv)Barrel nut catch mein antar hai. (v) 51 mm Mor ki lambai jaida hai. (vi)Firing lever muda hua hai. (vii) Firing mech mein antar hai, (viii) Base plate chaura hai. (ix) Barrel ke threads bahar hai. Accessories 199 (i) Screw driver – 6 x 100 mm (ii) Screw driver 4 mm (iii) Spiner double – 100 x 100 mm’ (iv) L N Key - 5 mm (v) Box spinar - 24 mm (vi) Spinar double - 17 x 19 mm (vii) Can oil (viii) Bore cleaning brush. (ix) Box spare part Spare part box (i) Firing Pin (ii) Firing spring (iii) L N Key (iv) Striker gaze (v) Wing Nut Note :- Ek bomb extantion key atte hai. Jab barrel ziada garam ya ganda ho jaye to misfire bomb barrel mein phans jata hai. us ko nikalne mein kam aata hai, 8, ABHYAS Bhag I ka class se abhyas liya jae, abhyas sawal jawab dwara kiya jae. As per trg aids. 10 26 Class se abhyas karwaya jae. 9. BHAG-II Dial Sight se Waqfiat 1. Weight - 350 gm 2. Dia - 125 x 110 mms 3. 2” Mor mein rangelagane ke liye angle aur degree ka istemal kiya jata hai. Dial sight , Pointer stick 12 38 Digram ki madad se samjheyan. 200 Lekin 51 mm Mor mein dial sight ki suvidha hone ke karan range hasil kiya jata hai, is dial sight per range lagakar tgt kae upper bomb ko giraya jata hai, Range lagakar bomb ko lambe range tak dala ja sakta hai. Dial Sight ke Hisse (i) Housing’ (ii) Housing bracket (iii) Bracket screw (iv) Range scale (v) Polothern plate (vi) Wing nut (vii) Sprit buble. (viii) Crusser line. (ix) Locking Nut. Note :- Is per do radio active sign hote hai. agar sight tut jati hai to iske najdeek wale jawan ko 15 min ke andar urinal ke janch karna chahiye aur ziada pani peena chahiye. Dial sight ko polothen mein pack karen aur Wksp mein bhaj den. 10. SANKSHEP Q. 1. 51 mm Mor mein base plate hone se kya faida hai ? Ans. Ret ya mitti mein mor ko ghusane se rokhata hai. 02 40 Pratyek bhag se ek sawal poochhna zaruri hai. Q. 3. Dial sight ka kya faida hai? Ans. Sahi range lagakar tgt ko barbad kiya ja sakta hai. ------------------------******************************-------------------201 MOR 5-12 MORTOR KA KHOLNA JORNA AUR SAFAI SHURU SHURU KA KAM Squadka nirikshan karo aur unko batao, jaise ki baki hathiyaron ko istemal karne se pahle unka nirikshan kiya jata hai, isi tarh 50.8 mm mortor ko bhi istemal karne se pahle nirikshan kar lena zarurai hai. Niriksan kaise kiya jata hai, isi ko ap dekhenge. Tariqa : Muzzle cover ko utaro, barrel ko thoda upar karte hue dekho ki barrel mein koi chiz to nahi hai aur yakin hone par muzzle cover laga do aur khade ho jao. Bayan karo ki jab bhi 50.8mm mortor ko liya jaye ya sabaq shuru hone se pahle hamesha nirikshan kar lena chahie. DOHRAI Mortor ki visheshtaon par sawal-o-jawab. Uddesh 50.8 mm mortor ka kholna, jorna aur safai karna sikhna. SAMAN 50.8 mm mortor ki safai ka saman, combination tool aur wrench EM 50.8 mm mortor. PAHUNCH 50 .8 mm mortor, platoon commander ka apna top khana hai. Yeh sidha sda hathiyar hai magar iska fire bahut kargar hai. Iska zaida se zaida range 480 mtr hai mortor ko ek hi jawan asani se le ja aur fire kar sakta hai. Halakin is mein kam karne wali team mein am taur par do jawan aur ek fire ka rukh badalne aur us par qabu rakhne wala detachment commander hota hai. Is se 5 qism ke bomb fire kiye jate hai. Healing bomb ke mar dalne wala 202 ilaqa bomb ke phatne ki jagah se 8 mtr casuality area 150 gaz aur danger are 250 gaz 250 gaz charon taraf hai. BHAG-1 KHOLNA AUR JORNA (a) Kholna : Muzzle cover ko utaro aur baen hath ke anguthe se barrel catch ko niche aur piche dabao. Ab dahine hath se barrel ko ghari suiyon ke ulte rukh ghumao (agar dusre qism ki barrel hai to us ko ¼ charkar baen se dahine ko do aur barrel ko alag kar do). Commbination tool lo (Agar combination tool na mile to, chabi ka bhi istemal kiya ja sakta hai). Steel pad fixing screw ko baen hath se steel pad par qabu rakhte hue, do ya teen chakar dahine karo. Steel pad, fire pin aur firing pin spring ko nikal do. Yad rahe mortor ko isse zaida nahin kholna chahie. (b) Hisse purjon ke man : Muzzle cover, barrel, carring handle, barrel locking threads, breech piece, lever, lanyard, spade base plate, shoes, firing pin spring, firing threads, pin bush hole, steel pad aur fixing screw. (c) Jorna : Jorne ke liye kholne ki tamam karwai ulat karo. Firing pin ka mota hissa niche dalte hue lagao aur phir spring dalo. Steel pad ko laga do. Steel pad ko baen hath se qabu rakhte hue, combination tool se steel pad fixing screw ko kas ho. Barrel ko jorne ke liye “Safed line” ka khyal rakhte hue, barrel ko ¼ dahine rakho. Ab gahrai ki sion ke ruk ghuma kar kas do. (Agar dusri qism ki barrel hai to uski “safed line” ¼ dahine rakhte hue dahine se baen ¼ chakar ghuma do). Yakin karo ki barrel thik jur gayi hai, muzzle cover ko laga do. (d) Abhiyas : Kholne ka (akhir mein ek mortor khuli rakho). BHAG-2 SAFAI (a) Am safai (1) Larai ke maidan mein rozana saf karte rahna chahie, chahe fire kiya ho ya nahi. Agar mortor kotte mein hai, to hafte mein 1 bar zarur saf kiya jaye. Barrel ko rod par brush lagakar, rod ka istemal karna chahie, iske bad rod aur chindi jis par halka tel laga hua ho, use saf karo, phir khushak karo, (barrel ki safai ke liye mortor ko munasib jagah par rakho aur rod ko upar se dalna chahie). Achi tarah safai ho jane ke bad, barrel ka mulhazia karo. Yakin hone par rod se barrel mein tel laga do. Barrel ki churion ko bhi achi tarah saf karo. Steel pad, firing pin aur spring ko tel lagao, saf karo aur khushak karo aur phir tel lagao aur baqi puri mortor par rang kiya hua ho, to garda mitti saf karo. Yad rahe ki agar rogan kiya hua hai to tel mat lagao. (2) Abhiyas : Mortor ki safai karao ( akhir mein mortor khuli rahne do). (b) Fire se pahle ki safai : Fire se pahle barrel, firing pin ko khushak karo. Barrel ke ilawa jor do : 203 (1) Firing pin test : Steel pad ko qabu rakhte hue, steel pad par koi kargaz ya patta ya angutha lagakar lanyard kincho aur yakin karo ki kagaz aur patte mein surakh ho gaya hai, agar anguthe par karwai ki jaye to yeh mehsus hona chahie ki anguthe par chot lagi hai. (2) Agar firing pin jam ho gaya ho to bomb barrel mein dalte hi fire ho jaye ga. Yad rahe ki agar barrel khuli hai to lever ko dabane se pahle steel pad par dabao rakho. Agar aisa na kiay to ho sakta hai ki firing pin ko edhar udhar thokar lage aur toot jaye ya teda ho jaye. (3) Abhiyas : Jawano se abhiyas karao. (c) Firing ke dauran ki safai: Firing ke dauran jab bhi mumkin ko barrel ko khol kar steel pad ki safai karni chahie. Cartridges ke bache khuche chote chote kale rang ke garre steel pad par girte rahte hai aur unki ek the ban jati hai, agar unko saf na kiya jaye to ho sakta hai ki firing pin cartiradge par chot na laga sake aur bomb mis ho jaye. (d) Fire ke bad ki safai : Fire ke bad “am safai” Ki tarah hi mortor ki safai karni chahaie lekin barrel, steel pad, firing pin aur spring par khas dhyan do. Barrel ko garam pani mein dalkar saf karo, agar barrel par rang na kiya hua ho to barrel ko kisi bartan mein bhi kholte hue pani mein dalkar saf kar sakte hai. Safai hone ke bad mulhazia aur tel lagakar rakhni chahie. Abhiyas : Sawal-o-jawab aur abhiyas karo. SANKSHEP : (a) Sawal-o-jawab se. (b) Sabaq ki tartib dohrao. -----------------------------------****************------------------------------------ MOR 13-17 MOR KE BOMBON KI PAHCHAN, VISHESHTAYEN AUR CHAL 204 Parichay Har detachment ke jawan ko mortor se zaida se zaida faida uthane ke liye zarurai hai ki who bombon ke bare mein achi tarah jankari hasil Karen, har ek jawano ko mor ke bambon ke bare mein jankari honi se,hone wale hadson se bachaya ja sakta hai. Uddesh 51 mm Mor ke bambon ki pahchan, visheshtayen aur chal. Saman Sabhi prakar ke dril bomb, ground sheet. Pehchan aur visheshtayen Pahchan : Body par kiye hue gahre badami rang ko dekhkar aur uske gird lal rang ki dharian ko dekh kar pehchan ki ja sakti hai ki yeh ek HE bomb hai. HE bomb do prakar ke hote hai. HE MK-1 aur HE MK-2. Pahchan ke liye bomb ki body par MK-1 ya MK-2 likha hua hota hai. Visheshtayen (a) Technical Data (1) Weight – 980+ or -25 kg 205 (2) Lambai - 270mm (3) Fuse DA No. 161 M-III (M-I) (4) Visphokat mishran - RDX/WAX (5) Range (aa) Min - 180M (ab) Max - 850 M (ac) HE MK-I (aaa) CH-I - 180mtr – 600mtr. (aab) CH-II - 600mtr - 850mtr (ad) HE MK-II (aaa) CH-I – 200mtr - 750mtr (aab) CH-II -750mtr -1080 mtr (6) Rate of fire (aa) Normal - 8 bomb per min. (ab) Intense – 12 bomb per min. (7) Effective lethal area - 11mtr radius. (8) Danger area - 80 M HE BOMB KI CHAL Hisse purzon ke naam : Body, safety cap, safety pin retaining ball, wind shield, detent, detent spring, striker, striker spring, shutter mechanism, shutter spring, bress disk aur magazine. Bomb ki chal (a) Aam halat : Am halat mein bomb par dekhne wali baten yeh hoti hai ki safety cap laga hota hai. Jis ke upar chipkane wala phita laga hota hai. Safety pin retaning ball ko apni jagah rok kar rakhta hai. Detent spring ko wind shield se laga kar rakhta hai. Retaining ball striker ko rok kar rakhta hai aur striker spring daba rahta hai. Striker point shutter ko dur rakhta hai aur detonator striker ki sidh mein nahi ata. Fire se pahle safety cap aur safety pin ko nikal diya jata hai. (b) Fire hone par : Fire hone par bomb kafi pressure ke sath barrel se nikalta hai aur bomb ke harkat karne wale purje set back se dhake se piche harkat karte hai. Detent niche ki taraf harkat karta hai aur tircha channel khul jata hai. Detent spring dab jata hai. Striker bhi dhake se thora niche dab jata hai jis se retaining ball azad hokar tirche channel mein gir jata hai. (c) Armed hone par : Jab set back se Dhaka samapt ho jata hai to detent, detent spring ki takat se upar ki taraf harkat karta hai aur wind shield ke sath lag jata hai. Jis se tircha channel band ho jata hai. Ab retaning ball dobara apni jagah par wapis nahi ja sakta. Isi dauran striker spring ki madad se striker upar ki taraf harkat karta hai aur wind shield ke lag jata hai. Jab striker upar ki harkat karta hai, shooter azad ho jata hai. Shooter spring apna tanav pura karta hai aur shooter hinge pin par 206 ghumkar detonator thik striker point ki sidh mein aa jata. Ab bomb armed ki halat mein hota hai. (d) Takrane par : Jab bomb uran mein apni sabse zaida height par pahunch jata hai to bomb niche ki taraf ata hai. Zamin par takrane se wind shield dab jata hai, striker apne spring ke barkhilaf harkat karta hai. Striker point par chot marta hai, jis se dhamake ki tarang paida hoti hai. Yeh trang septum se hokar CE stemped mein aag lag jati hai. Jis se CE pallet dhamake ke sath phat jata hai aur bomb ke tukre tukre ho jate hai. Bagh-2 Smoke bomb se jankari Yeh apni fauj ki harkat ke dauran aimed fire se bachane ke liye ya dekhbal se bachane ke liye dhuyan ka parda banane mein istemal hota hai. Pahchan Upar se fuse nahin hota hai. Rang hara hota hai aur bomb ki body par smoke likha rahta hai. Technical Data (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) (i) Weight - 980gm. Lambai - 283 mm. Min rg - 180 mtr Max rg - 850 mtr Duhyan dene ka samay - 2min Rate of fire - HE ki tarah Max dia - 50.8 mm Filing weight - 450 grm Muzzle velocity – 110 M/sec Smoke bomb ke mukhya hisse (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) Nose cap. Delay pallet. Priming composition. Closing disc. Tail unit. Gun powder. Chal : Fire hone se chingari paida hota hai. Chingari closing disc se gun powder mein aag laga deta hai. Aag phir gun powder mein jati hai aur isi jala deti hai, jisse delay pallet jal jata hai. Delay pallet ke jalne se priming composition aur smoke composition aag pakar leta hai aur bomb dhuyan dena shuru kar deta hai. Yeh closing disc ke dawrabahar nikalta hai. Note : Bomb ko aag lagane wale purje bomb ke base mein hote hai aur carts bomb ko dhakalne ke ilawa aag lagane ka kam bhi karte hai. Delay plate ki wajah se dhuyan 6 sec tak bahar nahi nikalta hai. 207 Bhag -3 ILL bomb se jankari Yeh rat ke samaye mein roshini dene ke kam ata hai. Yeh bomb safed rang ka hota hai. Iske upar stencil se ILL likha hua hota hai. Technical Data (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) Weight - 925gm Time of illumination - 35sec Mean Luminosity - 2.5 lakh candla Rate of descent - 3 M/sec Pt of burst zamin ke upar - 150 + or -30 M Range - 900 M Illumination ka area - 400 mtr Dia. Chal : Fire hone se carts se chimgari paida hoti hai jo ki closing disc se guzarkar delay charge se hoti hui gun powder ke bursting charge ko aag laga deti hai. Isse flare paida hota hai aur flare para ke sath laga hota hai, flare aur para jab bomb se bahar nikalta hai to parachute jaldi hi khul jata hai aur flare udke niche hawa mein latakne lagta hai, sath hi roshini dene lagta hai. Sankshep 51mm mortor ke bombon se waqfiat hone se bombon ka sahi istemal kiya ja sakta hai aur sath hi sath bombon ki chal ki jankari hone se hone wale hadson se bacha ja sakta hai. -----------------------------********************--------------------------------------- MOR 18-25 BOMBON KO FIRE KE LIYE TAIYAR KARNABHARNA, KHALI KARNA FIRE AUR MISFIRE KA TARIQA SIKHANA . 208 S, NO 1. TAR TIB TEACHING POINTS SHU RU SHU RU KA KAM (v) Class ki ginti Deton mein bant . (w) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (x) Bandobast ki karwai. 2. DOH RAI 3. PAH UNCH Q1. 51 mm Mor ka wazan kitna hai? B. 4.88 Kg. Q 2. 51 mm Mor ki barrel ki lambai kitni hai. ? A. 540 mm. Q 3. Dial sight 102A ka wazan kitna hai? A. 350 gm. 51 mm Mor ek Pl cdr ka topkhana hai. is ko ek jawan aasani se handling kar sakta hai agar No 2 hazir hai to tej mor fire mewin madad de sakta hai ek mor det is kabil hona chahiye ki tgt TR G AIDS TIME R EMA RKS As per trg aids list 02 02 Ni raks han class se karw aya jai. 01 03 Pic hale saba q se dohr ai le jai. 01 04 Pa hunc h saba q se sam band 209 par mor ko acchi tarah lay kar sake aur fire kar sake sath hi misfire hone per teji se karwai kar sake. 4. 6. UDD ESH Bombon ko fire ke liye taiyar karna , bharna, khali karna, lay fire aur misfire ka tariqa sikana hai. SAM AN 51 mm Mor, Dial Sight, Drill bomb, 9 mm CMG, mag, Fig 11 tgt, easel, black board, Ground sheet. BHA GON MEIN BANT hit aur chot a saf ho. As per trg aids. Bhag -I Fire se pahle Bombon ko taiyar karna. 01 05 Do bar bata ya jayeg a. 01 06 01 07 Sa man ko point kark e bata yeng e. Sa bak ko tarti bwar chala ne ke liye bhag on mein baat. . 06 13 Bhag -II Firing posn, Bharna aur Khali karna. Bhag –III Lay aur fire karna. Bhag –IV Misfire par karwai. 7. BHA Fire se pahle Bombon ko G -I taiyar karna Bag canvas se bomb tube ko nikalen, tube se bomb ko niklayen, bomb ki body ka nirakshan karen ki body dabi to nahin hai. Agar koi nuqus ho to bomb ki badli karen aise bomb ko istemal mein na laya jai. Dusre bomb ko len aur check karen agar bomb thik hai to karwai is prakar 51 mm Mor, Bag canva s, Drill Bomb Ba yan ke sath nam una diya jay. 210 karen. (a) Retaining cap ko tight karen, chipakne wale fite ko nikalen safety cap utaren, agar No 1 akela bhar aur fire ki karwai kar raha ho to safety pin ko bhi nikalta hai. Agar No 2 hazir ho to safety pin ko bharne se pahle nikalata hai. (b) Bomb utane hi taiyar karyen jitna zarurat ho. Dhyan rahe ki bomb ka safety cap nikalane se nose ke upar nami ka asar ho sakta hai, is liye bomb fire karne se pahle kuchh samay pahle hi taiyar kiya jaye. Jin bombon ka safety pin nikala gaya ho un bombon ko fire kiya jaye ya blind kar diya jaye. Jin bombon ko pack kar rahe hon un bombon ke nose ko saaf karke pack kiya jaye. 8, ABH YAS Class ka bombon ko taiyar karna ka abhyas karwaya jae. 9. BHA G-II Firing posn, Bharna aur Khali karna 51 mm Mor se ek hi posn se fire kiya jata hai. (i) Kneeling Posn. Yeh posn mor fire karne ki liye assan hai aam taur par hum isi posn se hi fire karte hain. Is posn mein dhyan mein rakhane wali nimna baten hain :- 51 mm Mor bag canva s, Drill bomb. 51 mm Mor, Drill bomb, Groun d sheet. 05 18 Ab hyas ke daur an galtiy an ko dur kiya jai. 10 28 M or ko mou nt karn e se pahl e zami n ka 211 (a) Dahine ghutna kafi dahine ho. (b) Baen hath ki kohanui ghutane ke andar ya bahar ho. (c) Boot ka toe base plate ke madhaya mein. (d) Mor No 2 No-1 ke dahine taraf posn lega taki bharane ki karwai aasani se kar sake. 51 mm Mor ko bharna Sabse pahle mor ke upar se muzzle cover ko utaren aur mor ke andar dekhen agar No 1 akela hi bharne ki karwai kar raha hai to taiyar kiye bombon ka tail unit niche ki taraf karte hue barrel mein dakhil karen dhyan rahe bomb ko barrel mein dakhil karne ke lie jabardasti na ki jaye. Bomb dalne ke baad mor ko hilayen taki bomb steel pad per thik se baith jaye. Note Agar No 2 bhar ki karwai kar raha hai to tab bomb barrel mein teen chauthai dakhil ho jaye tabi safety pin ko nikaylen aur dono hathon ko niche ki taraf teji se laen. nirak shan karn a aur nlrlk shan karn e ki jarur at kaha n parti hai class ko bata na. Khali Karna Agar fire karne ki jarurat na ho ya addash mile khali kar to karwai is prakar karen mor ko daen ki taraf karte hue dahine hath ko muzzle par rakhate hue bomb ko nikalta hai aur agar No 2 ho to tail unit wala bhag 212 No 2 ki taraf karte hue No 2 deta hai, aur No 1 muzzle cover ko lagata hai. . . 10 11 as Abhy BHA G-III Class ka bharne aur khali karne ka abhyas liya jaye. Lay aur fire karna. Mor ko tgt par sahi align karne ko lay kahte hai. Lay karte samay tgt, mor ki safed line aur firer ka sir ek sidh mein hona chahiye. Lay ki karwai mor ko harkat dekar kiya jai jab NO 1 ko yakin ho jata ki mor ki safed line aur tgt ek sidh mein hai, to No 1 on pukarata hai. No 2 apne sathyan se khara hota hai, aur lay ko check karta hai. Agar correction dena ho to correction deta hai, aur up pukarata hai. Fire Karna. Mor ko fire ke liye lever ki dori ke andar aur anguatha pura lever ke upar , lever ko dabate samay jhatake se na dabaya jai. Jis se ki bomb ki elevation mein farak pare. Lever ko dabate samay dhyan sprit bubble par ho, agar correction dene ki zarurat ho to correction dekar fire karen agar tgt barbad ho gaya ho to dismount mor karen ya addesh mile bina fire khali kar. 51 mm Mor, dial sight, CMG, mag, drill carts, bomb, Fig – 11 tgt, Groun d sheet. 10 38 10 48 Cl ass ke shak ko dur kary en. Ja b No 1 on puka rta hai to daen hath lever par hota hai aur corre ction karn a ho to daae n hath se base plate ko utha te hue daen aue baen hark et deta hai. Sqd 213 . . 12 ABH YAS 13 BHA G – IV Class ko lay aur fire karne ki karwai par abhyas liya Trg aids pura layout kiya hua. 09 57 51 mm Mor, Drill bomb, CMG, (i) Firing pin ka tuta drill ya ghisa hona. carts, (ii) Steel pad par Fig 11 dhatu aur gas ka jama tgt. hona. (iii) Retaining cap ka dhila hona. (iv) Bomb ka steel pad per thik na baitha hona. (v) Carts par koi naqus hona. (vi) Kisi purje ka tuta hona. 10 67 Misfire par karwai. Misfire hone ke karan :- post trg ke daur an lever ko na dabh ayen balki bom b pukr yen. Sh ak aur sawa l ko dur kiya Mi jaye. sfire hone ke kara n class ko bata ya jai. Ba yan ke sath nam una dena . Namuna Class ke det se mor ko bhar aur lay tak ki karwai karwaya jai. Ustad No – 1 ki haisiyat se namuna de. Lever ko dabane se bomb fire na ho ya trg ke dauran hukam 214 mile fire nahin, to NO –1 mor ko hilata hai, aur lever ko dobara dabata hai, is prakar dobara lever ko dabane se bhi fire no ho ya adesh mile fir fire nahi, to NO –1 khali karte hue No –2 ko misfire deta hai. NO –2 dusra bomb bharta hai, agar dusra bomb bhi fire na ho ya addesh mile fir bhi fire nahi to No – 1 khali kar ki karwai karta hai. No –2 dono bombon ko hatheli par rakhate hue carts ko check karta hai, aur cart per kam chot ya chot na ho to steel pad ko kholen aur firing pin aur spring ko chick kiya jata aur steel pad ki bhi safai ki jaye, Bad mein misfire ko blind karke barbad kiya jaye. . 14 ABH YAS Class ko misfire ki karwai par abhyas kiya jaye abhyas ke liyte addesh is prakar se honge :(ii) (ii) (ii) nahin . 15 SAN KSHEP Fire nahin Fir fire nahin Fir bhi fire Q. 1. Jin bombon ka safety pin nikala gaya ho unko kya karna chahiye ? Ans. Fire ya blind ke taur per barbad kiya jai. Q. 2. Lay kise kahate hai? Ans. Tgt, Mor ki safad line aur firer ka sir ek sidh mein karne ki karwai ko lay kahte hai. Pur a trg aids layout kiya hua. 11 78 Ab hyas ke daur an galtiy an ko dur kare n 02 80 Sa bhi bhag on se jarur i sawa l puch e jaye. 215 Q 3. Misfire hone ke karan kya hain? Ans . (i) Firing pin ka tuta ya ghisa hona. (ii) Steel pad par dhatu aur gas ka jama hona. (iii) Retaining cap ka dhila hona. (iv) Bomb ka steel pad per thik na baitha hona. (v) Carts par koi naqus hona. (vi) Kisi purje ka tuta hona. -------------------------******************-------------------------------MR 26-33 51 MM MOR SE DIRECT AUR INDIRECT FIRE KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA S, NO TAR TIB TEACHING POINTS 1. SHU RU SHU RU KA KAM (y) Class ki ginti Deton mein bant . (z) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (aa) Bandoba st ki karwai. 2. DOH Q1. Fire se pahle mor ko RAI lay karna kyon jaruri hai? C. Durust sidhai hasil karne ke liye. Q 2. Bomb ka retainer cap dhila hone se fire par kiya asar T RG AID S A s per trg aids list TIME RE MAR KS 02 02 Nir aksh an class se karw aya jai. 02 04 Pic hale saba q se doteen sawal 216 hoga. ? puch hkar dohra i ki jai. A. Bomb misfire hone ka andesha ho sakta hai. Kyoin ki carts ke cap tak firing pin nahi pahunchata hai. 3. 4. PAH UNCH 51 mm Mor ek Inf Pl ka area weapon hai. Is hathiyar mein dial sight ki suvidha hai. Jis se hum najar ane wale aur najar nahi ane wale dushman ke uper un sthanon se bhi fire dal sakte hai, jahan par flat trajectory wale hathiyaron se fire nahi dala ja sakta hai. Is par No –1 aur No –2 team ke taur par kaam karte hain. Is se hum bhin – bhin haltaon mein direct aur indirect fire dal sakte hain. UDD 51 mm Mor se direct aur ESH indirect fire karne ka tariqa sikhana hai. 01 05 Pa hunc h saba q se samb andhi t aur chota saf ho. 01 06 Ud desh ko dohar aya jayeg a. Sa man ko point karke batay enge. 5. SAM AN 51 mm Mor, Dial Sight, Drill bomb, 9 mm CMG, mag, Fig 11 tgt, easal, black board, auxiary aiming mark, Ground sheet. 01 07 6. BHA GON MEIN BANT Bhag -I Direct fire karne ka tariqa. 01 08 7. BHA G -I Bhag -II Indirect fire karne ka tariqa. Direct fire karne ka 5 tariqa. Jab ek mor det tgt 1 12 20 No 2 ke 217 ko dekate hue tgt ke uper mor lay karke hawa ka huk rakhate hue sprit bubble ko madhya mein rakhte hue fire karta hai use direct fire kahte hai. (a) Direct fire mein mor det, tgt ke beach kisi prakar ki rukawat jaise crest, makan adi nahi hona chahiye jis se ki bomb ki uran mein badha pare. (b) Jahan tak ho sake direct fire hamasha low angle se karna chahiye, jisse ki bomb ki uran mein hawa ka pratirodh kam hota hai. (c) Tirechi hawa bomb ko tgt se dur le jati hai. Note :- Ustad No –1 ka kam kare No –2 ki liye class se ek student ko bulayen. mm Mor , dial sigh t, Dril l Bo mb, Fig 11 tgt. kam ki liye class se ek stude nt bulak ar khud No 1 ka kam karke namu na den. Namuna :- Mor det samane dekh, 400 m maidan ke baen kinare par dushman ka LMG post, barbad karange HE Mk- I CH – I se, Mor det kneeling posn isse jagah mount mor , HE bhar, lay, aur fire. Yadi No – 1 fire karne ka nishchay karta hai to bubble ko madhya mein rakhate hue lever ko bina jhakte se dabata hai, bomb fire ho jata hai, agar correction dene ki zarurat ho to correction deta hai, nahi to khali kar sqd post training ke dauran drill bomb khali kar. 218 8, 9. ABH YAS BHA G-II Class ka direct fire karne par abhyas karwaya jae. Indirect fire karne ka tariqa Jab ek mor det bina tgt ko dekhe apni mor ko kisi kudrati ya banavati nishan ki madad se lay karke hawa ka huk rakhate hue tgt ko barbad karta hai to is prakar ke fire ko Indirect fire kahte hai. (a) Indirect fire us halat mein kiya jai jabki tgt kisi imarat, crest ya pahari ke pichhe ho, aur bomb ko tgt par khare rukh girane ki zarurat ho. (b) Angle hamesha seedai satah se lena chahiye. (c) Indirect fire mein yadi low angle se crest clearance na ho raha to high angle se fire karna chahiye. (d) Indirect fire us samay dala jata hai jab firer tgt ko na dekh raha ho, lekin tgt ki disha ko acchi tarah se janta ho. 5 1 mm Mor , Dril l bo mb, Gro und she et, aux illar y aim ing mar k. 10 38 St udan t ko board ki mada d dwar a samj haya jae. . Tariqa Mor det ko axis of advance milane par wah fire aur move ke tariqe se crest line tak jata hai aur ilaqe ko scarch karta hai. Det Cdr hukam deta hai mor det samane dekh 750 m ek goal darket, darket 6 baje dushman ka LMG post, barbad karange HE Mk – I CH – II se mor posn crest line se pahle 25 gaz dabi zamin dono piche ate hai, bhar lay ki karwai 219 karte hai. No-2 crest line par line of fire se 15 – 20 gaz dahine ya bahen crest ke sath posn leta hai aur fire ka adesh deta hai aur mor ko dekata ha. Yadi correction dena ki zarurat para to munashib correction dekar tgt ko barbad kiya jata hai. Correction dene ka tariqa is prakar se hai :(i) 500 gaz tak ke range ke liye age piche ke liye 50 m dahine aur baen ke liye 5 dgree ka koi corrcection nahi diya jata hai, agar range 500 gaz se adhik hai to uper niche 50 m aur dahine baen 3 degree ke liye koi correction nahi di jata hai. (ii) 1 degree se 1000 gaz per 17 gaz ko cover karta hai. (iii) 1 degree se 500 gaz per 17/2 = 8.5 gaz ko cover karta hai. (iv) 51 mm Mor area wpn hai teen se char bomb fire karke tgt ko barbad karte hai. (v) 1 HE Bomb ka mar dalne ka ilaqa 11 m from point of burst se hai. (vi) 5 degree cover karega 5 x 8.5 gaz = 42.5 gaz. (vii) 22 gaz. 1 HE cover karega (viii) 2 HE cover karta hai 22 gaz x 2 gaz = 44 gaz ( Approx area barbad hoga) 220 Auxiliary Aiming Mark Method Aise nishan jinhe banawati taur par taiyar karke unaki madad se tgt ko barbad kiya jata hai. Unhe auxillary aiming mark kahte hai. Jaise lakari, pather, thatha bayonet etc. Parantu control store ka istemal kiya ja raha ho to dismount ki halat mein wapas lena chahiye. Bayan Jab firer ko tgt na dikhai de raha ho aur tgt ke asspass koi kudrati ya banawat nishan bhi maujud na ho to hum in banawati nishaon par mor ko lay karke tgt ko barbad karate hain. Auxillary aiming mark lagate samay dhyan mein rakhne wali batyan :(i) Back ground se milta julta ho. (ii) Sky line par na lagaya jayen. (iii) jai. Mujbuti se lagaya (iii)Lagane wala dushman ko na dikhai de. (iv) Pahle auxillary aiming se dusra auxillary aiming mark itna duri par lagaya jai ki lagana wala No –1 auxillary aiming mark aur tgt dikhai de is tarah se adhik sidhai hasil hogi. (v) Control item ka istemal kiya ja raha ho to dismount mor par wapas lena chahiye. 221 Tariqa ( ustad No 2 ka kaam karen) Class ko axis of advance den. Class samane dekh sabse uncha ped class ka axis of advance. Class advance.Jaise hi crest ke pass pahunchte hain shakhat fire ka adesh den. Puri class crawl karke crest par pahunch jati hai aur search karen. Cdr ya NO –2 fire ka order den. Mor det 450 m ek bara patther dushman ka LMG post barbad karenge HE Mk- I CH – II se. Mor posn 20 m piche mount mor. Cdr ya No –2 ( Yadi cdr nahi hai to ) auxiliary aiming mark lagane ke liye crest par hi rahe. No –2 crest par aar ke mutabik posn leta hai, aur tgt aur No –1 ko dekhta hue ek sidhai mein karte hue NO –1 auxiliary aiming mark lagata hai. Fir itna piche akar No-2 auxillary aiming mark lagata hai, ki use tgt bhi dikhai de. Yon kahe NO 1 mark aur tgt ko ek sidh mein rakhte hue itna pichhe ata hai ki tgt asani se dikhai de aur dusra aiming mark lagayean. Abh No – 2 ya cdr crust par line of fire se dahine ya bahyen is se 20 gaz duri per posn len jis se ki short fall ke nukshan se bacha ja sake aur No –1 ko bhar aur fire ka adesh den. Yadi bomb tgt par gir jata hai to bomb on tgt mor fire ka adesh den aur No-1 ki madad ke liye Piche ayega. Our use 222 bharne aur khali karne mein madad kareaga. Dusra crust par mar dekhane ki liye jayega. Tgt bardad hone par tgt barbad dismount mor ka adash dega. ( Abhyas ke dauran drill bomb khali kar) yadi bomb tgt par na gire to piche sikhe tariqe se correction dekar barbad karaga ant mein dismount mor par auxillary aiming mark bhi wapas layaga. as . 10 Abhy SAN KSHEP Class ko direct aur Indirect fire karne mein thata subsidierly aiming mark chune aur auxillary aiming mark lagana ka abhyas karwaya jai. Q. 1. Direct fire kon se angle se achchha aur kargar sidh hota hai ? Ans. Low angle se. Q. 2. Direct fire tgt par kis surat mein dakla jata hai? Ans. Jab firer tgt ko dekh raha ho aur unke bich No –1 koi rukawat na ho. Q 3. Indirect fire karne ke koan – koan se tariqa hai? Ans . (i) Subsideraly aiming mark. (ii) Auxillary aiming mark. 10 38 02 80 Sa bhi bhag on se jaruri sawal puch e jaye. -------------------------------****************---------------------------223 MOR 34-39 MOR DET KA KAM AUR FIRE NIYANTRAN SHURU SHURU KA KAM Mortor aur carbine ka nirikshan karo. Dohrai Sabaq 5 par sawal aur jawab se. UDDESH Mortor detachment ke kam, position lane ki drill aur fire niyantran karna sikhana hai. Saman Mortor, drill HE bomb, upyogi utility pouch, box holder, jis mein faltu purje aur dusra zarurat ka saman ho. PAHUNCH Sidha aur prakash fire dalne ke liye jawan mortor chalane ki drill jan chuke hai, ab jawan mortor det ke ek sadasye ke roop mein is sikhlai se kam le, jawan yeh achi tarah samaj le ki mortor det mein jawan ki khm nischit nahi hote un se koi sa kam karaya ja sakta hai. Isliye who hark am ki jankari Karen. Detachment ki banabat Standard Yeh banabat maidani ilaqe ke liye lagu hai aur is mein sirf mortor det cdr aur no. 1 hote hai. In dono ke pas niminlikhit saman hota hai : (a) Det cdr. (1) Carbine bayonet ke sath. (2) Bhara hua carbine magazine. (3) 2 bombs carrier (6 HE 6 sank). (b) Mortor no. 1 (1) 50.8MM Mortor. (2) Pistol 9 mm. Modification ‘M’ Yeh banabat har ilaqe mein lagu hai. Is banabat mein mortor no. 2 ko shamil kiya jata hai, taki det apne sath zaida ammuniation utha sake, standard banabat mein jis par det cdr aur mortor no. 1 saman authorized hai. Modification ‘M’ mein bhi usi prakar uthate hai mortor no. 2 ka saman niminlikhit hai : (a) Rifle7.62mm SLR. (b) Bhare hue magazine. (c) 2 bombs carrier (6 HE 6 Sank). MORTOR KO UTHA KAR LE JANE KA TARIQA Advance ke dauran lambha rasta taye karne ke liye mortor ko asani se ek jagah se dusri jagah uthkar le jane ke liye char taiqe hai : (a) Trail yani ek hath mein mortor aur dusre hath mein container. 224 (b) Mortor kandhe par aur container trail position mein. (c) Mortor seling arms aur container trail position mein. (d) Mortor aur container ek seling mein bandh kar kandhe ke upar se latkai hui. DETACHMENT KA KAM Det cdr ki pahli zimmewari yeh hai ki jo hukam use mile hai aur fire dalne ka jo kam use karne hai uske anusar bh mortor ki position chune who ek ya ek se adhik dusri position mortor ki pahli position se kak se kam 50 gax (45.72mtr) ke faisle par ho. Namuna dekar samjao. Det cdr par pahunchte hi no.1 aur no.2 ko aisi jagah le jaye jahan se who target ya nishan bindu ko achi tarah dekh sake. Jawan ko zor dekar samjao ki har mouke par sabdhani barti jaye, aur is bat ka pura dhayan rakha jaye ki dushman to nahi dekh raha hai, a bar se det cdr mortor position banane, sath hi dusri position aur untak pahuchane ke raste bhi samja de, phir who fire kiye jane wale bomb ki qism range aur kon ke bare mein hukam dega, jaise HE Smk load 40* uncha kon. Agar sahayak sishan bindu ki zarurat hai to det cdr unhe position mein lagaye, iske bad who no. 2 ko hidayten dekar khud chipi hui position mein chala jaye aur wahi se who mortor se fire dalwayen aur fire par niyantran rakhe. No. 1 ka kam bhi mortor ki dekhbal karna aur fire dalna hai, yeh bhi dekho ki chuni hui position (objective) ke raste mein koi choti ya moti chiz to nahin hai agar, aisa ho to woh det cdr ko suchna de. No. 1 ka pahla kam hai ki who no.1 ko lagatar gola barudh supply karta rahega. Agar is kam ke liye us ki zarurat nahi hai toobserver ya mumkin bachao ke kam par tainat kiya ja sakta hai, agar fire bahut tez raftar se dalna hai to who, no.1 ke is mortor load karega. Agar is bat ki zarurat nahi hai to who no. 1 ke sath na rakha jaye. Jawano se mortr det ke roop mein position par qabza abhiyas karya jaye. FIRE NIYANTRAN Det cdr aisi jagah par hoga jahan se who target ko dekh sake who dushman se apna chupao rakhe aur mortor se itni doori pare rahe ki awaz wahan tak pahunch jaye who fire rakhe se pare rahe, lakin bazu ki taraf itna door bhi na rakhe ki darustian dena mushkil ho yeh who fire karne ka hukam dega , agar zarurat hai to who har bomb ke girne ki jagah dekh kar darustian batayega. Wo tajube se dekhega ki hathiyar ka khaternak ilaqa kitna hai aur no.1 ki qabliyat kya hai,choti choti galtian 60 gaz se kam ya 50 gaz se kam ki durusti karna galat hai aur is se use batana chahie. Bato aur namuna dikhao ki range ki line darustian kaise di jati hai,jab bomb target tak na pahunche, to det commander hukam de upar 100 gaz range kam karna chahta hai, to niche 100 yard rahe 50 gaz se kam darustian na di jaye. Disha Agar bomb target ke baen taraf gire to apni galti dekh kar hukam diya jayega, dahine 6* isi tarah agar bomb target ke dahine taraf gire to hukam diya jayega ki baen 6* aur agar bomb anuman lagai gayi jagah par gire to det cdr range pukarega, yad rahe degree se kon ki darusti na di jaye. 225 Jawan se fire niyantran ke sawal dekh kar abhiyas karao. Position lane aur fire niyantran ke Vishay mein det ko puri drill ka abhiyas karao. SANKSHEP Squad se sawal pucho aur unhe sawal puchne ka mouka de. Jawan ji kamo mein kamzor hai, abhiyas karya jaye. Jawano ko moti moti baten dohrao. ************************************************************************* ************************************************************************* ******************************************* (9).NO.36 H.E GRENADE (GN) GN 1-8 NO.36 HE GRENADE KI PAHCHAN AUR ISTEMAL 226 SHURU KA KAM Ustad har jawan ko ko ek drill grenade mulhiza karke den aur apne grenade mein drill ignitor set dal len, sqd ko line ban karao, number karao aur pouch aur saman ka mulhizia karo. Bayan karo ki dusre hathiyro ki tarh grenade ka bhi yeh jaan salamati ki liye mulhaiza kiya jata hai. Base plug ko kholo, dekho ki grenade ke andher is mutabik koi chez jani ignator 227 set to nahin, agar hai to bahar nikal do, yakin karo ki dono surakh khali hai. Yeh karwai grenade ke andher sabak shuru karne se pahle kar li jayegi. Jawan grenade ko baen hath se pakre, baen kandhe ki line mein. DOHRAI CQB par sawal-o-jawab karo. UDDESH No. 36 Grenade ki pahchan aur istemal le liye tayar karna sikhana hai. Saman Drill grenade, drill ignator set, drill cartiradge safai ka saman, instructional grenade packing ka saman aur grenade ki chal ka diagram. Instructional grenade (sikhlai ka grenade) yeh grenade ke purjon ki jankari dene ke liye istemal kiya jata hai. BAYAN No. 36 grenade ke istemal ke lihaz se teen prakar ke hai : (a) DRILL GRENADE : Is grenade ko sikhlai ke dauran istemal karte hai. Pahchan : I ski body par safed rang aur 5 surakh hote hai, bajan ko pura karne ke liye iske andher ret(sand) bhari hoti hai. INSTRUCTIONAL GRENADE : Yeh grenade ke purjon ki jankari dene ke liye istemal kiya jata hai. Pehchan: Is par live grenade ki tarah rang kiya hota hai, lakin is par lal nishan nahi hota aur body ka adha hissa kata hua hota hai. (b) DRILL IGNITOR SET : Is mein ek surakh hota hai aur iske kuch hisse mein lakri ka buraha bhara hota hai. Jin boxon mein drill ya instructional grenade rakhe hote hai, unpar drill ya instructional grenade ke nishan lage hote hai. (c) LIVE GRENADE :Yeh grenade jaan se mar dalne wale grenade hai. Yeh phatne ki jagah se 8mtr charon taraf adhmi ko jaan se mar sakta hai aur 270 mtr tak jakmi kar dene ki shakti rakhta hai. Is grenade ko un jagahon par istemal kiya jata hai jahan chapti trijactory wale hathiyar kargar nahin hote, maslan : (1) Morche, makano ke andher, tuti phti zamin, rat ke waqt, hamle ke akhir mein, AFVs ke khilaf agar tank ke turret khule ho to un mein phaink kar andher beithe hue crew ko kafi nuksan pahuchaya ja sakta hai. Is ke ilawa body traps ke liye istemal kiya jata hai. Yad rakhen ki agar ilaqa madhani ho to grenade phainkne se pahle ki apne jawan position mein hai. (2) Grenade ki body dhale lohe ki bani hoti hai. Is ki body par yeh jhirian kati hoti hai, jo ki grenade ko puri tarah tukde hone mein madad deti hai, grenade mein HE “high explosive” yani dhamake se phatne wale barudh bhare hote hai. I ske andher ko nalian hoti hai. Bich wale striker aur spring ke liye aur dusri detonator ki line hoti hai, striker aur spring ko lever ke zarie apni 228 jagah kayam rakha jata hai jo ki striker ki kati hui jhiri mein laga hota hai. (3) Lever ko qabu mein rakhne ke liye, ek safety pin hota hai, jise lever ko upar se aur grenade ko kandhon mein bane hue ssurakskho mein se nikal kar lagaya jat hai. Grenade ka bajan 700 kg hota hai. (4) Pehachan : Is ki body ka rang gehra bhura hota hai, iski giradh hare rang ki qhari aur lal rang ke cross hote hai. Rat ke waqt grenade ko is ki dody par bani hui jhirion ki sahayata se pehchana ja sakta hai. BHAG Yeh sabaq char bhagon mein sikhaya jata hai : BHAG 1–PRIMING KE PAHLE KI TAYARI (a) Grenade ko kam mein lane se pahle, uska mulhazia safai aur acchi tarah se kar lena zaruri hai. Taki is bat ka itmiyan ho jaye ki thik hi kam karega. (b) Mulhazia : Grenade ko hath mein lekar batao ki is bata ka yakin karo, ki lever striker ki jhiri mein acchi tarah laga hua hai aur body se zaida bahar ki taraf to nahi nikala hai, agar nikala ho to daba diya jaye. (c) Abhiyas : Sawal-o-jawab se. (d) Kholna : Key ki madad se base plug kholo. Lever ko unglion ke niche qabu mein rakhte hue safety pin nikalo, grenade ke khule hisse ko belt ya boot ki toe par rakhte hue ahista se azad kar do aur strilar aur spring ko nikal kar bahar rakh do. (e) Safai : Grenade mein am taur par gease lage hoti hai, istemal se pahle ise achi tarah se saf kar lena chahie. (f) Striker test se pahle jorna : Striker aur spring ko bich wali sleeve mein is tarah rakho, ki striker ki jhiri grenade ke kandn ki taraf rakhen. Strikar ko round ya kisi nok dar chiz ki madad se uppar ki taraf dakelo aur lever striker ki jhiri mei lagatar zor se niche dabate hue qabu mein rakho. (g) Striker test : Grenade ke khule sire ko belt ya rakhte hue lever ko azad kar do. Yakin karo ki striker zor se niche ata hai, agar aisa na ho to zahir hai ki safai acchi tarah nahi ki gayi hai. Is shuwat mein phir achi tarah se safai karo aur striker ko phir se test karo. Agar phir bhi kam na kare, to nuks ho sakta hai, is shuruwat mein grenade ko istemal mein na laya jaye. (h) Purjon ko antim bar jorna : Jawan ko batao ki striker test se pahle grenade ko jahan tak jorna sikh chuke ho. Sikhe hue tariqe ki mutabik jor do. Ab lever ko unglion ke niche qabu mein rakhte hue aur sath hi filling screw ko apni taraf rakhte hue, pin ko is tarah lagao 229 ki jo jawan grenade ko dahine hath se pahinkne wala ho, who pin ko dahine se baen ko lagyega aur jo baen hath se pahinkne wala ho, who baen se dahine se lagayega. Is ke bad pin ki nokon ko thoda sa khol do. Zaida kholne se pin ki nokon ko nikalna kathin hoga. Akhir mein base plug ko laga do. (i) Abhiyas : Kholna, jorna, testing aur akhri jorna. BHAG-2 IGNITOR SET KA BAYAN (a) Igniator set : Igniator set grenade ko phatane ke liye istemal mein laya jata hai, iske hisse purje, cap chamber jiske upar 22 cap lagi hoti hai. Fauze aur detonator ko bari etyat se hath mein pakarna chahie, isse hamesh fuze aur cap chamber se pakro, is kisi kism ki chot na lagne do aur na hi hath mein pakarkar masalna chahie. Isse garmi aur name se bhana chahie aur iske kisi hisse purje ko alag karne ki koshish nahi karni chahie. (b) Pehchan : Igniator set do prakar ke milte hai, ek jaise ki fuze ki range saft hota hai aur rat ke waqt pehchan ke liye iske girdh ek rubber ya kagaz ka chhala laga hota hai. Is chale ko utarna nahi chahie, is kism ke jalne ka time 4 second hota hai, iske ilawa dusre qism ki ignator set, jaise ki fuze ka rang pila hota hai aur iske girdh rubber ka challa nahi hota. Is fuze ke jalne ka time 7 second hota hai aur yeh aise grenade mein istemal kiya jata hai, jinhe rifle se fire karna ho. (c) Nirakhsan : Dekho ki 22 cup ke bich wala surakh upar se thik tarah bund hai ya nahin. Zarurai hai ki cap chamber mein kisi qism ka nuqs nahi hona chahie aur yeh bhi dekho ki chamber arm detonator fuze se majbooti se lage hue hai. BHAG-3 CHAL (a) Diagram par : Jab pin ko nikal kar grenade ko phaink diya jata hai to striker spring ki madad se kafi takat ke sath niche dabta hai. Jaise lever udkar ek taraf door ghir jata hai. Striker ki lug 22 inch cap par chot marte hai, jis se aag paida hoti hai. Yeh aag cap chamber mein bante hue surakh se hokar fuze mein dakhil hoti hai, fuze apne time jalkar detonator ko aag deta hai aur detonator dhamake se phat ta hai. Detonator sleev toot jati hai, aag grenade mein bhar hui HE baruud mein pahuchati hai, jisse grenade puri takat se phat kar charon taraf kafi zaida nuksan pahuchata hai. (b) Instructional grenade par chal samjao. (c) Abhiyas : Chal par sawal-o-jawab se. BHAG-4 PACKING 230 Is qism ke lakri mein 12 grenade band hote hai. Box par Hand Grenade char second likha hota hai. Har box mein ek tin ka dabba hota hai,jisme 12 igniator set rakhen hote hai. Is box ko dekhen ki andher ki taraf ek base plug key hoti hai. Rifle se fier kiye jane wale grenade ke isi tarah ke box mein ate hai. Har box mein 12 grenade,12 igniator set, 12 tube launching aur ballistide cartiradges hote hai, box ke ek taraf rifel aur dekhne par 7 second likha hua hota hai. New packing HE grenade Ek dhati box mein 4 container hote hai, ek container mein teen grenade aur ek 3 igniator set ka daba hota hai. Baki rifle ko box mein 3 choti dibian hoti hai. Ek dabhi mein teen tube launching, char ballisits cartridges hote hai. Baki saman pahle ki tarah. Abhiyas : Packing par sawal karo. SANKSHEP Sawal-o-jawab se sabaq ki moti baten batao. TOET Grenade ko phainkne ki tayari karna (a) Tariqa : Jawan ko grenade aur ek ignator set 2 aur phainkne ke liye tayar karne ke liye kaho. (b) Standard : Yeh dekho ki jawan grenade thik tariqe se tayar karte hai ya nahi. (c) Niche bataya hua kam jawan hath se Karen ya sawal ka jawab de. (1) Handison se bachne ka pahla upaye.(Jawan hath se kam karega). (2) Grenade ka bahar se mulahiza karna (Jawan sawal ka jawab dega). (3) Safai karna (Sawal ka jawab dega). (4) Striker set (Jawan kam karega). (5) Igniator set ka kam karega.(Sawal ka jawab dega). (6) Grenade ko prime karna. (Jawan kam karega). ------------------------****************----------------------------GN 9-15 GRENADE KO PHAINKNA 231 SHURU KA KAM Squad ko is tarah line ban kar ke number karao ki baen hath se phainkne wala jawan squad ke baen par ho. Grenade ka mulhazia karo, jawan ko do do kadam kholo, target batao aur phir semi circle mein khada karo. DOHRAI Grenade ki pehchan aur fire se pahle ki tayarion par sawal-o-jawab. UDDESH Grenade ko phainkne ke sidanth sikhna hai. Saman Har jawan ke liye do do drill grenade aur high wire. PAHUNCH Grenade ko door shatru ki position mein phainkne ke liye zarurai hai ki grenade ko unchain dekar goli mein phainka jaye, jaise ki cricet ki game ko phainka jata ha. Ek ausat takat wala jawan grenade ko azadi se bazu ko ghuma kar asani se 25 se 35 gaz tak phaink sakta hai. BHAG Yeh sabaq 2 baghon mein sikhaya jayega. BHAG-1 READY AUR THROW KARNA (a) Ready : Ustad baen wale jawan mein aur age ho. Ustad apne line ke liye target batye. ‘Ready’ ki hukam par, grenade ko uthao ya pouch nikalo aur dahine hath se is tarah pakro ki lever ungalion ke niche dabi rahe. Baen hath ki pahli ya dusri ungli ko safety pin mein dalo aur grenade ko badan ke samne peti ki line mein rakhte hue, badan ki dahine tarafitna turn karo ki bayan kandha aur paon target ki sidh mein ajaye. Agar koi jawan baen hath se grenade phainkane wala ho to who tamam karwai iske ulat Karen. (b) Throw : Baen hath sae phainkne wala, baen ki, jagah dahine aur baen ki jagah baen samje. Dahine hath se grenade ko phainkte waqt baen hath ko bagair hataye badan ke sath milakar rakho aur 232 dahine hath ko niche aur piche ki harkat dekhkar pin nikal do. Yeh zaruri hai ki grenade ki taraf dekhkar yakin kar liya jaye ki pin nikal gaya hai . Ab baen kandhe ko target ki taraf rakhte hue, baen bazu ko upar utahate hue target ki sidh mein lao aur sath hi badan ko pura piche ki aur jukhao. Ab bagair ruke badan ko age ki or jhukate hue grenade ko phainko. Yaad rahe grenade ko us waqt chorna chahie, jab ki dahina hath kandhe ke upar zaida se zaida upar ho. Yeh zarur dekho I grenade kahan girta hai, grenade ke zamin par girte hi let jao, dekho aur abhiyas ke dauran mar ko pukaro. Galat jagah se grenade ko sahi jagah par lane ke liye baen paon ki madad lo. (c) Abhiyas : Grenade throw karne mein ustad bari bari sab jawan ko check karo. (Sqd high wire ke dahine taraf). BHAG-2 HIGH WIRE KA ISTEMAL (a) Ki grenade ko golai dekar phainkne ka abhiyas den eke liye high wire ka istemal kiya jata hai. High wire zamin se 18 feet unchi honi chahie, isme 3 feet tak ki chorai shamil hai. Yani jail ka niche wala hissa zamin se 15 feet par hona chahie. High wire ke age 10 gaz par ek morcha hona chahie aur high wire ke piche 15 aur 25 gaz par throwing line ban ni chahie. Agar high wire ka bandobast na ho sake to us surat mein chote drakht jiski unchain takriban 15 feet ho, ke upar se phanke waya jaye, iske ilawa do drakhton ke darmiyan rassi ya tar bagaira bandh kar bhi high wire ka kam liya ja sakta hai. (b) Namuna : Ustad ek dafa high wire ke upar se grenade throw karne ka namuna de aur jawan dekhen. ABHIYAS : Ustad ke niche high wire par grenade throw karne ke groupon mein, ek group high wire ka istemal kare aur dusre bagair high wire ka istemal Karen. SANKSHEP : Sawal-o-jawab se sabaq ki moti moti baten batao. ---------------------------******************--------------------------GN 16-29 GRENADE PHAINKNA AUR LOBBING 233 SHURU SHURU KA KAM Squad line ban karke number karao. Apna grenade dekho aur mulhazia karo. DOHRAI Grenade phainkne ka abhiyas lo. UDDESH Grenade ko phainkna aur lobbing ki sikhlai dena. SAMAN Do-do grenade aur har qism ki aren maujud hon. PAHUNCH Ap logon ne grenade phainkne ke mul sidanth sikh liye ha. Ab unhe asli taur par amal mein lane ki zarurat hai, is squad mein ark e piche se grenade phanikne aur lobbing karne ki sikhlai di jayegi. BHAG Yeh sabaq 2 baghon mein sikhaya jayega : BHAG-1 PHAINKNA (a) Standard position se morche se grenade ko phainkna : Jawan ko samjao ki grenade phainkne wala, pahle khai ke andher ya unchi ar ke piche ki position ko achi tarah se dekhe. Iske bad who ready position bana kar aura r se pura faida utha kar, grenade ko phainke aur tezi ke sath piche ko hat jaye, agar zarurat ho use dekhna chahie ki grenade kahan gira hai. (b) Abhiyas : Jawan ko khade ho kar ar ke piche khade hokar grenade phainkne ka abhiyas karo. (c) Lying ar : Jawano ko batao ki grenade phainkne walo ko kisi kam unche bandh ya diwar adi ke piche se target ko achi tarah se dekhna chahie aur ar ke piche dubak kar grenade ko ready position mein lana chahie. Grenade ko phainkte samaye who dono hatho ke bal par upar uthe aur baen ghutne ko zamin par tekte hue apna badan chatki se piche ko jhuka kar grenade ko phaink de aur tezi se ark e piche let jayen. (d) Abhiyas : Lying ar ke piche se grenade phainkne ka abhiyas lo. (e) Crouch position se namuna do. Abhiyas lo. BHAG-2 LOBBING (a) Bayan : Gali kuche ya jungle ki larai mein yeh zarurai hoge ki tezi se grenade ko makan mein khirki ya darwaje se dala jaye ya ghani jaridar jagah mein chora jaye. (b) Namuna : Jawan ko alag alag kayi halato mein grenade chorne ka namua do. ABHIYAS Squad se grenade lobbing ka mila jhula abhiyas lo. SANKSHEP Sawal-o-jawab ki moti moti baten batao. TOET 234 Yeh test unchi ar se liye jaye. Zamin se 20 feet daimetre ka dahira khinchao. Iske centre ar se 20 gaz ke faisle par ho, jawan se grenade phainke. 6 me se 3 grenade dahire ke andher girne chahie. ------------------------------------****************-------------------- GN 30-39 TUBE LAUNCHING MK-I SE WAQFIAT AUR RIFLE GRENADE KO FIRE KARNE KA TARIQE SIKHANA S, NO . 1 B U TARTI SHUR SHUR U KA KAM . 2 AI DOHR TEACHING POINTS TRG AIDS (bb) Class As ki ginti groupon per trg mein bant . aids. (cc) Tube launching,weapo n aur saman ka nirakshan. (dd) Band obast ki karwai. Q1 No 36 Hand Grenade ka mar dalne ka ilaqe kitna hai ? Ans :- 8 Mtr charo taraf. Q2. 7 sec wala TIME REMA RKS 01 01 Usta d niraksh an khud Karen 01 02 HE Hand Gren ke vishesh atyen per sawal 235 ignitor set ka kya pachan hoti hai? Karen. Ans :- Fuse ka colour pila aur chhalla nahin hota. . . . . 3 PAHU NCH 4 UDDE SH 5 SAMA 6 N BHAG ON MEIN BANT No 36 Hand grenade ko ek jawan 25 se 35 gaz tak phank saketa hai lekin ismein 7 sec wala fuse lagakar rifle se fire karke kam se kam 50 m aur ziada se ziada 150 m tak gren ko dur gira kar dushman ko barbad kar sakte hain jo ki rifle se hum tube launching MK-I ki madad se aur HD carts ke sath fire karte hai. Is lie harek jawan ko rifle grenade ko fire karne ka tariqe achchhi tarah se ana chahiye. Tube Launching MKI se waqfiat aur No-36 HE Grenade ko rifle se fire karne ka tariqe sikhana hai. Tube Launching MKI, Grenade, Ignitor set, Drill carts, Arming ring, Rifle , Sand Bag, Fig 11 Tgt. Yeh sabaq tartibwar sikhaya jayaga. Tube Launching MK-I se Waqfiat Tube Launching MK-I ki banawat ek khokli nali se sakal mein hai. Jo ki ek taraf se khalui aur dusre taraf se band hota hai. Band wale sire par ek stud laga hota hai aur ismein churiyan bani hoti hai. Rifle, Grenade , Tube launchi ng MKI, HD Carts , Ground sheet, Sand Bag. 01 03 Saba q se samba ndat aur saaf aur chhota hona chahiye . 01 04 Udde sh ko dohaya ra jai. 01 05 20 25 Baen ke sath naumn a. 236 Is stud ke zariye rifle grenade ke base plug bane surakh se fit kiya jata hai, khule wale surakh ke zarie tube ko band barrel mein bane hue jagah par charaya jata hai. Is hole ka rang OG colour ka hoat hai is ko nap taul is prakar hai. Lambai – 15 CM , Wazan - 127 gm. Tube par kuchh surakhen bane hue hote hain jis mein range control pin lagaya jata hai. Is grenade ko fire karne ke lie gren par ek arming ring lagaya jata hai, jo ki lever ko apni jagah se nikalne se rokhta hai. Arming ring ka wazan – 33 gm hai. Visheshtyan (i) 50, 100, aur 150 m tak fire kar sakte hain . (ii) Dono range control pin ke sath fire karne se 50 m range hasil hota hai. (ii) Ek range pin ko nikalne se 100m ka range hasil hota hai. (iv) Dono range pin ko nikal kar fire karne se 150m range hasil hota hai. Grenade ko Prime aur Unprime Karna (i) Grenade ka nirakshan aur safai ke bad arming ring ko grenade ke bichwala katav par milana 237 chihiye. (ii) Arming ring charhate samay grenade ko niche se charakar bichwala katao par milana chahiye. (iii) Arming ring ka katao lever ke viprit hona chahiye. (iv) 07 sec wala ignitor set (fuse) ko centre sleeve mein dakhil Karen aur base plug fit Karen. (v) Grenade ko tube launching per chadhana. Unprime karan (i) Base plug ko khole aur fuse ko alag Karen aur box mein rakhe. (ii) Base plug ko lagaen aur base plug key ki madad se fit katren. (iii) Grenade ko box mein band Karen. Rifle fire ke liye taiyar karma (i) Grenade sight ko 90 degree ke angle mein khara Karen. (ii) Change lever ki posn ‘R’ ya ‘B’ par karen aur rifle ko cock karen aur HOD lagayen. (iii) HD carts ko len aur chamber mein dakhil Karen. (iv) Yekin Karen ki chamber mein round achhi tarah se fit ho gaya hai aur chalwale purzon ko age jane 238 den. (v) Change lever ki posn ‘S’ pe rkarne. Grenade ko bharna (i) Taiyar kiya hua grenade ko nirakshan karte hue grenade ko chahiyen. Check Karen ki grenade thik tarah se fit ho gaya hai. (ii) Range milne par range contrl pin ko nikalen aur tube launching ko achchhi tarah se fit Karen. (iii) Firing posn akhityar Karen aur safety pin ko nikalen. Firing Posn (i) Kneeling posn :Baen paon ko tgt ki sidth lagayen aur fiel ke butt ke age wala bhag zamin par laga hua ho aur pichhla bhag sand bag per laga huwa ho baen hath se front hand guard par pakaren. (ii) Sitting Posn :Dayen paon ko lamba aur baen paon ko adha close Karen. Baki kneeling posn ki tarah. Grenade ki Chal Trigger dabane se HD carts fire hota hai jisse gas paida hoti hai. Gas tube launching ki flash eleiminator se alag kar deta hai. Uran ke dauran chand second bad arming ring set back ked hake se gir jata hai aur lever azad ho jata hai striker 239 spring ki takat se .22 cap par chot marta hai aur aag ki chingari paida hoti hai aur safety fuse ko aag lag jati hai. Jisse detonator fat jata hai sath hi detonator sleev phat jata hai aur HE barud ka upper aad lagta hai aur chur chur hoker fat jata hai. Bina fire khali karan (i) Change lever ko ‘S’ per Karen. (ii) Tube launching ko baen ahth se pakarte hue safety pin ko lagyen. (iii) Tube launching ko flash eliminator se alag Karen. (iv) Range pin ko lagayen. (v) Rifle ko khali kar ki karwai kareyn aur HD carts ko rakhen. (vi) Grenade ko surakshit jagah per rakhen. Fir aur misfire (i) Sabse pahle sikhe tariqe se fire ke lie taiyar Karen. Tube launching aur grenade ko taiyar karne ke baad firing posn akhityar Karen aur ley ki karwai Karen. (ii) Tgt, grenade ka shoulder aur fire ka sir ek sidh mein ko aur change lever ko safe par. (iii) Fire ke hukam par change lever ko ‘R’ 240 par karen aur trigger ko dabaen, Grenade fir ho jayega. (iv) Misfire hone par change lever ko ‘S’ par karen dayen ahth se safety pin ko lagayen. Tube launching ko rifle se alag karen. (v) Dusra HD carts ko lagyen aur dobara fire ke lie taiyar ho hayen. . . 7 ABHY AS 8 SANK SHEP Sabhi student ko chal, fire aur misfire ki karwai par abhays karwaya jai. Q. 1. Tube launching MK-I ka wazan kitna hai? Ans. 127 Gm. Q. 2. Deno range control pin nikalne poar kitna range hasil hota hai ? Ans. 13 38 02 40 Her ek bhag per ek ya do sawal puchay en. 150 Mtr. Q. 3. Rifle grenade ko kaun kaun si posn se fire kiya jata hai ? Ans. Kneeling posn aur sitting posn se fire karte hain.. 241 ************************************************************************************* ************************************************************************************* ********************************************************************************** (10).9 mm PISTOL BROWNING ( CODE- PIS) PIS 1-3 242 9 mm PISTOL SE WAQFIAT, KHOLNA ,JORNA AUR SAFAI KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA 243 S. NO 1. IB U TART SHUR SHUR U KA KAM 2. DOH RAI 3. PAHU NCH UDD 4. ESH TEACHING POINTS (ee) Cl ass ki ginti groupon mein bant . (cc) H athiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (gg) B andobast ki karwai. Q1 CQB ka kya matlab hai? Ans :- Close Quarter Battle. Q2. CQB ke wpn kaun kaun se hain? Ans :- 9 mm Pistol, Gren, 9 mm CMG, Bayonet.Khukari,Da h Talwar etc, 9 mm Pistol short recoil par kam karnewala CQB ka bahut achchha hathiyar hai. Achanak niklane wale dushman ko kam range par barbad karne ke liye jaruri hai ki jaldi se jaldi mag ko utare , khali mag ko pounch mein band karna aur bhara mag chara kar fire kar sake sath hi tut fut ho jane par jaldi se jaldi pistol ko khol saken. 9 mm Pistol se waqfiat, kholna , TRG AIDS TIME 9 mm Pistol, Pistol case, Line yard, cleaning rod, Chindi. 01 01 Ust ad cham ber sqd ko dikha n, 02 03 Cla ss ko prash an pooch e jaye. 01 04 Cho ota saaf aur sabaq se samb andhit ho. 01 RE MAR KS 05 Udd esh ko 244 5. ) N (a SAMA (b) BHAG ON MEIN BANT jorna, safai karna ka tariqa sikhana hai. 9 mm Pistol, Pistol case, line yard, cleaning rod aur chindi. (c) (d) Bhag -I Achchshi adaten aur pistol se waqfiat . dohra ya jai. Sa man ko point karke batay a jayaga . (g) 01 06 (e) (f) 01 07 Sub hida ke liye bhago n mein bant. 07 14 Poi nt karke batay a jai. Bhag -II Pistol ko kholna aur jorna. Bhag III Safai ka tariqa. -I BHAG Achchhi adaten aur pistol se waqfiat (a) Band pistol ko hamesha bhara hua samjhen. (b) Pistol lete ya deta samay nirikshan kiya jai. (c) Triger dabate samay hamesha surakshit disha mein karke dabana chahiye. (d) Pistol bharna ho to 9 mm Pistol,Point er 245 hammer ki posn age ho. (e) Dushma n ko kabhi bhi pistol ke age na ane dena. 9mm PISTOL KA TECH DATA 1. KHALI PISTOL KA WAJAN 0.900 Kg 2. BHARI PISTOL KA WAJAN 1.100 Kg 3. KHALI MAG KA WAJAN 0.075 Kg 4. BHARI MAG KA WAJAN 0.200 Kg 5. SIGHT RADIOUS 6.25” 6. PISTOL KE LAMBAI 7.8” 7. BARREL KI LAMBAI 4.75” 8. MV 305 Mtr/Sec 9. RATE OF FIRE 6 RDS/6 SEC 10. MAG CAPACITY 13 ROUNDS 11. BHARE JATE HAIN 12 ROUNDS 12. BATTLE EFFECTIVE RANGE 15 MTR (KARGAR RANGE) 246 ) (a (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) 9 mm Pistol,Point er 05 19 9 mm Pistal, Pointer , ground sheet. 07 26 (g) 13. SUPPORT KE SATH KARGAR RANGE - 25 MTR 14. BATTLE CROACH POSN SE KARGAR RG - 10 MTR 15. ZEROING KE LIYE RANGE 10 MTR 16. MECH SAFETY (0.125”,0.135”,0.145 ”, 0.155” AUR 0.165”) 17. EK SIGHT SE DUSRI SIGHT BADLI - ½ “ KARNE PAR 10 MTR PAR FARAK 18. APPARTURE - U TYPE 19. TRIGGER PULL - 2.270KG SE 3.630KG (5 SE 8 LBS) 8, 9. ABHY AS Class se technical data aur hisse purje ke naam par abhyas liya jai. 9 mm Pistol ko BHAG kholna aur jorna. -II Sab se pahle yakin karen ki pistol khali hai mag ko dabate hue mag ko utaren baen hathki kalmiwali ungali aur hath ki madad se slide ko piche khinche khurdhara bhag ko pakarkar 247 aur dayen hath ki anghute safety catch ko slide ke age wale bhag mein lagyean. Slide ko pura piche rokte hue dono hath ke anghute se safety catch aur slide ke milap ko toren. Slide par kabu rakte hue aage jane den, body ko slide se alag karen baen hath mein slide ko ulta pakren, aur main spring ko breech ki taraf dhakalete hue mein spring aur guide bahar nikaleyan barrel ko niklayan ke lie thora uper aur pichhe ki taraf uthaen. ) (a (b) Hisse Purje ke Naam (a) Mag Platform, spring, bottom plate. (b) barrel Barrel locking lug, bolt guide , spring way, setting for (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) main spring aur guide. (c) Slide Slide races barrel, main guide, spring way, ejection slot , breech block, extractor, sear, firing pin, pin firing way, spring aur locking plate. (d) Frame Locking piece, tripping lever, trigger, trigger guard, mag way, 248 mag catch, ejector, pistol grip, hammer, hammer sear, spring, safety catch. (e) Pistol Slide locking lever (Long catch) Axis pin, thumb piece, main guide spring, main guide, loop aur plunjor. Jorna Sab se pahle barrel ko slide mein dalen, barrel way mein fit karen aage ki taraf dabate hue setting for main guide mein fit karen, dhyan rahe loop ka gol wala bhag niche ho, slide ko jorne ke liye flame ke leg ko slide ke races mein lete hue slide ko pura piche khinche, aur slide ki age wali jhiri mein safety catch ko lagaye aur long catch ko apne hole mein fit karern, slide par kabu rakte hue safety catch ko niche karen aur slide ko aage jane den mag ko charaen aur trigger ko press karen. ABHY AS 2. 1 Class ko kholne aur jorne mein abyas liya jayen BHAG SAFAI KA - III TARIKHA;- . 9 mm Pistol, cleaning Aam safai slide rod, kop pura peeche chindi. 04 05 30 35 San kshep har ek bhag 249 kinche aur safety catch ka age wali jhiri mein lagayen.cleaning rod mein 4”x3”ke sizeki chindi lagakar barrel ko saf karen,tel ke liye 4”x2”size ka chindi ka istemal karen. ) (a (b) FIRE SE PAHLE KI SAFAI;- Fire se pahjle sabhi purjon ko kholkar saf karen saf karne ke liye saf kapre ka istemal karen. FIRE KA DAURAN SAFAI;Samay milte hi mag ko utaren, slide (c) se sawal jawab karke kiya jaye. (d) (e) (f) (g) ko pichhe kinche, safety cap ko lagayen rod aur chindi ki madad se safai karen. FIRE KE BAAD KI SAFAI;-Pistol ko kholen saaf kapare se purjon ko puri taraf safai karen,chhote purjon ko na kholen ,barrel ko thori der garam pani mein rakhein aur rod aur chindi ki madad se saaf karen, aur tel lagayen.Lubrication system banki hathiyar ki tarah hai. ABHY AS Sawal jawab se abyas liya jayen 03 38 250 SANK SHEP Q1 – Pistol istemal karne wale ki acche aadten kiya hain? Band pistol ko hamesha bhara hua samjen. 02 40 (b) Pistol lete ya deta samay nirakshan kiya jai h (c)Trigger dabate samay hamesha surkshit disha mein karke dabana chahiye. (d)pistol bha5rna ho to hammer ki posn age ho. (e) Dushman ko kabhi bhi pistol ke age na ane dena. Q2 Pistol ka sidght radious kitna hai ? Ans- 6.25” Q 3 – Pistol ka rate of fire kitna hai? Ans – 6 rd 6 sec mein Q 4 – Ejector kaun se hisse mein paya jata hai? Ans – Frame ke piche hisse mein. -----------------------------********************---------------------------251 PIS 4-6 9 mm PISTOL KE MAG KO BHARNA, KHALI KARNA, PISTOL KO BHARNA,READY,MAKE SAFE AUR FIRE KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA 252 S, NO 1. B U TARTI SHUR SHUR U KA KAM 2. TEACHING POINTS (hh) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (ff) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (jj) Bandobast ki karwai. TR G AIDS TIME 9 mm Pistol , Pistol case, Line yard, Drill carts . 01 DOHR Q1 Pistol ko kitne bare bhagon mein khola jata hai? Ans :- 3 bare bhagon mein. Q2. Barrel ki lambai kitni hai? Ans :- 4.75”. 3. PAHU NCH 9 mm Pistol CQB ka bahut accha hathiyar hai, is mein nazdik niklane wale tgt ko marne ki khubi hai, is lie har ek jawan ko jaldi se jaldi pistol ko bharna, khali karna aur fire karne ka tariqa aana chahiye, taki is ka pura faida uthaya ja sake aur samay ki bachat karte hue ek goli ek dushman ka mudda hasil ho sake. 01 4. UDDE SH 9 mm Pistol ke mag ko bharna,khali karna,pistol ko bharna , ready, make safe aur fire karne ka tariqa sikhana hai. 01 ( a) AI (b) saman (c) 9 mm Pistol, Mag, (d) 01 REM ARKS 01 2 3 4 0 Pichle sabaq se dohrai le jai. 0 Choota saaf aur sabaq se sambandh it ho. 0 Uddesh do bar bataya jai. (e) 01 Ustad khud karen (f) ( g) 05 S 253 Drill carts, Pistol case, line yard, Fig 11 tgt. . 6 BHAGO N MEIN BANT am an ko poi nt kar ke bat aya jaya ga. Bhag -I Mag ko bharna aur khali karna . 01 06 Ma 05 11 Ma 04 15 07 22 Bhag -II Pistol ko bharna, ready , make safe aur khali karna. Bhag III Firing posn aur fire karna. BHAG -I Mag ko bharna aur khali karna . (f) Mag ke hisson ke naam. (g) Amn safai ka tariqa. (h) Amn se waqfiat. (i) Mag bharne ki tartib. (j) Mag ko pistol se nikalna. (k) Mag ki round rakhane ki capacity. , 8 9 ABHYAS BHAG-II Mag bharne aur khali karne ka abhyas liya jai. Pistol ko bharna, ready , make safe aur g, Drill carts g, Drill carts 9 mm N 254 . khali karna. (a) 2. (b) 1 (c) Pistal, Mag, Drill carts, Fig 11 Tgt. (d) Bhar ki hukam par mag ko baren aur akin Karen ki sahi laga hai. Hukam mile ready to karwai is prakart se karen. Pistol ko case se bahar nikalen, pistol ko cock karen, ungali trigger guard mein , addesh mile make safe to pistol ko khali karen, bhara hua mag charyen, aur case mein band karen, jahan se hi hukam, mile khali kar to is addesh par karwai is prakar karen, pistrol se mag ko utharen, pistol ko do baar cock karen, khali mag charakar trigger ko press karen aur khali mag charyen aur pistol ko case mein band karen ABHYAS Class ko bharne aur khali karne per abhyas liya jai. BHAGFiring posn aur fire 9 III karna.;mm Pistol, (a) Battle Mag, crouch posn. Drill (b) Standing carts posn. (a) Battle crouch posn. Agar dushman 10 mtr se nazdik ho to am una bay an ke sat h diya jai. (e) (f) 05 27 07 34 (g) C lass ko tafs il se na mu na de. 255 yeh posn liya jata hai, baen paon ko tgt ki sidh mein aur badan ka khakha chhote se chhota banayen. (b) Standing posn Agar tgt 10 se 25 mtr ki duri par ho to standing posn se tgt ko barbad kiya jata hai, dono paon khule hue, dahine paon tgt ki sidh mein aur baen paon pichhe, baen hath belt , kamar ya pocket mein lagaya ho. Fire karna Munashib posn banayen aur trigger ko kalmiwali ungali ke beech dabaen pahla pull hasil karen, aur rifle ki tarah trigger ko dabyen. Agar fire ko rokna hai to stop ki karwai karen. Pistol ko niche layen aur go on par fire ko jari karen. ABHYAS Class ko firing posn 9 par abhyas karwaya mm jaye. Pistol, Mag, Drill carts (a ) . (b) SANKS HEP (c) Q1 – Pistol ke mag mein kitne rds aate hain? A – 13 Rds aate hain. Q2 – Make safe kab kiya jata hai ? A- Jab ek jagah se dusri jagah jana ho(Ops area mein) ya thori der ke liye fire rokana ho. (d) 04 38 (e) 02 (f) 40 ) (g H ar ek bha g se saw al poo chh en. Q 3 – Pistol ko ready kab – kab kiya jata 256 hain? A – (i) Fire karne ki jarurat pare. (ii) Tgt dikhai dena pare. (iii) Hukam milne par. -----------------------------*************************------------------------------------ PIS 7-11 9mm PISTOL KI CHAAL, PARNE WALI ROKEN AUR UNHEN DUR KARNE KA TARIQA SIKHANA TARTIB S/NO TEACHING POINTS 1. SHURU SHURU KA KAM (a) Class ki ginti groupon mein bant . (b) Hathiyar aur saman ka nirakshan. (c) Bandobast ki karwai. 2. DOHRAI Q1. 9mm Pistol kis sidhnath TRG TIM AIDS E A R 9mm 0 0 Pisto 1 1 l, Mag, drill carts , fig 11tgt , grou nd sheet . 0 0 REM ARK S Nirik shan class se kara jaye. Pichl 257 par kam karta hai? Ans :- Short recoil ke sidhant par. Q2. Yadi tgt 10 m se nazdik ho to kaun se posn lena chahiye ? Ans :-Battle crouch posn. 1 2 e saba q se dohr ai le jai. 3. PAHUNC 9 mm Pistol short recoil ki H sidhant par kam karne wal ahathiyar hai. Is hathiyar ka tech data, bharna, khali karna sikh lena hi ek firei ke liye kafi nahi hai, balki zaruri hai ki firer iski chal ke bare mein jankari rakhta ho taki firing ke dauran parne wali rokon ko asani se dur kar sake. 0 1 0 Choo 3 ta saaf aur saba q se samb andhi t ho. 4. UDDES H 9 mm Pistol ki Chaal, Parne wali Roken aur Unhe Dur Karne ka Tarika Sikhana Hai. 0 1 0 Udde 4 sh do bar batay a jae. 5. SAMAN 9 mm Pistol, Mag, Drill carts, Pistol case, line yard, Black board, long easel, chalk, duster, fig 11 tgt, ground sheet. 0 1 (a) 6. (b) BHAGO N MEIN BANT (c) Bhag -I 9mm Pistol ki Chaal. Bhag -II Parnewali Roken aur Unhe Dur Karne ka Tariqa. (d) 0 Sama 5 n ko point karke batay a jaye. (e ( (g) ) f ) Suvid 0 0 ha ke 1 6 liye bago n mein bant ki jaye. 258 BHAG-I NAMUN A 9mm Pistol ki Chaal. Chal mein kaam aane wale hisse purje – Mag, tripping lever head, tripping lever tail, sear connecting lever, sear arm, hammer, firing pin, barrel, locking thread, slide locking races, extractor, ejector, feed piece, positional lug. Chaal. Jab ek firer mag ko chadhata hai to mag agla kinara tripping lever head ke upar dabav dalta hai, jisse tripping lever tail sear connecting lever ki sidh mein aa jata hai. Jab trigger ko dabaya jata hai to tripping lever tail sear connecting lever ke agle hisse par dabav dalta hai, jisse sear connecting lever ka pichhle hissa sear arm ke upar dabav dalta hai aur hammer azad hokar firing pin retainer par chot marta hai, firing pin apne hole se nikalkar chamber wale rd ke primer par chot marta hai aur rd fire ho ja ta hai. Ise FIRE ki karwai kahte hain. Rd fire hone se ek dhakka lagta hai jise short recoil ke naam se jante hain. Is dhakke ki madad se brl aur slide piche ki harkat karte hain. Jab brl aur slide dono ek sath lock halat mein hi 5mm peeche ki harkat karta hai to unclained surface limitor se takra kar neeche ki taraf dab jata hai aur brl locking thread tatha slide locking races ka milap tut jata hai, karwai UNLOCK ki hoti hai. Yahan par brl ke peechhe ki harkat samapt ho jati hai lekin slide ke peechhe ki harkat jari rahti hai. Is peechhe ki harkat ke dauran Pisto l, mag, drill carts , grou nd sheet . 0 7 1 Nam 3 una baya n ke sath diya jaye. 259 (a) (b) BHAGII extractor fire case ko peechhe lata hai, karwai EXTRACT ki hoti hai. Fired case ejector se takrakar ejectioning slot ke raaste dahine aur neeche gir jata hai, karwai EJECT ki hoti hai. Slide hammer ke pura upar se gujar jata hai aur forward lug se takrane ke karan peechhe jane se ruk jata hai. Is dauran hammer vent ka milap sear ke sath ho jata hai, karwai COCK ki hoti hai. Main guide spring sikur jata hai. Jab spring apne tanav ko pura karta hai to slide ko aage dhakelta hai. Is aage ki harkat ke dauran feed piece mag ke upar wale rd ko chamber (c) mein dakhil karta hai, karwai FEED ki hoti hai. Extractor rd ke pende par sawar ho jata hai, karwai LOAD ki hoti hai. Positional lug, sited for positional lug ke upar dabav dalta hai jisse brl upar ki taraf uthta hai, is dauran brl locking thread aur slide locking races ka milap ho jata hai, karwai LOCK ki hoti hai. Lock hone ke baad bhi brl aur slide lock halat mein dono ek sath 5mm aage ki harkat karta hai. Is dauran sear connecting lever ka agla kinara tripping lever tail ki sidh mein aa jata hai aur pistol dubara fire karne ke liye taiyar ho jata hai. Parne wali Roken aur Unhe Dur Karne ka Tariqa. Yadi pistol shuru se hi fire na kare ya fire karte karte ruk (d) (e ) ( f ) (g) Nam una baya n ke 260 NAMUN A ABHYAS jaye to rok ko pehchen. Pistol ko bhar posn mein layen. Pistol ko baen turn karen aur ejectioning slot ke raaste dekhen. Dekhne se pata chala hammer pura aage slide pura aage to misfire ki rok samajhkar dur karen. Pistol ko dahine turn karte huye cock karen, slide ko aage jane den aur fire mein shamil karen. Agar dekhne mein aaye hammer pura peechhe slide aage se thora peechhe to unfit rd ki rok samajhkar dur karen. Baen hath ki hatheli se slide par thapki lagayen, unfit rd fit ho jayega, pistol ko fire mein shamil kare. Agar dekhne mein aaye hammer pura peechhe slide peechhe se thora aage to body mein atke huye rd ki rok samajhkar dur karen. Slide ko pakarte huye pistol ko cock karen, pistol ko dahine turn karte huye hilayen, body mein atka hua rd neeche gir jayega, pistol ko fire mein shamil karen. Agar dekhne mein aaye hammer pura peechhe slide pura peechhe to khali mag ki rok samajhkar dur karen. Mag catch ko dabate huye khali mag ko utaren, pouch se bhari hui mag ko len, mag ka mulahija karte huye mag way mein dakhil karen, yakin karen ki mag thik lag gaya hai, slide ko aage jane den aur pistol ko fire mein shamil karen. Abhas ke liye hukam is prakar se – Hammer pura aage slide pura age, hammer pura age slide age se thora peechhe, hammer pura 9 mm Pisto l, Mag, Drill carts 0 7 3 0 9 mm Pisto l, Mag, 0 8 3 8 sath diya jaye. 261 (b) (a) 7. peechhe slide peechhe se Drill thora age, hammer pura carts peechhe slide pura peechhe. (c) (d) SANKSH Q1. Pistol ki chal kitne EP action mein puri hoti hai ? Ans. 8 action mein. Q2. Pistol mein kitne prakar ki roken dur hoti hain ? Ans. 4 prakar ki. (e ) 0 2 ( f ) 4 0 (g) ************************************************************************************* ************************************************************************************* ********************************************************************************** 15) . TEAR SMOKE (CODE-TS) TS - 1 TEAR SMOKE GAS –ITIHAAS , KISMAIN , RANGE AUR PRAYOG Shirshak Vishay Shuru shuru ka kaam Dhayna karshan Prastha vana Yakin Karen ki sabka dhyan class ki taraf hai aur sab ke pass likhne ki samagri hai. Tatha class chalane hetu upkaran lage hai. Manavadhikar se aap kya samajte hain. Vartman samay main aantrik kanoon tatha suraksha vyavastha ko sucharu rup se chalane ke liye jin sadhano ko upyog main late hai usmain se tear smoke gas ek bahut hi accha avam mahatwapurna sadhan hai. Isliye yehn par awashak hai ki police force Prashiks han Upkaran Multymi diaProje cter etc. Tadaiv Tadaiv Sama y 1 Min 02-03 Min 04-05 Min 262 Uddesh Ansu gas ka itihas Ansu Gas ka bharat main itihas saddse iske bare main puri jankari rakhte ho tatha istemal ke bare main bhi jante ho mouka padne par vah iska thik prakar se istemal kar saken. Is path ki samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi tear smoke gas ki aam jankari, Gas ammunition ke prakar unke range aur upyog ke bare main janne main saksham honge. Vaise to is gas ka avaishkaar 1900 main ho chukka tha lekin iska sarvapratham istemal France ki police organization ne first world war (1914-1918) ke shuru hone se pahle hi kar liya jaisa ki Kol.Rex. appligate ne apni pustak ‘‘Riot control material and Techniques main likha hai. Iske bad America main bhi gas ka istemal Dakuon, choron tatha asamajik tatwon ke khilaf jo sena se ladhai samapt ho jane ke bad pension tatha graduity de kar nokari se hata diye gaye the unhone bad main sarkar ke khilaf aandolan chod diya aur lut-mar shuru kar di thi unke khilaf prayog ki gaya tha. Pahle is gas ko bank aur static instolation main rakha jata tha jisko bank clerk baithe-baithe hi istemal kar sakta tha. Baad main is gas ko ek jagha se dusri jagha le jane layak banaya gaya aur fir grenade tatha shellon main bhara kar isko portabale banaya gaya hai. Bharat main yeh gas kab layi gai iske bare main puri tour se jankari nahi hai lekin 1933 main is gas ko sabse pahle Punjab main khatarnak apradhi tatha daquit ko arrest karne ke liye authorised ki gai. Police training school PTS Pillaur ke principal Late. F.H.D Home jo us samay PT School ke principal the is gas ke bare main jankari prakat karne ke liye America bheje haye aur ve waha se iske bare main jankari hasil karke laye. Bad main unko hi Bharat Sarkar ka salahakar lagaya gaya jo tear smoke se sambandhit mamlon ke bare main Bharat sarkar ko avagat karate gaye.1935 main ek report secrectory for India ko bheji hai jisme is gas ko bhid ke upar istemal ke liye ijajat mangi gayi jo manjur kar di gayi. 1- Kya halat vastav main is layak hai ki gas istemal kiya jaye. 2- Kya manav aadhikaron par iska istemal Tadaiv 06- 07 Min Tadaiv 08-11 Min Tadaiv 12-16 Min 263 puri tarah se nirnayak hai. 3- Kya iske istemal ke liye iccha aur safal avsar the. 1937 main ek tear smoke scout banaya gaya jiska PTS ke principal ke adhin tear smoke ki treaning di gai tatha 1940 ke lagatar tear smoke ke bare main PTS Fillor dwara training di jane lagi. March 1980 se tear smoke ke bare main vishesh training CRPF ke Central Training College-II all India Police level par di ja rahi hai. Jisme sabhi state Police ke adhikari aate hai aur Tear Smoke ke bare main jankari hasil karte hai. Kaha jata hai ki gas majme ke lihaj se sabse pahle Freedom fighters ke khilaf Patna (Bihar) main istemal ki gayi thi. Tear Smoke Gas Ke Prabhav – 1-Ansu Gas ka dhuaa aakhon main lagne se aasu aane lagte hai. 2-Ansu gas se ek prakar ki gas nikalti hai jiski sugund aswasniye hoti hai. 3- Iske asar se aankh, gale, nak tatha pasina hone wali chamdi main jalan hoti hai. Gas Ammuni tion ke prakar unke range aur puyog. Tear Smoke gas ko iski banawat ke aadhar par 2 bhagon main banta gaya hai. 1.Thos Gas- Yeh Gas Federal Company dwara 1923 main banana shuru kiya gaya. 2. Maya Gas- Yeh Gas Likecriya lab dwara 1925 main banaya gaya. Type of Tear Smoke ammunitionThose Gas Ammunition ko duri ke lihaj se hum 3 bhagon main bant-te hain : a) Najdik Duri (Short range) b) Maddham Duri (Medium Range) c) Lambi Duri (Long range) Short Range Ammunition – Is main hum ek tear smoke ammunition ko shamil karte hai jinki range 0 se 10 gaj tak hoti hai. Isme tear smoke ammunition sammelit hota hai.Blast Cartridge* Metal- Alluminum * Lambai- 5’’ * Wajan – 60 grm. * Vyas – 0.8’’ * Range- 3 se 4 Gaj tak Tadaiv 17&3 6 Min 264 Istemal Blast ya Trenchen Gun cartridge ko majme ke virudh istemal nahi kiya jata hai. Iska istemal gad-bad karne walon aur gundon ke liye kiya jata hai. Gun Cartridge – * Lambai – 8’’ * Vyas -1.5’’ * Wajan-226.8 grm. * Range-10 Gaj * Rang-Alluminium Is cartridge ko fedral riot gas gun se fire karte hai. Iske bhi fire karne ka uddesh wahi hai jo blast cartridge ka hai. 4 gaj duri se kam kar isko fire nahi karna chahiye. Medium range- Isme hum thos gas ke un tear smoke ammunitions ko shamil karte hai jo hath se 10 gaj se lekar 50 gaj tak fenke jate hai. Pahle hum fedral company ke grenade hi lenge. 1- Single way grenade Rang- Lal Lambai Bhushan ke sath -6’’ Lambai Bina Bhushan ke- 5’’ Wajan-17 ounce Vayas -2.5’’ Gas emmishan holes- 14 (9 side main 4 upar aur 1 niche) Gas emmishan samay- 25 se 35 second tak Range -50 guj Yadi C.N. aur D.M Grenade honge to unka rang nila aur hara hoga, baki sari baaten wahi hai jo C.N ke single way grenade main batai gai hai. Istemal ka tarika1- Majme ke upar 2- Gas torch main dal kar 3- Three way grenadeYeh tifin ki shakal ka hota hai, iske 3 tukde dhamake ke sath alag-alag girte hai, three way grenade ke bare main jankariRang-Lal (yadi CN ka hai to ) Wajan-20 ounce Lambai bhushan ke sath-6’’ Lambai bina bhushan -5’’ Vayas- 2.5’’ Gas emmishan holes-22 Gas emmishan samay- 20 se 25 second. Range- 50 gaj 265 Failao- Iska ek tukda dusre tukde se takriban 15 se 25 guj dur jata hai. Istemal ka tarika1. Jab majma tukdiyon main alag-alag khada ho. 2. Jab auraton aur bacchon ka majma ho Note- Is grenade ko kabhi bhi gas torch main dalkar istemal nahi karna chahiye. 1- Indigenous GrenadeYeh hamare desh meion ordinance factory Chanda ka banaya huaa grenade hai. Yahan Grenade-CN gas ka hai. Is grenade ki vishesh jankari – Rang-Lal Lambai- 4.8’’ Wajan-540 grm Gas emmishan holes- 15 Gas emmishan samay- 15 second Vayas – 2.2.” Range – 35 se 50 gaj Istmal ka tarika :Is grenade ka istmal majme par karte hai. Agar is grenade ko GF rifle per discharge cap chadha kar isme gas cap ke sath grenade ko dalkar ballistite cartridge se 45 degree angle se fire karen to usme se jo gas niklegi vah gas cap (jo ki Swadeshi grenade ke niche main lagaya hai) par dhakka degi jisse grenade ka range 200 gaj tak ho jata hai. *Blast Dispersion Grenade (CN & CS) Is grenade ki body aluminum ki bani hoti hai iska aakar thik speed hit grenade ki tarah hota hai. CN ka blast dispersion grenade ke andar CN ka mixer tatha CS ke blast dispersion grenade ke andar CS mixer aur powder bhara hota hai. Yeh kharbuje ki tarah fat-ta hai .Bhushan ki chal pura hone par aag ka shole grenade ke andar bhare hue blasting charge ko aag laga deta hai. Jisse yeh grenade kafi unchi aawaj se fat jata hai. Is main se gas dhul ki shakal main bahar nikal jati hai. Long Range- isme un shellon tatha grenade ko shamil karte hai jiska range 100 se 200 gaj tak hota hai. Short Range ShellRang- Lal (Yadi CN ka hai to) Lambai- 8.5’’ Vyas -1.5’’ 266 Gas emmission hole-10 Gas emmission type-25 se 35 second. Wajan- 10 ounce Range-100 gaj Long Range Shell- Iske bare main puri jankari thik wahi hai jo short range ki hai. Lekin isme proplete charge ki matra jaida hone ke karan is shell ka range 200 gaj hai. Rang- Lal (Yadi CN ka hai to) Lambai- 10.9’’ Vyas -1.5’’ Gas emmishan hole-10 Gas emmishan type-25 se 35 second. Wajan- 17 ounce Range direct -75 se 100 gaj Range angle ke sath- 325 Shak ya Path ke madham se. sawal Sankshe Pure path ko sankshep p samapan Karen. Tadaiv main batakar Tadaiv 3738Min 39-40 Min ******************************************************* TS - 2 TEARSMOKE UNIT TEKANPUR(GWALIOR) MAIN BANAYE JANE WALE TEAR SMOKE GAS AMMUNITIONS KE BARE MAIN JANKARI SHIRSH AK DHANA KARSHA N UDDES H PRICHA Y SUBJECT TIME 02 Min Is path ki samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi TS Unit Tekenpur main banaye jane wale Tear smoke gas ammunitions ke bare main saksham honge . Pahle ham tayar smoke amammunitions ke liye puran rup se America (USA) ke fedral company tatha lek-eari company par nirbhar the. Ham inhi companion se tear smoke ammunitions mangaate the or inpar hi nirbhar rahte the. Yeh ammunition bahar se mangne par hamko bahut mahnga padta tha. Dhire-dhire bharat sarkar ne ispar vichar kiya our yeh nirnay liya ki kyun na ham apne desh main tear smoke ammunition 03&05 Min 06-08 Min 267 banana shuru kar den. Ataha 1967 main Chanda Ordinance Factory, jo Maharashtra main hai, jisne C.N ka ek chota grenade banana shuru kar diya. Isko swadeshi garned indiginous grenade bhi kahte hai.Aaj kal bharat main ek our firm tear smoke ammunition taiyar kar rahi hai. Isko tear smoke unit kahte hai. Yah factory B.S.F.ke andar Tekanpur Gwaliyar (M.P.) main hai. Iske taiyar smoke ammunition ka nap tool fedral/lek eari company ke ammunition main thoda bhin hai. 09-35 T. M. U. ke Tekanpur main banaye jane wale ansu gas shell Min 1. Durgami shell 2. Nikatgami Shell 3 Stan Shell 4. Two in One shell 5. Dual shell 6. Wood paising shell 7.Multi plate shell Multi shell launcher hetu. Durgami aur Nikatgami shell aam taur par kanun vyvastha banaye rakhne ke liye suraksha balon dwara kiye jate hai. Baki shellon ko khas maukon par istemal karne ke liye viksat kiya gaya hai. Durgami aur Nikat Gami shell ki banawat - 1) Shell body (aluminium ya plastic) 2) igniator assembly – nirdharit deri paida karne ke liye. 3)Cartridge case– aluminium ya plastic ke 0.22 kyap our propelyend charge ke sath. 4)durgami / nikatgami shellon main lekimetri kampgition bhara hota hai durgami shell ka dile samay our propellent charge nikat gami shell se adhik hai taki vah nikatgami shell jaida dur tak ja sake. Savdhaniya – 1. Istemal karne se pahle yakin karen ki shell ki self life khatam to nahi hua hai. 2. Load karne se pahle dekh le ki shell leak ya chatigrast to nahi hai. 3. Shell ko gun main load karte samay jabardasti na kare. 4.Bhid par sidha fire na karen . Aisa karne se gambhir chote aa sakti hai aur mout bhi ho sakti hai Faide 1. Sabhi tarah ke mousam main kargar astra. 2. Dhuaa nikalne ki raftar jaida hai. 3. Aage wala hissa chapta hone se chot lagne ke avsar kam ho jate hain. 4. Shell ke istamal se bhid aur police ke bich surakshit fasla rakha ja sakta hai aur bhid ko dur se hi titar bitar kiya ja sakta hai 5. Pratek se 10 meter X 10 meter ka ilaka prabhavit karta hai. 6. Fire kai shell ek sath le ja sakti hai. PRAYOG – 1. Dur va nikatgami shell uttejit bhid ko dur se titar-bitar karne ke liye upyukt astra hai. 2. Band kamra ya aadd liye hue ugravadiyon ko bahar nikalne ki karwahi main kafi labhdayak hai. 268 3. Durgami /Nikatgami electrical shellon ko multi barrel launcher (agni varsha) se istamal kiya ja sakta hai. STAN SHELL – “SEEMA KIRTI” – Aam Jankari – Is shell ko fire karne par yeh do se char second ke bad jordar dhamaka karta hai aur chounka dene wali roshni ke sath fat-ta hai. Yeh dhamaka 303 rifle fire hone par utapann awaz ke barabar hai. Shell ke dhamake se bhid main sansani doud jati hai aur use titar-bitar karne main aasani hoti hai. Yeh ek aisa astra hai jiska istemal ek ‘’surprises astra ke rup main kiya jana chahiye. Stan shell ke istemal se najdik se najdik khada vyakti ko chot lag sakti hai ya vah aag se julas sakta hai, fir bhi yeh chote goli dwara kiye gaye nuksan se bahut kam hai. Sankshe p Banawat1-Plastic ki shell body 2-Plastic ka cartridge case 3- .22 cap 4- Igniator assembly 5- Shell main stan composition Sawal jawab se. 36&40 Min **************************************************************** TS 3-4 TEAR SMOKE AMMUNITIONS –BADAL AUR HAWA KA ASAR SHIRSHAK DHAYANAK ARSHAN UDDESH PARICHAY TARTIB SUBJECT TIME 02 min Mousam ka asar . Is path ki samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi Tear smoke ammunitions /Badlao aur hawa ke asar ke bare main saksham honge . Gas se jaida faida uthane ke liye isko is tarike se istemal kiya jaye ki accha asar ho aur majma jaldi se jaldi titar-bitar ho jaye. Iske liye chand ek siddhant, jo ki gas istemal karte samay dhyan main rakhne chahiye. Hawa ka rukh va raftar malum karna : –Ansu gas ka istemal karte samay aur khas kar jab shell fire karte hain to hawa ka rukh rakhna padta hai, 03-05 min 06-10 min 11-20 min 269 Badalon ka siddhant Hawa ki raftar Sankshep kyunki ek to shell wajan main halka hota hai, dusra raftar kam hone ki wajah se uddan ke aakhir samay main apne raste kafi dur hat kar ja sakta hai. Isliye gas ki karwahi ko kamyab banaye rakhne ke liye jaruri hai ki lagatar karwahi ki jaye. 1. Malmal ke kapde ko, bans ke tukde par bandhkar hawa ki disha ka pata lagaya ja sakta hai. 2. Ek tin ke dibba main sulagta hua kapda ya gobar dalkar is ko ek patle bass main lagakar upar uthaya jaye, is dhue se hawa ki disha ka pata lag jayega. 3. Smoke candle jalakar bhi hawa ki disha ko malum kiya ja sakta hai. 4. Smoke shell ko gun se fire karke hawa k disha ko malum kiya ja sakta hai. Upar ki baaton ke alawa aur bhi kai tarike se hawa ke rukh ka pata laga sakte hai, hawa ki raftar ka pata lagane ke liye anemometer ki madad li ja sakti hai. Anemometer- Yeh hawa ke raftar ka pata lagane ka ek yantra hai, isse hawa ki raftar ka pata prati minute / Feet main lag jata hai aur jaruri ho to hawa ki raftar prati ghanta /kilo meters main bhi nikali ja sakti hai. Gas ke dhue par nimnalikhit baaten asar dalti hai. 1- Garmi :- Garmi pakar hawa halki ho jati hai aur upar uthati hai, iske sath hi sath vatavaran main chodi hui ansu gas ka dhuwa bhi upar uth-ta hai aur is prakar se upar uthane wala dhuwa iske liye upyukat nahi hota hai. Yadi garmi ho to dhuwan kewal upar ko hi uthega, yadyapi itna jaruri hai ki grenade ke khud ke pressure se ansu gas kuch dur tak age ko jaye, lekin uske bad fir dhuan ko dhakel kar aage ko le jaye jisse iska pura asar majme par ho sake uske liye ek ghante main 6 k.m. chalne wali hawa bahut upyukat hai. Ek ghante main 12 k.m. chalne wali hawa bhi iske liye upyukat hai. Isliye jaruri hai ki gas ke dhue ko aage dhakalne ke liye hawa main raftar bhi ho jo gas ko majme tak pahuncha sake. Sawal Jawab se. 21-22 min 23-37 min 38-40 min **************************************************************** TS 5-6 CHAMBER TEST KE BAREMAIN JANKARI 270 SHIRSHA K DHAYANA KARSHAN UDDESH PARICHAY Chamber test ke liye saman SUBJECT TIME 02 min Line of screen (Conversation line) Is path ki samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi chamber test tatha swans yantra ki fitting ko check karne ke bare main saksham honge. Chamber test ka uddesh swas yantra ki durusti ko check karna aur gas ka asar mahsus karna hai. Iske liye koi bhi kamra ya tent jo air tight, ho gas chamber ke liye prayog kiya ja sakta hai. Kamra aisa hona chahiye ki darwaja khulne par dhire-dhire gas nikal sake. Iske alawa kamre main 2 darwaje, shishe ki khidki , roshan dan aur pankha hona chahiye. Jab kabhi bhi gas chamber ki jagah ka chunao kiya ja raha ho to aam raste se 100 gaj dur hona chahiye. 1. Gas chamber 2. C.N. Lekri-metyari capsule 3.Tin ka tawa 4. lamp ya candle 5. pankha 6. swans yantra 7. Tip todne wala saman 8. Matches Chamber prashikshan se pahle ki karwahi 1- Chamber test ke liye C.N. ki mili hui mark-II va III shishe ki lekri-metyari capsule ka istemal karna chahiye 2- 1000 ghan feet kamre ki liye 2 capsule kafi hai. 3- kisi halki tip todne wali chij se tip ko todo, capsule ko ek tin ke tawe par rakhen .Niche se lamp ya candle se garam karo, dhyan rahe tawa jaida garam nahi hona chahiye, nahi to aag lagne ka dar rahta hai, aur C.N. rasayan gas na paida karke jal jata hai. 4- Gas ko pure kamre main failne ke liye pankhe ki madad lo. 5- Capsule ko istemal karte samay C.N. mishran badan par nahi lagana chahiye nahi to sakt jalan paida hogi sath hi chamber parshikshan se pahle is baat ki tassali karo-a) Heater, Pankha, Capsule istemal ke liye taiyar hai. b) Tamam jawano ko chamber prashikshan ko uddesh va drill battayen.c) Har jawan ke pass apna swans yantra hona chahiye. d) tamam nikali gas taiyar sthiti main ho. e) Sabko face piece pahnaya jayega. f) face piece fit ho jane ke bad jawanon se drill karai jaye.g)Drill ke dauran check karon ki kisi aadmi ko gas se taklif to nahi ho rahi hai. h) Parsikshan ke liye puri taiyari ho jane ke 03-06 min 07-12 min 13-30 min 271 bad darwaje par sentry niyukt karen. i) Shikshak, sentry se thodsa sa darwaja kholne ke liye kahen aur isi dauran sab jawanon ko kamre main dakhil hone ko kahen jo ki sabhi jawan kamre main aa jate hai to vah sentry se darwaja band karwaden. 6- Chamber test ke dauran ki karwahi a) chamber main aa jane ke bad sabhi jawano ko gol dayare main khada karen. b) agar gas ke asar se koi aadmi ghabrane lage to use kamre se bahar nikalo aur dubara chamber parshikshan main dalo.c) Jawano ki face piece ki fitting ko check karo. d) jawano se thoda sa vyam karao taki ye swans yantra ki kabliyat ko mahsus kar sake.e) jawano ko kam se kam 5 minute tak rahane do.f) shiksharthion se aakhir main ek minute ke liye face piece utarwa do aur gas mahsus karwao. g) jawano ko face piece pahna kar test for gas karao aur dusre darwaje se bahar nikalo. Tippani Sankshep I. Agar jaida jawano se chamber test karaya ja raha 30-38 ho to yakin karte raho ki gas ka asar chamber main min rahe aur jarurat padne par aur capsule istemal kiya jayen. II. Chamber test kisi padadhikari ya prashikshit adhikari ya shikshak ki nigrani main karaya jaye aur yeh prasikshan ke dauran mojud rahe. 7. Chamber prasikshan ke bad ki karwahi a) Sabhi jawano ko kamre se bahar nikalne ke bad hi unke face piece utar de. B) Yakin karo ki kise jawan ko gas ka jaida asar to nahi ho gaya hai, agar jaida asar ho gaya ho to prathamik upchar karo. c) Check karo ki kisi jawan ke chehre par face piece ka nishan to nahi ho gaya. Nishan ban-ne ke nimnalikhit karan hai. i) face piece ka chota hona ii) face piece ke phite ka jaida kasa hona d) Agar jawano ko swans yantra thik fit mila ho to unke upar nishan lagakar unki size note kar li jaye e) Uske bad face piece ko acchi tarah saaf karo, khushak karo taki uspar gas ka asar na rah jaye. f) Eye piece par anti daiming compound lagakar saaf karen. g) Upasthit adhikari tamam chijon ki report den. Sawal jawab se. 39-40 min **************************************************************** 272 TS 7-8 TEAR SMOKE GRENADES KI CHAL SHIRSHAK DHAYANAK ARSHAN UDDESH Tartib SUBJECT TIME 02 Min Is path ki samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi Tear smoke grenades ki chal tatha sabhi prakar ke grenades va shells ke bare main saksham honge . Single way grenade- kisi bhi grenade ke do hisse hote hai. 1- Bhushan 2 –Body 1.Bhushan- Bhushan bhi 2 kisam ke hote hai. a) Ek second ka bhushan- Jaldi jalne wala. b) Do second bhushan – delay type Jaldi jalne wala bhushan ko single way grenade main tatha delay type bhushan ko three way grenade main istemal kiya jata hai. Jo jaldi jalne wala bhushan lever par ek second tatha delay type bhushan lever par do second likha hota hai. Lekin aaj kal jaldi jalne wala bhushan istemal kiya jata hai jiske lever par kuch nahi likha hota hai. Bhushan ke hisse purjon ke naam1. lever 2. Split pin 3. Ring 4. Hammer (Sticker) 5. Precaution Cap 6. .32 Black cartridge 7. Special spring Chahe ek second wala bhushan ho ya do second ka iski chal single way grenade tatha three way grenade main ek jaisa hi hai. Jab yeh action main nahi hota hai to iske hisse purje ki position is 03-05 Min 06-36 Min 273 prakar hoti hai- Hammer lever ke niche surakshit daba hota hai tatha lever ko apni jagah par thik rakhne ke liye bhushan ke sholder ke surakh main split pin ko dala hota hai taki lever apni jagha banaye rahe aur lever ke niche hammer surkshit rahata hai. split pin ke dono kinare bahar ko khule rahate hai taki pin apni jagha se hil na paye aur hadsonse bacha ja sake. Jab bhushan ko action main laya jata hai.- jab Spilt pin ko nikal kar grenade ko hawa main faink te hai to lever azad hota hai jiski wajaha se lever ke niche daba huaa hammer apne spiral spring ki takad se apne pivat par upar ko harkat karte hai aur waha lever ko apne raste se hata deta hai, aur jor se percussion cap par thokar marta hai, jis se aag ka shoal paida hota hai. Yeh shola .32 black cartridge ko aag laga deta hai, .32 black cartridge main aag lagne se iski aag teji se grenade main bhare ignishiyan past ko aag laga deta hai. 2.Body Grenade ki body main nimn hisse purje hote hai. – 1. pressure chamber 2. Body 3. Gas emission holes 4. Ignition post 5. Mixer of gas Chhal – Jab bhushan .32 cartridge se aag ka shola nikalta hai to vah grenade ke pressure chamber se hote hue ignition post ko aag laga deta hai. Ispar aag lagne se grenade main bhare gas mishran ko bhi aag lag jati hai, is prakar grenade ke andar aag lagne se gas itne dabav ke sath bahar aa jati hai ki vah chipkane wale phite ko fad kar gas, gas emmission hole se bade dawav ke sath bahar aa jati hai aise halat main yadi iske upar pani bhi dala jaye to iski gas par pani ka koi bhi asar nahi hota hai. Grenade itna garam ho jata hai ki usko uthakar police par fenkna namunkin hota hai. Gas grenade se 25 se 35 second tak nikalti hai. Three way grenade – Hisse purje ke naam thik wahi hai jo speed grenade ke hain. Lekin farak itna hai ki three way grenade tiffin ke jaisa hai aur dhamake ke sath 3 tukadon main alagalag hota hai. Three way grenade ke padartha) Fuze b) Breasting Charge c) Ignition post d) C.N ka mishran 274 Sankshep e) Cups (Katori) Chhal- Bhushan ka shola Grenade ke pressure chamber se hota huaa fuze aur pahli katori main bhare ignition post ko aag laga deta hai, fuze jalta hua pahli katori ke niche rakhe breasting charge main aag laga deta hai, jis se dhamake ke sath pahli katori aur do jude hue grenade ke hisse alag ho jate hain. Fuze apna kam yahi par samapt nahi karta balki yeh failta hua dusri katori ke ignition post aur C.N. gas mishran main aag laga deta hai. Aag lagne ke sath tisari katori alag ho jati hai aur fat-ta hain. Sawal Jawab Se 37-40 min TS -9 TEAR SMOKE GAS KA SIDDHANT AUR ISTEMAL MAIN DEKHNE WALI BATEN SHIRSHAK DHAYANAK ARSHAN UDDESH Tartib SUBJECT TIME 02 Min Line of release Is path kI samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi Tactical Principle of tear smoke gas ke bare main saksham honge . Hawa ka rukh aur raftar- Yeh pahle hi bataya ja chuka hai ki hawa kis prakar Tear Smoke gas ke dhune par asar dalti hai. Isliye adhikari ko chahiye ki gas ko usi jagha istemal karwayen jahan se uska pura-pura asar majme par ho saken. Isi prakar hawa ki raftar ka bhi dhyan rakhna hoga. Yadi hawa tej chal rahi hogi to jaida matra main gas ko istemal karna padaga kyunki hawa ki raftar se dhua jaldi hi upar uth jayega aur uska majme par koi asar nahi hoga. Balki jaida tej hawa main ammunitions ko barbad karna hai. Area occupied by the mob – Majme ke dwara ghere hue ilake ko dekh kar line of relies ki lambai ka fasala kiya jana chahiye line of release banate samay majme ke dono kinaron par kuch jagha chhut sakti hai jiska adhikari ko dhyan rakhna chahiye isiliye line of release ko itna lamba banaya jaye ki majme ka koi bhi hissa aisa na bache jispar gas ka asar na ho. 03-05 min 06-30 min 275 Sankshep Temper of the mob- Majme ka temper dekhkar hi gas ka istemal karna chahiye. Majme ka jo hissa jaida bhadkilla ho to udhar pahle gas ka istemal Karen, sath hi aurat aur bacchaon ka majma ho to unke upar C.N gas ke three way grenade istemal karna chahiye. Uttejit bhid ki taraf C.S tatha D.M. gas ka istemal uttam sabit ho sakta hai. Bachne ke rasten- Majme ke nikal bhagne wale rastaon ko T.S gas se kabhi bhi cover nahi karna chahiye kiyunki hamara uddesh majme ko titarbitar karna hai na ki majme ko gherna. T.S Gas ki uplabdhta- Majme ko turant titarbitar karne ke liye jaruri hai ki kafi tadad main gas ka istemal kiya jaye, gas kam ho to gas ko bhid ke khatarnak hisse par hi istemal karna chahiye. Security of gas Squad-Gas squad ki suraksha ke liye asla party jarur sath honi chahiye. Hospital- Jis sthan par gas ka istemal ho raha ho wahan ke niwasion ko pahle suchit kar dena chahiye ki waha gas istemal hone wali hai taki vah apna pahle se hi bachav ka bandobast karke rakhe sath hi yadi us jagha par koi hospital bhi pad ta ho to hospital ke adhikariyon ko pahle se suchit kar diya jaye ki waha par gas ka istemal ho sakta hai, taki vah log apne hospital ke khidki darwaje band kar le ya koi precaution le sake taki rogiyon ko koi pareshani na ho. Range –Gas squad ke adhikarion ko yeh malum hona chahiye ki majma kitni duri par hai taki usi hisab se TS ke ammunitions ko istemal kar saken. Respirator – Gas istemal se pahle gas squad ko respirator pahna dena chahiye iske 3 faide hain : 1- Gas squad khud gas se bach sakta hai. 2- Jawano ko yadi gas ke bich main jakar koi karwahi karni ho to aasani se kar sakte hai. 3- Respirator pahan-ne ke bad aadmi ka chehra aisa ban jata hai ki aam aadmi use dekha kar darne lagta hai. Yeh ek kisam ka psychology prabhav hai. Fire fighting – Yadi kabhi gas se majme ko titarbitar karna ho ya kisi makan ke andar kisi criminal ko pakadna ho to gas ke istemal se pahle fire fighting ka bhi pura bandobast hona chahiye taki aag lag jaye to usko turant bujhaya ja saken. Sawal jawab se. 31-40 276 min *************************************************************** TS 10 TEAR SMOKE AMMUNITIONS KI STORAGE SHIRSHAK SUBJECT TIME DHAYANAK ARSHAN UDDESH Ansu gas par mousam ka asar. 02 Min Is path ke samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi Storage of Tear Smoke Gas ke bare main saksham honge . Tear Smoke Gas ammunition me ansu gas paida karne wala mishran bhara jata hai. Inme kai atyadhik sakria rasayan jaise propellant, .22 cap aadi bhi hote hain. Ansu gas ammunition ke sahi va prabhav kari upyog ke liye jaruri hai ki uska bhandar sahi tarah se ho. Adhik taapman ke utaar-chadhav, adhik adrata ka ammunition par bura asar padta hai jis se ammunition miss fire ya blast ho sakta hai. Ansu gas ka bhandar karte samay nimnalikhit baton ko dhyan main rakhna chahiye. 1.Ansu gas ammunition ka store karna wali barrack se dur aur alag hona chahiye. 2. Jis building main ansu gas ammunition rakha jaye us par bijali girne se bachne ke liye lighting conductor hona chahiye. 3. Sabhi prakar ke bijali connection ammunition se kam se kam 6 fit ki duri par hone chahiye. 4. Store main vayu sanchar ka samuchit prabhand hona chahiye. 5. Store main vayu sanchar niyamit rup se hona chahiye. 6. Hathiyar, Gas gun, respirator ittayadi ammunition store se alag rakhna chahiye. 7. Gas ammunition ke sath aur kisi prakar ka ammunition nahi rakhna chahiye. 8. Aag bujhane ki samuchit vyavastha honi chahiye. 9.(No Smoking) Dhumrapan varjit ka board Store main praukh sthan par laga ho. 10. Ammunition ko jamin par ya diwar se laga kar nahi rakhna chahiye. Isko jamin se kam se kam 12’’ unchai par tatha uchit sthan par 03-05 Min PARICHAY Tartib 06-08 Min 09-30 Min 277 rakhna chahiye tatha check karke rahna chahiye ki farsh ke jariye nami ammunition tak toh nahi pahunch rahi hai. 11. Ammunition diwar se kam se kam 4 ya 5’ dur rehna chahiye. 12 Ammunition ki self life 3 sal hai isse adhik samay se rakhe ammunition ko alag kar dena chahiye. 13. Ammunition ka bhandar banane ke tarike ke anusar karna chahiye vah alag-alag prakar ke ammunition ko alag-alag rakhna chahiye. 14. Ammunition ko is prakar vitarit karna chahiye ki jo ammunition pahle bana hai vah pahle istemal ho tatha jo bad ka bana hai vah bad main istemal ho (First in first out). 15. Jis ammunition ki life 4 se 7 varsh ke bich ho use alag kar dena chahiye vah alag rakhna chahiye. Aise ammunition ko alag store main rakhne ka prayatna karna chahiye. Isse kewal prashikshan ke liye hi istemal karna chahiye. 16. Jis ammunition ki life 7 sal se adhik ho gai ho use alag kar ke jala dena chahiye. Isko kabhi bhid niyantran ya annya kanoon vyavastha banaye rakhne ke kaam main nahi lana chahiye. 17. Har kism ka ammunition jaise shell, grenade tatha special ammunition ko alag-alag rakhna chahiye tatha ban-ne ki tarik aur life khatam hone ki tarik saf-saf likhi honi chahiye. 18.Ansu gas ammunition ko thik tarike se pack karke rakhna chahiye is se ansu gas ekai main savadhani se pack kiya jata hai. Ammunition ko packed halat main hi rakhna chahiye vah tabhi kholna chahiye jab istemal karna ho. 19. Yadi kisi karanvash ammunition khol diya jata hai aur vah bagair istemal kiye wapas aa jata hai to, uss ammunition ko alag rakhna chahiye aur sabse pahle jarurat padne par istemal karna chahiye. 20.Ammunition ko har 3 maha bad leak aur jung aadi ke liye check karna chahiye. Yadi aisa hai to aise ammunition ko jaldi se jaldi alag kar dena chahiye aur turant ansu gas ekai ko suchit karna chahiye jisme lot number banane ki tarik aadi ka pura vivaran likha jana chahiye. 21. Store ko har saptah main kholna chahiye jisse wahan ki hawa badli ho saken. 22. Marammat kiye gaye ya sudhare gaye ammunition ko alag rakhna chahiye. Aise 278 Sankshep ammunition ko kabhi bhi kanoon- Vyavastha karwahi main istemal main na kiya jaye. 23. Ammunition dene ka va sangrah karne ka pura record rakhna chahiye taki kewal wahi ammunition bhid niyantran main istemal ho jo 3 saal se purana na ho. Ansu Gas ammunition Protechnic mishran se 31-40 banaya jata hai. Iska sakriye halation main sahi Min upyog karne ke liye jaruri hai ki iska rakhrakhav sahi tarike se kiya jaye. Adhik matra main Time bond ammunition store main rakhne se ammunition ke bhandar, jarurat kharid vah istemal main kafi pareshani ho sakti hai. Dekha gaya hai ki kai state main ammunition marammat karke dubara prayog karte hai aise ammunition ko sakriye halaton main istemal nahi karna chahiye. Kyunki iske prabhav par bharosa nahi kiya ja sakta . Uchit bhandar aur samay-samay par badli hone par ammunition ki sahi kharid ho sakti hai. Sahi kism ke ammunition ka prabhavi upyog ho sakta hai va purane, an upyogi ammunition ko barbad kiya ja sakta hai. **************************************************************** TS 11 TEAR SMOKE GAS –KARO , NA KARO SHIRSHA K DHAYANA KARSHAN UDDESH Tartiib SUBJECT TIME Ansu Gas main karo / Mat karo 02 Min Is path ki samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi Do’s & Don’s of Tear Smoke Gas ke bare main saksham honge . Karo1. Majme ke ravaiya halat aur jagah ko dekhte hue ansu gas ko istemal karen. 2. Jarurat ke mutabik hi gas istemal karen. 3. Gas istemal karte samay gas squad ki suraksha ka pura dhayan rakhen. 03-05 Min 06-30 Min 279 Sankshep 4. Jin jagah par thos gas ke grenade/shellon se aag lagne ka andesha ho wahan maya gas ka istemal karen, ya fir gas torch ka prayog karen. 5. Sarvajaink sthan par gas ke istemal se pahle waha ke niwasiyon ko suchit karen. 6. Mousam hawa ka dhyan rakhte hue gas ka istemal karen. 7. Line of release aise jagah banaye, jaha se majme par uska pura asar ho. 8. Jahan grenade/ shellon ka istemal karna sambhav ho wahan gas torch ka istemal karen. 9. Yahan tak ho sake auraton aur bacchon ke majme par gas torch ka istemal karen. 10. Grenade tatha shellon ke istemal se purva is baat ka yakin karo ki kahin inki body tuti hui to nahi hai. 11. Shellon ko angle se hi fire karna chahiye. Mat karo-. 1. Gas istemal karte samay dhilli karwahi mat karo. 2. Blast cartridge ko kisi ke chehare par fire mat karo. 3. Shellon ko kisi aadmi par shisth lekar fire nahi karna chahiye 4. Flight riot shell ko khule majme par istemal mat karo. 5. Shellon par kisi sakt diwar par direct fire nahi karna chahiye. 6. Riot drill party ke commander ke aadesh ke bina C.S. tatha D.N. gas ka istemal mat karo. 7. Bahut tej hawa main ansu gas ko istemal mat karo. 8. Bina jarurat ke gas squad ko respirator na pahnayen. 9. Dhalwan jamin tatha chaton par grenade tatha shellon ko istemal na karen. 10. Gas party ko majma titar-bitar hone ke turant baad apne sthan se mat hatao. Savadhaniya31-40 1- Fire kiye hue practice shell ke khoke ko cap lagane Min ke pahle gas gun main dalkar inhe dekh lena chahiye ki yeh barrel se thik prakar se gujarta hai ya nahi. 2- Kai bar shell ke fire karne par shell ke projectile ki shakal tedhi- medhi ho jati hai to vah barrel main nahi aata. Atha cap ko chadhane se pahle yeh bhi dekh lena chahiye ki kya iska projectile barrel main thik aa raha hai. Jo projectile tedha ho gaya hai usko khokhale block main laga ke lakdi ke hatoden se peet kar sidha kar lena chahiye. 3- Precaution lagate samay kabhi bhi precaution ke upar jor se thokar nahi marna chahiye nahi to koi hadsa bhi ho sakta hai. Precaution cap ke sadon par chot marna chahiye na ki bich main. 280 4- Precaution cap ko lagate samay chashme ka istemal karna chahiye taki hadson se bacha ja sake. **************************************************************** TS 12-13 TEAR SMOKE RESPIRATORS KI KISMAIN SHIRSHA K DHAYANA KARSHAN UDDESH PARICHAY A Uddesh Tartib SUBJECT TIME Tear Smoke ke Grenade ko Blind hone ke karan. 02 Min Is path ke samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi General Instruction and type of resiprators and their carrying ke bare main saksham honge . Desh ke andar kanoon vyavasta ki bigadi hui halat ko sudharne ke liye police bal ka prayog kiya jata hai aur aise sthiti main yeh jaruri hai ki kam se kam takad ka prayog kiya jaye, taki janta aur Police ke acche samband bane rahen. Is uddesh ko dhayan main rakhte hue gas ke ilake main jana jaruri hai. Isliye hamare pass aise sadhan hone chahiye jisse hum gas se prabhavit ilake main aasani se apni karwahi kar saken iske liye swans yantra hi ek matra sadhan hai, jisase tamam ansu gas se bachav hota hai. Jaise karkhano (factroy) ki gas aadi. Swans yantra ke prakar, hidayaten tatha le jane ke tarike. Swans yantra ke prakarSwans yantra aam tour par char (4) prakar ke hote hain. 1. Service Swans yantra (Service respirators) 2. Civil duty Swans yantra ( civil duty respirators) 3. Civil Swans yantra ( civil espirators) 4. Swadeshi swans yantra ya Indigenious respirator. * Service Swans yantra : Yeh tamam gas tatha noj gason se bachav deta hai. Iske hisse purje adhik matra main hone ke karan iski ek khas drill banai gai hai jise prashikshan ke taur par aasani se sikhali ja sakti hai. Taki iska prayog sucharu rup se ho sake. Vaise is swans yantra ka prayog 03-05 Min 06-08 min 09-40 min. 281 pratham mahauddha main England ke raksha seva main lage hue log karte the. Isliye iska nam service swans yantra rakha gaya. * Civil duty Swans yantra Yeh swans yantra vastav main pratham vishva mahauddha ke dauran england main hawai hamle bachav vibhag ke liye banaya gaya tha. Isme connect tube nahi hoti, iski drill bahut hi aasan hai, kyunki isko jhole se nikalne ke bad sirf pahan-na hi hota hai. Yeh hawai hamale ke samay istemal hota tha. Isko khas kar un civiliyan ko diya jata tha jo ki civil hote hue duty par tainat the. *Civil Swans yantra Is Swans yantra ko England main civil logon ko hawai hamale ke bachav karne hetu diya gaya tha. Isme outlet valve nahi hote hai isliye swans chodte samay chehre par lage hue rubber ko hatana padta hai. *. Swadeshi swans yantra ya Indigenious respirator. Yeh swans yantra bharat main banaya gaya hai. Yeh Vesta company dwara banaya gaya hai iska container lamba tatha bada hota hai. Isme swans hole niche ki taraf hota hai. Garde se bachav ke liye ispar dhakan laga hota hai. Isme rubber ki tube hoti hai iska face piece bhi hota hai. *************************************************************************** TS 14-15 RESPIRATOR DRILL-GAS POSITION AUR SAHI FITTING SHIRSHA K DHAYANA KARSHAN SUBJECT UDDESH Is path ke samapti ke paschat sabhi prashiksharthi gas position and correct fitting of respirator aur TS Gas ke bare main saksham honge. Gas Position – Yeh gas position us samay akhtiyar ki jati hai jab hame yeh aadesh ho ki hamara vasta majme se hone wala hai. * Jaise hi hukum milta hai gas tayari position to is hukum par savadhan hona hai aur dono Tartib TIME Swadeshi swans yantra ya Indigenous respirator. 02 Min Bharat main banaya gaya. 03-06 Min 07-35 Min 282 hathon ko respirator par maro, dahine hath se container ki taraf se aisa pakdo ki charo ungliya bahar ki taraf aur aungatha andar ki taraf ho. Ab dahine hath ki mamad se respirator ko aage lao aur respirator ko sidha khada karo, bayen hath ko siling aur respirator ki bich sidha rakho ‘Up’ par issi halat main bayen hath ko chatki se bahar nikalo aur whip card hole se whip card ko ek hi zatke se pura bahar niklo. Ab bayen hath se respirator ko aur niche se pakdo aur dahine hath ki pakad ko chodo aur dahine hath ka ulta hook banate hue upar se flap ko ek hi zatke se khol do, ab respirator ko chhod do aur dono hath sidh main lao ‘Up’ par karwahi is prakar karo ki dono hathon se siling ko is prakar pakdo ki dahine hath ki charon ungliya siling ke upar se bayen hath ki charo ungliya upar se aur aungatha niche se ho, dahine hath ko siling se ulta kar do. Ab dono hathon se siling ko wahi se pakad kar upar khincho aur piche pith par siling ko faink do aur yakin karo ki dahine ki taraf siling ulti aur bayen ki sidhi ho. Alternative Position aur Gas tayari ki dusri position Yeh position us samay akhtiyar kiya jata hai jab ham march karke I.S. duty main ja rahe ho, bich raste main kahi achanak majma miljaye to ‘ gas tayari ki dusri position’ akhtiyar karte hai. Siling position ki haalat se hukum milta hai gas tayari ki dusri positin, to is aadesh par savadhan hote hue aur dono hathon ko respirator par ek sath maro, ‘’ up ‘’ par sikhe hue tarike se respirator ko samne lao aur bayen hath ko siling ke andar se bahar ko lao. Is position main whip card nahi nikali jayegi. Respirator ko bayen hath se pakdo aur flap ko sikhe hue tarike se kholo. Ab respirator ko bayen hath ki madad se dhire se chod do aur ab dono haathon se siling ko is prakar se pakdo ki charo ungliya bahar se aur angutha andar se ho aur siling ko pakadte hue dono hathon se upar ko khicho aur gardan ki upar siling main ek khisakne wali ganth laga do abhi dono hathon se flap ko sikhe hue tarike se 3 fold karo aur respirator ke andar dalo, dono hathon ki hatheli ka rukh andar ki taraf rakhte hue ‘up’ bolo, hathon ko vishram ki position main lao, sath hi pair ko khol do. Correct Fitting Of Respirator - Bayen hath se cap ko sir se utaar kar ghutno se dabao. Yadi 283 steel helmet ya jungle hat hai to bayen hath se piche karen sath hi dahine hath se face piece ko haver sack se bahar nikal. Kabhi bhi connecting tube se pakad kar face piece ko bahar nahi nikalna chahiye .Abhi chin rest ke najdik wale head harness ko dono hathon se is prakar pakdo ki angutha head harness ki andar se aur charo unglian bahar se ho. Dono hathon ke bahar se aur respirator ko chin par pahle le jao. Taki chinrest wala hissa chin par thik baith jaye. Iske baad dono hathon ki madad se head pad ko sir par lagao yadi koi had harness muda ho to usko sidha karo sath hi unko jarurat ki mutabik kas do (Class ko face piece ki sahi fitting dikhane ke liye shikshak face piece nahi pahanayega balki class ke jis jawan ne face piece thik pahana hua hai usko class se bahar nikalo aur class ke samne khade kar do. Sahi fitting ki aur baton main yeh baten aati hai: a) Thodi face piece ki chinrest main thik hai. b) Face piece pure chehare par thik baith gaya hai. c) Head harness kase hue aur sidhe hon. d) Aankh , eye pieces ki centre main ho. iske bad class ke koi aise do jawano ko nikalo jisme se ek ka face piece bahut bada ho aur dusare ka bahut chota ho. Sankshep Sawal jawab se 36-40 Min ************************************************************************* ************************************************************************* ********************************************************************** 284 SL NO. TITLE DETAIL TIME ONE MINUTE DRILLS WITH WEAPONS (CODE- OMD-W) LESSON-1: CLEANING OF FIREARMS 285 1. Shuru Shuru ka kaam 2. Path parichay 3. Lakshya 4. Dohrai 5. Uddesh 6. Pahunch 7. Tartib 8. Abhiyas 9. 10. Shak ya sawal Sankshep 11. Jaroori Gyan Instructor trainees ka ginti Karen aur buddy pair main bantein.Safai honewale hathiaron ko nirikshan Karen.Akin Karen barrel ko saf karnekelie pullthrough aur chindi har Jodi ki pass taiyar ho. Hathiar ko sahi istemal karnekelie aur jarurath parnepar turant fire karnekelie hathiar ka barrel ko saf rakna jaroori hain. Kam se kam samay main hathiar ka barrel ko sahi saf karna ek jawan ki niyayat jaroori kam hain. Buddy ki sath karnewale ek –ek minute drill ka nam bathayen? Sabak ka uddesh buddy pair jaldisejal hathiyaron ka barrel ko saf karna. Jaldisejal hathiyaron ka barrel ko buddypairmain rathehue sahi saf karsakthehain.Sahi saf kia hua hathiyar se bina rukawat ka lagataar fire kar sakthehain. His drill main ek jawan hathiyar ko pakaden aur magazine slot ko apne buddy ko histarah dikayen ki weh jaldisejal aur lagathar 03 ya 04 bar pullthrough marker hathiyar ko saf Karen aur check Karen ki barrel sahi saf hua ya nahi hain. His tarah 03 ya 04 hathiyar ko ek buddy safai Karen. Uppar bataya tartib ko buddypairon se lagathar abhiyas karayen. Koi shak ya sawal honese dur Karen. Jawanon ko hathiyar safai jaldi aur lagathar karnemain his tarah abhiyas denese hathiar ko sahi istemal karnemain asan hoga. 1)Jaldisejal hathiyaron ka barrel ko buddypairmain rathehue sahi saf karsakthehain. 2)Sahi saf kia hua hathiyar se bina rukawat ka lagataar fire kar sakthehain. 02 min 02 min 01 min 02 min 01 min 03 min 03 min 20 min 02 min 02 min 02 min 286 ****************************************************************** LESSON-2: FILLING MAGAZINE WITH ONE HAND 287 SL NO. 1. 2. TITLE Shuru Shuru ka kaam Path parichay 3. Lakshya 4. Dohrai 5. Uddesh 6. Pahunch 7. Tartib 8. Abhiyas 9. Shak ya sawal Sankshep 10. 11. Jaroori Gyan DETAIL Instructor, trainees ka ginti aur baant Karen.AK-47,SLR,9MM Pistol magazines aur hunka Rds ka mulahza Karen. Magazine ko ek hath se barna ek katin kam hain.Lekin abhiyas ke baad yeh aasan kam hojayaga aur hathiar ka advance handling main madad dega. Trainees ko his tarah ek hath se magazine barne main abhiyas denese hunka hathiar ki prati manobal badega aur jaldi hathiar ko istemal karnemain madad hoga. Gun and Stealth one minute drill main kam aanewale chalon ka nam bathayen? Sabak ka uddesh jaldise ek hathse hathiaronka magazine barneka abhiyas dena hain. Jaldisejal magazine ko ek hathse barnemain fouz ku hathiar istemal karnemain manobal badega aur fouz C.I ops main aur bhi kamyabhi hoga. His drill main ek minute main trainees ek hathse AK-47 Magazine 20 rds ka do baar barna ya SLR magazine 10 rds ka do baar barna ya 9MM Pistol Magazine 10 rds do baar barna.Dusra hath ka istemal kisi bhi kam main nahi hoga.Yeh Hathiar ka advance handling ka ek kala hain. Uppar bathaya tartib ko trainees se baar baar abhiyas karayen.Ek achcha trainerka supervision main yeh drill ka abhiyas karana bahut jaroori hain. Trainees ko koi shak ya sawal honese dur Karen. Hathiar ka advance handling main jawan ko abhiyas denese fouz ka kamyabi aur badega. Jaldisejal magazine ko ek hathse barnemain fouz ku hathiar istemal karnemain manobal badega. TIME 02 MIN 02 MIN 03 MIN 02 MIN 01 MIN 02 MIN 04 MIN 18 MIN 03 MIN 01 MIN 02 MIN 288 Fouz C.I ops main aur bhi kamyabhi hoga. FILLING MAGAZINE WITH ONE HAND ******************************************************************* LESSON-3: GUN AND STEALTH SL NO. 1. 2. TITLE Shuru Shuru ka kaam Path parichay 3. Lakshya 4. Dohrai 5. Uddesh 6. Pahunch 7. Tartib DETAIL Instructor trainees ka ginti aur baant Karen.Hunka hathiyar ko(SLR/INSAS/AK-47) nirikshan Karen. Bina awas kiye harkat karna hum lok kelie jeet hain. Dushman ka harkat awas ki saath ho woh bi hamarelie jeet hain. Fouz ko bina awas karwahi aur harkat karna sikhana har kaam mein jaroori hain.Hathiyar ka handling bi bina awas hona jeet ke lie niyayat jaroori hain. 1)Hathiaron ko jaldisejal saf karnekelie ek minute drill ki baremain varnan Karen? Sabak ka uddesh jaldisejal bina awas kie hathiar ki sath harkat karneka abhiyas dena hain. Raath main harkat kaan ki madad se hone se larai main jeet aasil hoga. Agar fouz bari awas ki saath harkat karnese dushman ko hamara jagah patha karne aur hamla karne main kamyabi hojayega. His drill main bina awas kie TIME 02 min 02 min 02 min 03 min 01 min 02 min 04 min 289 8. Abhiyas 9. Shak ya sawal Sankshep 10. 11. Jaroori Gyan hathiar ko cock karna-huskelie kabda ko ungli aur trigger ki bich main lafetkar dabane se –kamse kam awas main cock karsaktha hai.Phir, monkey crawl, Cheetah chal ,lodkan chal aur boodh chal se ek jagah se dusra jagah janeka abhiyas den. Hisi tartib ko baar baar abhiyas karayen.Jungle aur Plain ilaqa main raath aur din main his drill ko abhiyas karnese bina awas harkat karnemain fouz waqfiat hojayega. Koi shak ya sawal honese dur Karen. Kisi bi harkat kamse kam awas se honepar fouz ka harkat main surprise rahega aur dushman ko hamara jagah patha karnemain mushkil hoga. Raath main harkat kaan ki madad se hone se larai main jeet aasil hoga. Jungle aur Plain ilaqa main raath aur din main his drill ko abhiyas karnese bina awas harkat karnemain fouz waqfiat hojayega. 19 min 02 min 01 min 02 min GUN AND STEALTH LESSON-4: PREPARING A RANGE FOR FIREARMS PRACTICE SL NO. 1. TITLE Shuru Shuru ka DETAIL Instructor trainees ka ginti Karen aur buddy main baantein.His drill TIME 02 min 290 kaam 2. Path parichay 3. Lakshya 4. Dohrai 5. Uddesh 6. Pahunch 7. Tartib 8. Abhiyas 9. Shak ya sawal Sankshep 10. 11. Jaroori Gyan main 03 ya 04 buddy ka ek abhiyas main jarurath hain. Ek abhiyas ki baad baki buddyonse yeh drill karayen. Firing ke lie Range ko taiyar karna aur huska jankari har sadasiyon ke lie jaroori hain. Range ko firing ke lie jaldisejal taiyar karna har CRPF sadasiyon ke lie mahatvapoorn kam hain. His drill main husk am ka jaldi aur durust karnekelie abhiyas diajayega. Hathiar ka advance handling aur Magazine ko ek hath se barneka kya sambandh hain? Sabak ka uddesh 03 ya 04 buddyse Firing range ko jaldi aur tartib se taiyar karna sikhana hain. Firing range ko taiyar karnekelie, Firing point main sandbag lagana, tripal bichana, Butt main targeton ko lagana, Butt ke pichche bada lal janda lagana hain, Range ki charon tarafse laljanda aur guard lagana hain aur bhi anya kam karna hain. His drill main shamil kiagaya buddys eke k kam karthe range ko firing ke lie taiyar Karen aur sath sath ek buddy husko akin karte jayen. Koi kami honepar bathayen taki Range firing ke lie sahi taiyar ho jayega. His tartib ko 02 ya teen baar alak alak group/buddyse abhiyas karayen, aur galti ko batate rahen. Trainees ka shak ya sawal ko dur Karen. Firing range ko kamsamaymain taiyar karneka abhiyas denese fouz his kam ko jaldise jal karega aur samay ka bachat hoga. Range ko firing ke lie jaldisejal taiyar karna har CRPF sadasiyon ke lie mahatvapoorn kam hain. Firing range ko taiyar karnekelie, Firing point main sandbag lagana, tripal bichana, Butt main targeton ko lagana, Butt ke pichche bada lal janda lagana hain, Range ki charon 02 min 02 min 03 min 01 min 02 min 05 min 17 min 02 min 01 min 03 min 291 tarafse laljanda aur guard lagana hain aur bhi anya kam karna hain. PREPARING A RANGE FOR FIREARMS PRACTICE ********************************************************************************* SL NO. 1. 2. LESSON-5: STRESS SHOOTING TITLE Shuru Shuru ka kaam Path parichay 3. Lakshya 4. Dohrai 5. Uddesh 6. Pahunch 7. Tartib DETAIL Instructor trainees ka ginti aur buddymain baant Karen.Har abhiyas ke lie 04 buddys ko detail Karen.Trainees ka hathiar ko mulhaza Karen aur istemal honewale rukawaton ko check Karen. Stress shooting ek jaroori ek minute drill hain jismain buddy bahut taklif se nikalkar target ke uppar fire kartein hain. Buddys ko hathiyar ki sath rukawaton ko par karakar antmain rangemain firing karanese hunka firing ka kabliat sahi napha ja saktha hain. Ek hath se magazine ko barnese trainees ka hosla kaisa badega? Sabak ka uddesh stress shooting yaniki taklif ke sath achcha fire karneka abhiyas dena hain. Ek jawan ya buddy bahut taklif se rukawton ko paar karnekebaad target ki uppar sahi hit karna C.I ops fouz ke lie bahut jaroori hain. His drill main 04 buddy ko hathiar ki saath detail Karen.Hunko 03 rukawaten-jaisaki crawlingmain balli TIME 02 min 02 min 02 min 02 min 01 min 02 min 04 min 292 8. Abhiyas 9. Shak ya sawal Sankshep 10. 11. Jaroori Gyan ko paar karna,daur ke beam ko jump se paar karna aur letkar barrel ya tar ki nichchese gujarna.Antmain hathiar se target ko uppar 05 rd firekarna.Yeh drill ki timing har buddy ka lena aur kamjor buddy ko aur abhiyas dena hain. Uppar bathaya drill ko buddy se karana hain aur hunka kul samay notekarke kamjor buddy ko dubara mouka dena hain. Trainees ka shaky a sawal ko dur Karen. Stress shooting kamjor buddyko mazbut banayaga aur fouz ka kul manobalku aur badayaga. Ek jawan ya buddy bahut taklif se rukawton ko paar karnekebaad target ki uppar sahi hit karna C.I ops fouz ke lie bahut jaroori hain. Buddys ko hathiyar ki sath rukawaton ko par karakar antmain rangemain firing karanese hunka firing ka kabliat sahi napha ja saktha hain. 19 min 02 min 01 min 03 min STRESS SHOOTING LESSON-6: SAFELY TAKING AND DEPOSITING FIREARMS FROM ARMOURY SL NO. 1. 2. 3. TITLE Shuru Shuru ka kaam Path parichay Lakshya DETAIL Instructor trainees ka ginti aur baant Karen.Kote ka nirakshan aur kote U.O ko briefing Karen. Yeh ek shru shru ka drill hain joki har jawanon ke lie bahut jaroori hain. Hathiyar ko kote se nirikshan karke lena aur kali karke wapis karna his drill ka siklai hain. TIME 02 min 02 min 02 min 293 4. Dohrai 5. Uddesh 6. Pahunch 7. Tartib 8. Abhiyas 9. Shak ya sawal Sankshep 10. 11. Jaroori Gyan Stress shooting aur Gunand stealth drills ka kya antar hain/ Sabak ka uddesh trainees ko kote se hathiyar nirikshan ke baad lena aur kali ke baad wapis karna sikhana hain. Jaldi nirikshan karke hathiar ko kotese lena aur wapis bi jaldi nirikshan aur kali karke dena jawanon ka kabiliat badanekelie ek jaroori drill hain. His drill main har trainees kote se hathiar ko jaldi aur sahi nirkshan karke aur barrel ko kisiko na point karke lena aur wapis sahi kali karna aur nirikshanki baad jamah karna hota hain. Hisi tartib ko baar baar abhiyas karayen.Kamjor aur dhire kam karnewale jawanon ko aurbi abhiyas den. Koi shak ya sawal honese dur Karen. Yeh drill hathiar ko hifazat se kote se lena aur wapis karna –jaldisejal karna sikhatha hain. Hathiyar ko kote se nirikshan karke lena aur kali karke wapis karna his drill ka siklai hain. Yeh drill hathiar ko hifazat se kote se lena aur wapis karna –jaldisejal karna sikhatha hain. 03 min 01 min 02 min 04 min 18 min 02 min 01 min 03 min SAFELY TAKING AND DEPOSITING FIREARMS FROM ARMOURY ********************************************************************** ************************************************************************* *********************************************************************** 294 (18).BAYONET FIGHTING (BAY) BAY 1-5 BASIC POSITION AUR KARWAIAN SHURU SHURU KI BATEN (a) Suraksha sambandhit upaye. (b) Bayonet ko charana aur seling ko kas kar magazine ke uppar lana. ©Jawano ko linon mein khada karo muh amne samne aur bich mein 12 kadam ka phasla ho. DOHRAI CQB ke hathyaron par : UDDESH Swabhavik bayonet fighting ki basic positionen aur karwaian sikhana hai. SAMAN Rifle, bayonet, magazine aur seling. PAHUNCH Kabhi kabhi hamle ke dauran aur khas taur par jungle, basti tang jagah ya rat ko lar rahe ho to bayonet fighting ka istemal larai ka faisla karne mein bahut bada hath hai is se jawan mein bayonet marne ka mada barna aur hamlawar hona zarrurai hai. Aisa hone par who dushman ko harane mein ya dushman ke dil mein dar paida kar ke use bagana aur use majboor karne mein kamyav ho sake. Bayonet fighiting karte waqt jawan ko cheekna aur garjana (dharhna) chahie taki dushman haka baka rah jaye aur thodi der ke liye nishchal (freeze) ho jaye. DHAWA POSITION Bayonet fighitin ki sab karawain dhawa position se shuru hoti hai, khas kar jawan jab daud raha ho (namuna sath nakal). Dhawa position akhtiar ke liye karwai yeh karo. (a) Dono paon aramdeh faisle par rakho, baen paon dayen paon se thoda age. 295 (b) Gutne ko thoda moro aur badan sidha rakho ya muke baz ki tarah kamar se thoda age juko. (c) Rifle ko tirche rukh badan ke samne rakho, baen hath baen kandhe ke samne uppar wali seling kari ke pas rifle hand guard se pakri hui ho. Dayne hath se small of the butt ko pakro aur dayne koni majbooti se dayen taraf press ki hui ho. (d) Is position ke liye word of command hoga “Dhawa Position”. Dhawa position ka abhiyas karo. ARAM KAR Aram karne ki position jawan ki aram karne ke liye istemal ki jati hai, jab ki jawan ko bayonet fighiting ke liye hidayat di ja rahi ho. (Namuna sath nakal) : Is position ko akthiyar karne ke liye, rifle ke butt ko majbooti se paon ke pas rakho dono paon bishram position ki tarah aur rifle ko dayen hath se fore-sight ke niche, hand guard se pakro. Baen bazu kudrati taur par baen taraf bada ke sath mila hua ho. Is position meim paon mein koi tabdili nahi, lakin gutne jukane ki zarurat nahi hai. Is position ke iic word of command hoga “Aram kar”. Abhiyas : Dhawa position aura ram kar position ka. GHUMNA Kisi bhi waqt jawan par dushman dwara hamla ho sakta hai. Isliye jawan ko is kabil hobna chahie, ki piche se hone wale hamle ka mukabala karne ke liye, piche tezi se aur balance kayam rakhte hue mud sake. (Namuna do aur samjhao) : Piche murne ke liye ya ghumne ke lioye rifle dhawa position mein rakho aur baen paon ke aydi ka istemal karte hue baen se pura piche ghum jayo(180*). Is karwai ke liye worh of command hoga “Piche ghum”. Abhiyas : Piche ghum ka abhiyas pao. SIDHA GUZARNA Bayonet ki movement ka abhiyas karte hue jawan ek dusre ki taraf lineon mein guzrte hai. Jab dono linen bahut nazdik pahunch jati hai toh dusre ki movement ko surakshit taur par karne ke liye, sidha guzar ki karwai ki jati hai. Sidha guzar ki karwai karne ke liye baen se age bado jis se dayne 296 kandha ek dusre ke pas se guzar jaye, sidha 6 kadam jane ke bad ruko aur bina adesh piche gum jao. Is karawai ke liye word of command hoga “Sidha guzar”. Abhiyas : Sqd ko basic position aur dusri karawai ka abiyas karao. Kamzori ya galti ko pakro aur abhiyas karao. SHANKSHEP (a) Sawal-o-jawab se karo. (b) “Tezi” , phurti aur “josh” par zor dete hue shankshep karo. ----------------------------------*****************-----------------HAMLE KI KARWAIAN BAY 6-11 SHURU SHURU KI BATEN (a) Suraksha sambandi upaye. (b) Bayonet fix karao seling kasa hua. DOHRAI BYT-1 par dohrai lo. UDDESH Hamle ki do karwai, ani ghompna aur butt marna sikhana hai. SAMAN Rifle, bayonet, magazine aur dhummy. PAHUNCH Ani ghompna ya butt marne ki karawai mein hamlawar hone se dushman ke dil mein dar paida ho jata hai, who defence akhityar kar leta hai. Jawano bayonet fighiting ka istemal karne ke liye dummy ka istemal kiya jata hai. (Dummy ka istemal ka namuna dete hue samjhao). Ani ghompne ki karwai dhawa positon se ki jati hai. Yeh karwai dushman ka ani 297 ghompne, niklne aur phir dhawa position mein ane par puri hoti hai. Ani ghomp ki karwai ke liye : (a) Baen paon age badao aur dayen ghutne ko modo aur bayonet ko dushman mein ghompte hue ani gompe ki karwai karo. Gompe ki karwai karte waqt bazuyo, kandho aur sharer ki takat se gompe karo. Ani gompe ki karwai par paon zamin par parte hi kalai ko rok do. Dhyne bazu is waqt butt par hona chahie. (b) Nikal ke liye paon ko apni jagah par rakho. Bayonet ko dushman ke sharir se ghusao ki line mein rakhte hue apni sharer ki takat se piche nikalo aur isi samye rifle ko niche aur piche kincho. (c) Direction ko badly karte hue, pichle paon ko age lo aur dhawa position ko akthyar kar. ANI GHOMPNE KA DUSRA TARIQA (MODIFIED). (Samjhao) Tan sashtra ki position se hamla karte waqt, dushman bahut hi nazdik or ke piche se surprise kar sakta hai. Aisi halat mein jawan ke pass itna samaye nahi hoga ki who hath ki position pistol grip ko chod kar small of the butt ko pakarne ke liye badly kar sake. Isliye ani ghompne ki karwai bina hath ki positine badly karni chahie. Is prakar dusre tariqe ki ani bilkul ani jaise hi hai, anter kewal hath ki position ka hi hai (Dusre tariqe ki, yani modified) ka namuna dikhao. Yeh karwai tab hi karni chahie, jab achank surprise ho jaye, barna jawan tak ho sake thik ani gompe ki position akthiyar karni chahie kiyonki bayonet fighting ki dusri karwaian bahut mushkil se kar sakti hai, jab ki hath pistol grip par hoi. Dono ani gompe ke liye word of command hoga “Ani ghompe”. Abhiyas : Donon tarah ki ani gompe ka abhiyas karo. BUTT MARNA 298 Butt marne ki karwai alag se ya kisi aur hamle ki karwai ke bad. Istemal mein layi ja sakti hai. Yeh karwai dushman ke sharir ki kisi bhi asurakshit hisse par ki ja sakti hai. Sir badan ka koi hissa ya gurde ka ilaqa nishan ho sakta hai. Is mutabik butt marne ki karwai, pari khari ya in dono ke bich hi hogi. (Dummy ka istemal karte hue namuna do aur samjao). Gurde ya sharir ke niche wale bhag mein butt marne ke liye paon age nikalo, rifle ko golai mein age is tarah lao ki nishana dushman ke gurde ya niche wale bhag ho, is karwai ko karo. Yadi dushman ka gurda ya niche wala hissa chuk jaye, toh butt badan ke bichobich chhati ya thodi par lag sakta hai. Is karwai ke adesh hoga “Sir, gurde ya niche bhag ke liye butt”. Abhiyas : Sqd se alag tarah ke butt marne ka abhiyas karao. Sqd se ani aur butt marne ke abhiyas bhi karao. SANKHSHEP : (a) Sawal-o-jawab se. (b) Jor dekar samjao, ki ani aur butt marna bahut zaruri mar dalne wali karwaian hai. INSTRUCTOR’S NOTE BYT-1 ki dohrai ke bad sqd dummy ke dahine do lino mein khada karo. -------------------------------------****************------------------------BAY 12-17 HAMLE AUR BACHAO KI KARWAIAN SHURU SHURU KA KAM (a) Suraksha sambandi upaye. (b) Bayonet seling kasa hua. (c) Ani aur butt marne dhorai lo. UDDESH 299 Cut, kunda marna, dhina war bacha, bayan war block sikhna hai. SAMAN Rifle, magazine, sling aur dummy. PAHUNCH Kabhi kabhi yeh mumkin hota, ki ani ghompe ya butt marne ki karwai ki ja sake ya dushman in se apna bachao kar leta hai. Aisi halat mein cut ya kunda mar ki karwai bahut bakhubi se ki ja sakti hai. Aise maoqe bhi aa sakte hai, jab dushman bayonet marne wale jawan ko surprise kar de aur us par bayonet se mar dalne wali karwai Karen. Ek bayonet marne wale jawan ko aise halat ka samna karne ke liye war bacha aur block ke istemal se kisi hamlawar karwai ke liye tayar rahna chahie. CUT Cut ka istemal alag se ya kisi karwai ke bad kiya ja sakta hai. Butt ki tarah is ko bhi dushman ke badan ke kisi bhi asurakshit hisse par istemal kar sakte hai. Cut pare, khare ya in dono ke bich yani tircha ho sakta hai. (Alag alag tarah ke cut ko samjao aur unka namuna hawa mein do). Dummy par cut lagane se hathiyar ko nuksan pahuchega, ye baat sqd ko bhi samjao. Dhawa position se cut marne ke liye, dahine paon ko majboot adhar banakar baen paon age badao, baen bazu ko pura phailakar aur butt ko duri (Pivot) banate hue, bayonet ke tez kinare ko niche ya ar par chakkar ke taur par ghumao. Pichle paon ko age ghumao aur dhawa position akthiyar karo. Bina bayan kiye alag alag tarah ke cut tez gatt se hawa mein karke dikahao. Is karwai ke adesh hoga “Khara ya tircha ya para cut”. Abhiyas : (Sqd ko cut ka abhiyas bagair dummy ke karao, hathiyaro ko tut-phut se bachaya ja sake. KUNDA MAR Morche jungle ya ghane jahridhar ilaqe mein lar rahe ho toh kunda mar bekhubi se kiya ja sakta hai. Dushman ke badan ka koi bhi asurakshit hissa nishana ho sakta hai. (Dummy ka istemal karte hue samjao). Dhawa position se kunda marne ke liye, rifile ko bine kandhe par uppar ki taraf ghumao. Bayonet ka nokila hissa piche, sling upar aur rifile zamin ke mutwazi ho, dhina paon age karte hue, bazuon ko pura age karo aur dushman ko rifle ke butt se maro, dhine paon ko thoda dhine rakhte hue, pichle paon ko age milao aur dhawa position akthiyar karo. Is karwai ke liye adesh hoga “Kunda mar”. Abhiyas : Sqd se kunda mar ka abhiyas karao. WAR BACHA War bachao ka istemal ani ke barkhilaf kia jata hai, agar dushman ki rifle bachne waleke dhaine khule ke sath hai, to baen war bacha, agar hathiyar baen khuleke sath ho, to dhina war bacha kiya jayefa. (Dummy ka istemal karte hue dhinewar aur baen war bacha ka namuna do aur samjao). Dahina war bacha : Dahina war bacha ke liye, age wale paon par ek kadam age lo aur piche wale ko adhar banate hue usi jagah par rakho, baen bazu, sharir ki puri takat se pura age phaila do aur dushman ke hathiyar par rifle ke upar wale bhag se dhine taraf modo, dushman ka 300 bayonet ab bayonet marne wale jawan se alag kar rakha hoga aur dushman ke badan ka baen hissa hamle ke liye asurakshit ho jayega bina. Bina dhawa position akthiyar kiye hue, isi position se koi bhi hamle ki karawai karo, dushman ko marne ke bad dhawa position akthiyar karo. Bayan war bacha :Byan war bacha waise hi jaise dahina war bacha, fark sirf itna hai war bacha mein dushman ke hathiyar ko baen tarf mana gaya hai. Baen war bacha ke bad bhi koi bhi hamle ki karwai ki ja sakti hai. Ginti se war bacha ani ghompne ke abhiyas lo. Adesh yeh hoga : (a) “Dahine ya bhayen war bacha,Thahro Bacha” (b) “Ghomp Thahrao Fhomp” (c) “Nikal Thahrao Nikal” (d) “Dhawa Position” (e) Am rafter se baen ya baen war bachake liye adesh hoga “Dahine War ya Baen War Bacha” Abhiyas : Sqd se dahine se war bache ka abhiyas karao. BLOCKS Blocks ka istemal, dushman ko nakar karne aur uske toli ko (balance) bigarne ke liye kiya jata hai. Iska istemal tab kiya jata hai, jab hamla karne wale dushman ne surprise kar diya ho. Blocks ke bad hamlawar karwai ki jati hai. (Namuna dete hue samjao, madad ke liye sqd se student lo aur dummy rifle ka istemal karo). (a) Nicha war bachan : Iska istemal, butt jo ki gurdhe ya sharir ke niche wale bhag ke liye hai, uske khilaf kiya jata hai, tol balance ko kayam rakhne ke liye niche war bacha karte samaye, paon ko apne rakho jagah. Dhine hath apni jagah rakhte hue, baen hath ko itna niche lao ki rifle zamin ke mutabiz hi jaye. Apni rifle ko niche ki taraf dabakar, dushman ki rifle ko pare hata do uske bad koi hamle wali karwai karo aur phir dhawa position akthiyar karo. (b) Side blocks: Butt ya cut jab ki badan ke kisi taraf nishana mankar kiya ja raha ho, to uske khilaf side block ka istemal kiya jata hai. Side block dahine ya baen ho sakta hai. Iska dahine ya baen hona dushman ke war par nirbahar karta hai, side block karwai karne ke liye, paon ko apni jagah rakho. Dahine hath ko apni jagah rakhte hue, rifile ko baen hath se baen taraf karte hue badan ke samne khade rukh mein lao. Apni rifile ko dushman ki rifile mein dayen ya baen aur dushman ka tol bigar do. Iske bad koi hamalawar karwai karo aur phir dhawa position akthiyar karo. (c) Uncha block : Kunda mar ya khare cut ke khilaf, unche block ka istemal kiya jata hai, paon ko apni jagah rakho aur thoda modo. Baen hath ko apni jagah par rakhte hue, dahine hath se rifile ke butt ko utna uthao, ki rifile chahre ke samne aur zamin ke mutbazi ho. Rifile ke bich wale bhag ko marne wala hissa man kar, kohnion 301 aurgutnon par kabu rakhte hue, dono bazu bahar ki taraf pure phaila do. Is ke bad koi hamlawar karwai karo aur phir dhawa position akthiyar karo. Block (a) (b) (c) aur butt ke istemal ke ahista raftar se yeh adesh honge : “Niche, uncha side war bacha, thahro, bacha”. “Butt, thahro butt”. “Dhawa position”. Aam raftar ke liye adesh : (a) “Nicha war bacha aur aiche bhag ke liye butt shuru kar”. (b) “Uncha war bacha aur kunda mar shuru kar”. (c) “Side war bacha aur khara cut shuru kar”. Abhiyas (a) Squad se lakri ki dummy rifilon ke istemal se block ka istemal karo. (b) (Squad se pure kam ka abhiyas karao). War bacha aur block ka abhiyas karte waqt, bacha ke bad hamle ki sab karwaion ka abhiyas karana chahie. Jisse sikhne wale ke dimag mein yeh baith jaye ki dushman ko tol bacha ki karwai kar ke kharab karne ke bad halat ke mutabik koi bhi hamle ki karwai ki ja sakti hai. SANKSHEP (a) Squad ke sawalo jawab pucho. (b) Is bat par zor dete hue ki bachao ki karwai alag se istemal nahi ki jati. Bachao ke bad zaruri hai ki hamla kiya jaye. Bachao ki karwai se dushman ke tol ko bigarne ke bad bayonet marne wale koi bhi hamle ki karwai karne ki puri chutt hai. NOTE KI BATEN (a) Block ka namuna aur abhiyas karte samay, hathiyaron ki tutphut se bachne ke liye lakri ki dummy rifile ka istemal karna chahie. (b) Hathiyaron ki tut-phut se bachne ke liye, cut ki karwai dummy ka istemal kiye bagair hawa mein karni chahie. (c) Squad ki position waise hi honi chahie, jaise ki pichle wale saqab mein batai gayi hai. ---------------------------********************------------------------------- BAY 18-29 302 BACHAO AUR HAMLE KI MILI JHULI KARWAIAN SHURU SHURU KA KAM (a) Suraksha sambandhi upay. (b) Bayonet aur sling kasa hua. UDDESH Mili jhuli karwaion mein bachao aur hamle ki karwaian sikhana hai. SAMAN Rifile, bayonet, magazine, lakri ki dummy rifile aur dummy. PAHUNCH Hamle aur bachao ki alag karwaian sikhane ke bad, yeh zaruri hai ki jawan in sab ko mila kar lagatar paryog bhi sikh le, kyonki kabhi aisa bhi ho sakta hai ki dushman sirf ek ya do hamle ki karwai se na mare. Isliye bayonet marne wale itna mahir hona chahie ki agar dushman shuru shuru ke hamle se apne ap ko bacha le, ya koi hamle ki karwai karne ki koshish kare, to jawan kisi bhi hamle ya bachao ki karwai kar sake. MILI JHULI KARWAIAN Dummy ka istemal karte hue namuna do aur samjao dhawa position se baen war bacha, ki karwai ke bad ani ko ghomp ki karwai karo, dushman ani ghomp ki karwai ke bahar ho ya dur ho sir ke liye butt ki karwai karo. Dushman piche hat jata hai to chhati par butt marne ki karwai karo. Dhawa position mein akar, dusre dushman ka samna karne ke liye tayar ho jao. Yeh karawai ek khas halat mein istemal ki jati hai dusri karwaion mein abhiyas dene ki liye isi prakar ke dusre halat paida kiye ja sakte hai. Tartib war har karwai ke liye adesh diye jyen aur jawan usi mutabik karwai Karen. Jawan ko sab karwaion abhiyas karao, galtian pakro aur phir abhiyas do. SANKSHEP Squad se sawal-o-jawab se sankshep karo. 303 NOTE KI BATEN (a) Scode ko do linion mein banta jayega aur unki position basi hi honi chahie jaise ki pahle saqabon mein batai gayi hai. (b) Block ka abhiyas karne ke liye ek line walon ke pass, lakri ki dummy rifile aur dusre lini service rifile istemal Karen, iske bad apas mein badly karo. (c) Jiske pas service rifle hai, who bachao ki karwai Karen aur bachao ke bad hamle ki karwai ka abhiyas Karen. (d) Hathiyaron ki tut-phut se bachne ke liye, bachao ki karwai dhire ki jaye ya phir dono lino ke pas lakri ki dummy rifle honi chahie. Jise tezi ke sath in karwaion ka abhiyas karya ja sake. (e) Ustad ko tezi, phurti aur josh par zaida zor dena chahie aur sqd ki choti moti galti check nahi karni chahie. -------------------------------***************------------------------------------ BAY 19-35 TAN SHASTR AUR ANI GHOMPNA SHURU KA KAM Rifilon ka mulahiza karo hukam mile bayonet ki line tayar ho jaye to is hukam par jis ke pass gari ho, who utar de, bayonet scabbard ke sath rifile par charha kar rifile cock aur safety catch ‘R’ par line ban jao. Bayonet ke liye khul jao, is hukam par sqd itna khul jaye ki ek dusre ke bagli faisla karib 3 kadam ho. UDDESH Tan-shastr position akthiyar karna, khare aur lete dushman par ani ghompna sikhana. SAMAN Rifile, sangeen, khari aur leti dummian. Pahunch 304 Kai mauquo par dushman ki position par dhawa bholte samye aur jungle mein ya kisi bandh ilaqe mein larte samaye. Sansin ka war ya is ke war ki dhamki bahut kargar sabit hoti. Is liye khas kar infantry ke jawano ko is kabil hona chahie, ki who sangeen k war karke dushman ko barbad kar saken. Sangeen marne wale jawan mein teen siftaen honi chahie, josh, tezi aur sidhai. Yeh dabaq teen bhago mein jayega : BHAG 1- TAN SHASTRA AUR UNCHA BAEN SHASTRA Tan shastra position aur aram kar : (Namunaaur nakal) Infantry ke jawan shatru ki position ke upar dhawa bholte samaye uske nazdik pahunch kar jab yeh kisi par sangeen se war karne ko, tan sastra ki position akthiyar karte hai. Tan shashtra ka hukam milne par, baen paon ko ek kadam chalti halat mein age lo, dahine hath se rifle ko uchalte hue badan ke samne lao, dono hatho se ek sath pakro, is position mein khyal rakhne ki baten. Rifle ko dono hatho se prakar te hue sakal daraoni ho, sangeen ki nok shatru ki pet ki seedh mein, baen hath se hand guard majbooti se pakra hua ho aur koni se ander ki taraf muda hua hona chahie. Dahine hath se pistol grip charon ungli aur angutha pakra hua, butt khule par majbooti se jama hua taki ani ghompte samaye jism ka pura jor dala ja sake. Baen paon mein khamb aur badan mein bhoj us par ko sath hi dahina paon piche khicha hua aur panja chalti halat mein ho, hukam milega “Aram kar” toh rifile ko dahine hath se pistal grip se chorte hue, baen hath se rifile ko piche ki taraf karo aur dahine hath se pakro. Butt dono tango ke bich mein rahe, (yaha se bhi tan sashtra ki position ki karwai is prakar hai. BHAG 2 KHARE AUR LETE DUSHMAN PAR ANI GHOMPNA Ek khare dushman par ani ghompna (Namuna thehrao se baen ke sath) (a) (Dummy ke dahine line banana batao). “No.1 dummy ke samne line ban” ke hukam par rifile ko uncha baen sashtra ki position mein lete hue dummy ki karwai dus gaz ke phasale par jakar dummy ki taraf muh karte hue khade ho(sawal-o-jawab se tan sashtra position mein aao. (b) “Tayar ho” Hukam pr dummy ke karib 5 ya 6 feet ke faisle par khade ho jao. (c) “Ani ghomp thahrao ghomp” ke hukam par piche wale poan ko age barate hue sath hi dono paon ko uchalte hue, sangeen shatru ke pet mein pure jor se ghomp do is position mein dekhne ki baten, sangeen pet mein teen se char inch tak ghusa hua baen hath ka khamb nikalna zarurai hai,dahine hath se usi prakar pakra haua lakin dahine rahe ki butt khule se alag nahi hona chahie. Paon ki position tan sashtra ki tarah aur nigah jahan sangeen ghompa hai waha honi chahie. Ek lete hue dushman par ani ghompa (Namuna baen ke sath) : Larai ke halat mein hame dushman hamesha hi nahi milega, balki leta dushman bhi milega, isliye zaruri hai ki usko barbad kiya jaye. Is kam ka 305 namuna dekhna (tharao se namuna do). Dummy ke samne an eke tariqa usi prakar hai jaise khade dummy par ani ghompte samaye akthiyar kiya tha. BHAG 3 EK SE ZAIDA DUSHMAN PAR ANI GHOMPNA (Namuna baen se) Bahut se mauqon par jawan ko dushman ka samna karna parega. Aise pauqon par skb se nazdik bale dushman par war karo agar dusra kuch dur ho to sikhe hue tariqe se tan sashtra karte dusre ki taraf doudte hue war karo. Agar dusra dushman itna nazdik ho ki pahle ko marne ke bad tan sashtar karne ka mouqana mile to nikal ki position se hi us par sangeen ghomp diya jata hai aur isi tarah ek ek karke dushman ko thikane laga diya jata hai. Is kam ka namuna dekhen: (Tan sashtra ki position tak sawal-o-jawab se ho) Hukam milega ‘chal kar do ani ghomp’ nikal par thahro, ghomp ko pahle dummy par ani ghomp kar nikal ki position mein kahde ho jao, jahan se dusra dushman milne par, agar tan sashtra ki position akthiyarnahi kiya ja sakta to dusre dushman par ani ghomne ki line sangeen ka rukh dusre dushman ki taraf karte hue triqe ke anusar ghomp ki karwai ki jaye. SANKSHEP Sawal-o-jawab karo : INSTRUCTOR’S NOTE Bayonet traning ka uddesh hai, jawan ko bharosa dilane ki who zarurat parne par dushman ko sangeen se barbad kar sakta hai. (a) Ani ghompte samay, baen hath ka khamb nilkalna zaruri hai parantu butt khue par jawan taki ani ghompte waqt zism ka pua zor dal de. (b) Bayonet traning mein sab se zarurai chizen, josh, teziaur sidhai hai. Agar jawan ke ander yeh khubyan hai to use mamuli galtion ke liye na toka jaye. Jahan tak ho sake hark am dour chal se karwao. ---------------------------******************------------------------------------- BAY 36-38 TRAINING STICK SHURU KA KAM Rifle ka mulahiza, rifle cock, bayonet mayan ke sath charhi hui ho aur mayan rassi se rifle ke sath bandhi ho. DOHARI 306 Tan shastra position. UDDESH Training stick ka istemal sikhana hai. SAMAN Rifile, sangin(mayan ke sath) aur har jawan ke liye training stick. PAHUNCH Training stick is liye istemal ki jati hai taki uske zarie sangin ki sikhlai ke dauran jawan ki harkaton mein tezi paida kar sake. BHAG Yeh sabaq teen bhagon mein sikhaya jayega. BHAG 1 TRAINING STICK KA BAEN AUR PAKARNA. (a) Training stick (Traning stick ko hath mein lekar baen karo). Training stick k eek sir par ek gadha hota hai. Yeh gadha 2” qutar(diameter) ka kirmich ya tat ko gol tukra hai. Is mein boaien ke tukare ya busa bharkar ek tar ke zarie, stick mein bani jhiri mein bandh diya jata hai, yeh ganth dushman ki bayonet ken ok ko zahir karta hai. Jab ganth wala sira jab jawan ki taraf kiya jaye to who fouran tan sashtra ki position akthiyar kar le. Traning stick ke dusre sire par teen inch qutar(diameter) wala chhalla(ring) hota hai. Is ring par dori ya patli rassi lappet di jati hai. Yeh ring dushman ke ring najuk hisse ki zahir karta hai. Jab yeh ring age kiya jaye toh rifile wala jawan age badkar us par ani ghomp traning stick ki kul lambhai 5feet 9” honi chahie. (b) Training stick pakarne ka tarika: Training stick ko is tarah pakra jata hai gaadi wala sira age ki taraf karke stick ko baen hath se lag bag bich mein se aur dahine hath ring se koi 1 feet kef aisle par pakar lo aura b tan sashtra ki position akthiyar karo. Is position mein dekhne ki batyen, ring khare rukh hona chahie. Apne jism ko aram dene ke liye gadde ko niche karke zamin par tika do. Is ka matlab yeh hoga ki stick ya dushman thodi der ke liye karwai nahi kar sakta(Gaddi ko zamin par mat pakro). Abhiyas karne ke liye hukam yeh hoga “Ek” is hukam par tan sashtra aur “Do” apr aram ki position akhtiyar ki jayegi. BAGH 2 -DAHINE TARAF RING DIKHANA AUR ANI GHOMPNA. (a) Dahine taraf ring dikhana : Traning stick tan sashtra ki position mein rakhi hui ho aur jawan ka darmaini faisala 5 kadam ho, baen karo. Yahan se dahine taraf ani ghopne ki line, ring ko dahine taraf is tarah dikahiya jata hai, baen bazu itna piche kahihoho ki jism se lag jaye aur sath ring ko khade ruk rakhte hut dahine taraf kar do. Is mein dekhne ki baten. Age wale paon mein khamb pichle paon sakth, nigah ring par honi chahie. Ring khade rukh mein ho. Agar yahan se ani aur ghompna ho to pahle ghomph aur nikal katham ho jane ke bad ek kadam piche ko lo (khud karo). “Sidha guzar” ke liye gadhe ko niche zamin par tika do aur inko bagal mein chupao (kudh karo). 307 (b) Abhiyas : Is kam ka abhiyas karo (Abhiyas ke bad sqd ek taraf close aur kisi ek jawan ko rifileline ka hukam do). (c) Dahine taraf rifile aur training stick ka istemal : Jawan ka kam hai ki gadhe par nigah rakhte hue purti se tan sashtra karke hamla kare. Junhi jawan hamla kare, dahina ring dikhao, jawan ani ghomp kar nikal kar ke thahar jayega. Ab baen karo ki jab tak ring chupaya ya dusra ani ke liye nahi dikhaya jata, jawan ka kam is jagah par tharna hai. Ab dusri ani ke line ring dikhao aur sidha guzar karo. Abhiyas : Is kam ka jorion mein abhiyas ke bad jawan ke pas traning stick honi chahie. SANKSHEP Sawal-o-jawab. INSTRUCTOR’S NOTE (a) Traning stick wazan mein halki honi chahie aur uska gadha aur ring aisa hona chahie ki us se rifle se kisi hisse bayonet ya mayan kisi kisam ka nuksan na pahuchaye. (b) Traning stick ki sikhlai bayonet ka ek khas hissa isliye traning stick ko khub zor se chalaya jaye, jis jawan ke hath mein traning stick ho who ustad dahine aur jiske hath mein rifile hai who shagirdh. Ustad traning stick ko jitna furti se hilayega, sagirdh ko mashq se utna hi zaida faida pahunchega. (c) Jo jawan ustad bane, unhe chahie ki apne sagirdhonki harkaton ko gaur se dekhen aur koi galti malum ho to unhe batani chahie. Maslan chutki se kam karna, zor se age na barna, durust harkat na karna aur bhi koi choti moti galtian mashq hi har darje ke akhir mein batayi jaye. Sikhli ke in darjon mein ustad kisi ek ko chunkar use kudh abhiyas karye. (d) Sikhlai paye hue jawan ko abhiyas karne ya traning stick ki mashq shuru karne ke bad, sikhlai ke kisi darje mein jawan ki harkaton mein tezi paida karne ke liye. Ustad har ek jawan se bari bari abhiyas kar sakta hai. Who sqd ko apne girdh ek bade dhire mein khada karke jawan se point marne ya war bachane ki mashq kkara sakta hai, war bachana agle sqd mein sikhaya jayega. Yeh mashq is sabaq ke akhri darje mein krai jaye. --------------------------------***************---------------------------- BAY 39-42 ZATI BACHAO SHURU KA KAM Rifle ka mulahiza karo, rifle par sangeen charha hua aur mayan rassi se bandha hua ho. DOHRAI 308 Traning stick ke sath ek aur do ani ghopna. UDDESH Zati bachao sikhana. SAMAN Rifle, sangeen, traning stick aur rassi. PAHUNCH Jawan ke liya yeh zarurai hai ki who apne bachao ke kuch tariqe sikh le, lakin use achi tarah samaj lena chahie, ki uska asli maqsad apna bachao karna hi nahi, balki dushman par war karke us ko barbad karna hai. BHAG Yeh sabaq 4 bagho mein sikhaya jayega. BHAG 1- BAEN WAR BACHANA, KUNDA MARNA AUR ANI GHOMPNA. Jawan ko batao ki jab who apne apnea p ko dushmanke war se bacha le to who jhat par khud hamla kare, jab dushman baen taraf war kare toh bayea war bacha, dushman ke hathiyar ke war ko ran karne ka sabse acha aura san tariqa hai, ab dushman jawan ki tan sashtra wali position ke andhaer aa jata hai, is liye jawan apna sangeen istemal nahi kar sakenge. Is liye zarurai hai ki jawan pahie to dushman par kunda mare aur sangeen se us ko thikane laga de. BHAG 2- BAEN WAR BACHA KE SATH TRANING STICK KA ISTEMAL. Jwan ko kabhi bhi is position mein nahin roka jata. Sirf sqd ka namuna dikhane ke liye roka jata hai. Ustad stick dikhate samaye in baton ko dhyan mein rakhen : (a) Stick dikhane wala kabhi age ki taraf kadan na le. (b) Stick ka war sidha, zordaraur jawan ke baen kandhe ki taraf ho. Stick rifile ke sath bilkul nahi lagni chahie. (c) Ani ghompne ke liye, chale ko thik position mein, yani zamin se 1 feet uncha rakho. Ab ani ghopna ke liye chala dikhaya jaye. Jawan challe par ani ghomp kar nikal kare, iske bad ustad chupa le aur sidha guzar jaye. BHAG 3- DAHINE WAR BACHA AUR ANI GHOMPNA. Agardushman dahine kandhe par war kare to zaruri hoga ki uska war dahine taraf radh kar diya jayeaur phir ani ghompi jaye. Abhi batao ki dushman par ani ghompne ke liye koi rukawat nahi hai. Is liye yaha shatru par sikhe hue tariqe se ani gomph kar nikal jana chahie. Hadison se bachne ke liye, stick dikhane wala apna baen paon ko piche lekar apne badan ko baen kare. Abhiyas : Squad ko jorion mein abhiyas karao. BHAG 4- HAMLE KE DUSRE TARIQE 309 Agar jawan age bhar kar dushman par ani ghompe aur dushman baen ko war khali kar do to dono ek dusre ki zad mein aa jayenge jani dono ek dusre ke itna nazdik aa jayegen kin a hi kunde ka war kiya ja sakega aur na hi sangeen ka. Is surat mein dushman par kisi na kisi kism ka war kiya jaye, is ka faisala is bat parnirbhar hoga ki dushman kis qism ka war ke liye mouqa deta hai. Aise mouqe par yeh zaruri hai ki jo bhi war kiya jaye, bejhijke aur zor se kiya jaye. Fire ke sath war bachana Jab jawan dushman par hamla kare ya dushman us par hamla kare, to pahle iske kih who ek dusre ke upar sangeen se war Karen, jawan ko chahie ki who goli fire kar ke dushman ko barbad kar de. Aise halat mein rifle khule mein hoti hai, jawan ko chahie ki khule se hi rifle ko dushman ki sidh mein rakhte hue, ek hi jatke se trigger daba kar goli fire kar de aur jab tak mauqa mile, fire karta jaye. Agar dushman barbad na hua ho aur bahut nazdik a jaye, to phir baen ya dahine war bacha kar use barbad kar dena chahie. Abhiyas Isi kam ka abhiyas karao aur bad mein pure sabaq ka. SANKSHEP Sawal-o-jawab karo. INSTRUCTOR’S NOTES (a) Traning stick ke sath abhiyas lete samay gol chhakar mein lo. (b) Stick se war karte samaye kabhi age ki taraf kadam n alia jaye nahi to hadsa hone ka khatra hai. (c) Bhag 4 ka abhiyas lete samay war bachane se pahla, jawan goli fire kare. (d) Do acche jawano ka namuna. ***************************************************************** ******************************************************************* **************************************************************** SPECIAL WEAPONS FOR ADDITIONAL KNOWLEDGE 1) X-95 RIFLE 310 1. X-95 RIFLE KI AAM JANAKARI, KHOLNA AUR JORNA PRASHI KSHAN VISHAY UPKARA N Shuru Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan, class X-95 – shuru ki ginati va bant . rifle ka kam Siling, Magazin e, drill cartridge , bayonet cleaning kit. Black board, duster, sanketak , ground sheet figure 1X1 target. Dohara Insas ke magazine me kitana round Tadaiv i aate hai. SHIRS HAK Uddesh ya Is path ki samapti ke pashchat prashiksharthi X-95 rifle ki aam jankari kholana/ jorana ke bare me janane me saksham honge. Tadaiv AVANT IT ABHIY SAMAY UKTI 1 Path minute aramb h karane se pahale prashi kshak prashi kshart hiyo se purva path se samba ndhit prasna Karen. 1 Paddat Minut i – e vyakh yan 1 Paddati Minut – e vyakhy an 311 Paricha y Suraks ha ke upaya Chalan e ka siddha nt X-95 assault rifle ka nirmad Israel ki company Israel weaon industry ke dwara year 2003 me kiya gaya jo ki India me naxalwad atankwad avam ugravad ki gurilla ladai ladane ke liye is rifle ko year 2010 me aayat kiya gaya . Yah rifle din aur rat ke samay Leintegral (Mepromdr) Replex Sight, reflex sight ke dwara kargar fire dalane ki kshamata rakhati hai. jisase gurilla larai tatha rat ke samay kiye jane vale operation me kamyab hathiyar hai. Is rifle me 5.56X45 mm ball amns ka istemal kiya jata hai. Jo ki NATO standard ka hai. Yah Insas rifle se 25% halka tatha 33 Cm chhota hai. Iska magazine steel ka bana hua hai jisame 30 round aate hai. Isake but me. Buffer hone ke karan isame pichhe ko dhakka kam lagata hai. Isame tin prakar ke sight istemal kiye jate – 1. Backup sight 2. More integral reflex sight 3. Optical sight. 1. Rifle ko achhi tarah chek Karen. 2. X-95 assault rifle se keval prashikshit jawan se hi fire karaye. 3. Hamesha ke fire se bache. 4. Baen hath se fire karane wale ke liye cocken handle baen Karen. 5. Fire karene se pahle hathiyar ko zeroing kar le. 6. Hathiyar se hip position me fire Karen. But ke upar hath ka support le. 7. Lagatar 08 magazine se jyada fire na kare. Close bolt Gas ke dabav Piston head ka dabav Hathiyar automatic bhi aur semi automatic bhi. Ak sath 240 round fire kiya ja sakata hai. TECHNICAL DATA Calibre – 5.56 MM Ammunition – 5.56 X 45 MM OFV and NATO standard Tadaiv 4 Paddat Minut i – e vyakh yan Tadaiv 5 Paddat Minut i – e vyakh yan Tadaiv 10 Paddat Minut i -– e vyakh yan 312 Kholan a Magazine – 30 rounds Weight – 03 Kgs Khali Magazine – 220 Grams Bhari Magazine – 380 Grams Bhari Magazine ke sath rifle ka wazan – 3.600 Kgs Rifle ki lambai – 59 Cms Barrel ki lambai – 33 Cms Bayonet ki lambai – 27 Cms Cover ke sath bayonet ki lambai – 31 Cms Grouse – 06 (dahine tarf 1.7 Inch ghumav) Muzzle velocity – 860 meter/ second Cyclic rate of fire – 700 se 1000 round Kargar range – 700 meter. X-95 assault rifle do hisso me khulata -tadaiv- 6 Paddat hai. Minut i – Pratham Hissa – e vyakh a. Rifle ka nirikshan karo. yan b. But locking pin ko dabao. Sidha upar uthao. c. But ko kholo. d. Recoiling mechanism ko upar uthao aur bahar nikalo . Dwitiy hissa – a. Buffer se return spring ko nikalo. b. Buffer ke upar dabav dekar bolt carrier guide ko assembly se alag karo. c. Bolt guide pin ko nikalo. d. Firing pin ko bolt carrier se nikalo. HISSE PURJO KE NAM 1. Flush special 2. Front ceiling kadi 3. Front backup sight . 4. Operational accessories base 5. Integral reflex sight 6. Rear back sight. 7. Gas cylinder 8. Meddle ceiling kari. 9. Rear ceiling kari. 10.Last round catch 11. Magazine relayaser 12. Trigger 14. Cocking handle. 15. Laser PTT shoes 16. Piston 17. Bolt 313 Safai Jorana Sanksh ep 18. Recoiling spring 19. 19. Bolt carrier guide rod 20. Buffer 21. Firing Pin 22. Bolt guide pin. CLEANING KIT. Tadaiv& 5 Paddat 1. Oil cap Minut i – 2. Cleaning rod e vyakh 3. Sadharan cleaning brush yan 4. Chamber aur barrel extension cleaning brush 5. Internal receiver cleaning brush. TIN PRAKAR KI SAFAI 1. Roj ki Safai 2. Fire se pahale ki safai 3. Weekly safai. Har ek safai me bahari hisse ko sadharan cleaning brush se safai Karen. Lens ko rezar paper se saf karen. Cleaning cloth ko cleaning rod ke andar ghusaye. Barrel aur chamber ko saf karen. Internal receiver cleaning rod se hathiyar ko thik se pakadkar butt ko niche ki taraf karake safai karen. Lekin chamber ki taraf se andar na karen. Lohe ke hisse purjon me tel lagaye. 1- Bolt aur firing pin dubara bolt -tadaiv- 5 Paddat carrier me lagayen. Minut i – 2- Fault surface aur firing pin helical e vyakh surface me lagaye. yan 3- Firing pin ko bina hilaye rear sight ko thoda upar karen. 4- Firing aur bolt ko bolt guide pin rok kar rakhata hai. 5- Guide rod pichhe ko harkat karta hai aur buffer me sama jata hai. 6- Yakin karen ki guide rod ka position aage hai. 7- Recoiling ke hisse purje ko andar karen. 8- Butt ko band karen. 9- Locking pin ko dabate hue band karen. 10- Nirikshan karen. Sawal Jawab se -Tadaiv- 2 Paddat Minut i – 314 e vyakh yan 2. X-95 RIFLE KE SIGHT KE BAREN ME JANKARI VA FIRE KARANE KE TARIKE SHIRSHA K Shuru shuru kam AVANTI PRASHIKS T HAN SAMAY UPKARAN VISHAY – Hathiyar aur saman ka ka nirikshan, class ki ginati va bant Doharai X-95 rifle kitane khulati hai.? Uddeshya Is path ki sampti ke paschat prashinarthi X-95 rifle ke sight ke bare me janakari va fire karane ke tarike janane me saksham honge. Metrolight - multi purpose reflex sight do laser point ke sath khas aur shatir nishane ke kam atta hai .Israel defence force ise development kiya hai .isame 30 mm diameter wala lens Lambi duri ko chhota kar deta hai. X-95 rifle se sist lene ke liye sath me intergiyan reflex sight ka Parichay Reflax sight hisso me KUL LAGA TAR SAMA Y X-95 Rifle, 1 Minute 1 ceiling, Minut Magazine, e drill cartridge, bayonet, cleaning kit, black board, sanketak, ground sheet, figure 1X1 target -tadaiv1 2 Minute Minut es -tadaiv1 Minute 3 Minut es -tadaiv- 2 Minute 5 Minut e -tadaiv- 10 Minutes 15 Minut 315 bandobast kiya hai. Sidhe taur par barrel ke upar attach kiya gaya hai jo hamesha uchch koti ki accuracy deta hai. More reflex sight :More reflex sight se ham kai prakar ke kam le sakate hai. isame kai prakar ke laser bim kiran hote hai jo ki jaldi aur stick fire karane me kam ata hai. es REFLEX SIGHT KE HISSE PURJO KE NAM 1. Lens 2. Battery cover 3. Operation switch 4. Adjusting srew 5. Optical fibre cover Backup sight Optical sight Fire REFLEX SIGHT KE SWITCH KI PARIBHASHA Off – off switch rakhane se laser vim, lead elevation band ho jata hai. 1,2,3 Switch – Isame lagane se laser designing tin kism ka designing nikalata hai Tab jab laser PTT cover me dabav parata hai. L – Is position me reflex bindu laser bim se nikalata hai jo ki elemating hokar lal light me parivartit hota hai. Tab jab PTT switch ko dabata hai. I.R. – PTT catch ko dabane se IR laser bim nikalata hai. Back up sight Isaka istemal kiya jata hai jab reflex sight dusara kam kar raha hota hai. Front rear sight bolt aur appreture se bull par nishana liya jata hai. OPTICAL SIGHT : Isame ek powerful telescopic va night vision ko barrel me operational accessories base ke upar lagaya jata hai. Bhar ki karyavahi -tadaiv- 4 Minutes 19 Minut es -tadaiv- 3 Minutes 22 Minut es -tadaiv- 8 Minute 30 316 karane ka tarika Single shot Burst fire Khali karana Sankshep Hathiyar ko uthayen, Hathiyar ko 60 degree me pakaren. Magazine catch ko dabate hue magazine ko utare ek bhara hua magazine magazine way me dakhil karen. Rifle ko cock kare va safety lever ko fire position me kare. Firing position – Kneeling, sitting, scouting, standing positiono se kiya jata hai. Is hathiyar se single shot aur burst fire kiya jata hai. Jab fire selector lever ka position aar par rakhkar rifle ko cock karake fire karate hai to ek – 2 goli ka fire hota hai. Jab fire selector lever ka position A par rakhakar rifle ko cock karake fire karate hai to ek sath kai goliyon ka burst nikalata hai. Fire selector lever ka position S par rakhane se rifle safety me rahata hai. Piston grip ko pakadkar rifle ko uthaye, rifle ko 60 degree me ghumaye. Anguthe ki madad se safety lever ko S par karen. Magazine relayase ko dabakar magazine ko utarkar pouch me rakhen. Rifle ko chek karen. Hathiyar ko 60 degree me le jakar tin bar cock karen. Cocking handle ko pichhe rahane de. Hathiyar ko 45 degree me le jakar baen turn karen avam ejection port cover se dekhe ki chamber khali hai. Cocking handle ko aage jane de. Trigger dabaen. Safety lever ko S par karen aur magazine lagaye. Sawal avam javab se. Minut es -tadaiv- 2 Minutes 32 Minut es -tadaiv- 2 Minutes 34 Minut es -tadaiv- 4 Minutes 38 Minut es -tadaiv- 2 Minutes 40 Minut es 317 ********************************************************************** ********* 2). AGS/AGL Shirsha k Shuru shuru ka kam Vishay Prashiksh Avanti an t upkaran samay Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan calss 30 MM 1-2 ki ginti va bant AGL Minut mount, 3 e mag box link, drill grenade, sight with box, ground sheet, black board chalk, sanketank , duster aamrookh Abhiyukt i Path aaramb h karame se pahle prashik shak, prashik shanart hi se purva path se samba ndhit prashn a 318 Dohrai Uddesha y Parichay Bhag Karen. HE No 36 grenade ka mar dalne ka -Tadaiv - 2-3 Paddati ilaka kitana hai Minut vyakhya e n Es path ki samapti ke pashchat -Tadaiv - 3-4 -Tadaiv prashikshathy 30 mm AGL ammunition Minut ki vishestayen, saman lagana asthan e lena nirikshan report ke bare me janne me saksham hoge. Jaise ki aap jante hain ki GF rifle aur -Tadaiv - 4-9 -Tadaiv insas rifle ki sahayta se ham HE No 36 minut grenade fire kar sakte hai lekin e atankvadiyo avam ugravadi en dino me adhunik hathiyar ka istmal karna shuru kar diya hai isko dekhte huye Bharat sarkar ek aise hathiyar ki jarurat mahsus kiya jo dusman ko bhari tadad me ek sath barbad kar sake. Esi kram me Russia se AGL-17 ka niryat kiya. 30 mm AGS-30 AGL ke prarup hai. AGL ka avishkar Russia ne 1975 me kiya usi san me esko Rush sena me shamil kiya. Afganistan me chechniya ke sath ladai me bhari tadad me ye hathiyar estemal kiye aur kamyabi bhi mili. San 1989 me ye hathiyar Bhartiye sena me shamil huya, Bharat ne 1999 me Kargil yudh me ese istemal kiya. Esi san me AGS ko Sima Suraksha Bal me samil kiya gaya. CRPF me yah hathiyar san 2000 me aaya . Ye sabak apko tin bhago me sikhaya -Tadaiv - 9-15 -Tadaiv jayega minut 1 AGS aur ammunitions ki e visheshtaye 2 Saman lagana tatha asthan lena 3 Nirikshan avam report. AGS aur ammunitions ki visheshtaye 1. Launcher : 10.5 kg 2. Mount : 6 kg 3. Side with : 1 kg three system 4. Ammunition box with 30 Grenade : 14.85 Kgs 5. Grenade ka wajan : 350 Gram 6. Link ka vajan : 45 319 Gram 7. Khali amns ka Wazan : 03 Kgs. 8. Sight with case : 3.5 Kgs. Lamba range aur accuracy :a) AGS 30 ka kargar range 1700 meter hai aur fire ki yogyata is prakar hai. i. End Fire – 1800 meter Open side. ii. 700 meter optical sight se Direct Fire :50 meter se 1700 Meter (Low angle) Indirect fire – 1000 Meter se 1700 meter (high angle) Fire ki raftar 1. Normal – 50 Grenade prati minute 2. Rapid – 100 Grenade prati minute 3. Cyclic rate of fire – 400 Grenade prati minute 4. Control Elevation – 67degree 5. Control traverse – 42 degree 6. 600 tukado me fatata hai. 7. Mar dalane ka area 10 meter charo taraf hai. 8. Do fuse hote hai. Isame 16 grouse hote hai. 9. AGS belt fit va hawa se thandha hone wala hathiyar hai. 10. Jawan toli ke taur par kam karate hai. AGL ka mechanical sefty i. Barrel ka chhota hona ii. Chamber ka parlure hona iii. A.P.I ka hona iv. Bolt ka bhari hona v. Majboot return spring ke sath guide rod ka hona. AGS ke AGS 30 ki ammunition ko (VOG-30) ke -Tadaiv - 15-20 -Tadaiv ammunitio am se jana jata hai. Fatane ke ariya se minut n ki 10 meter charo taraf mar dalta hai. e visheshtay Isaki maximum range 1700 meter hai. en Grenade ka Wajan – 350 Gram Court case ka wajan – 75 Gram Shell ka wajan – 275 Gram Grenade ki Lambai – 132.8 Meter 320 Shell ki lambai – 112.4 meter Cartridge shell ki lambai. – 28.0 meter Authorised ammunition First line - 450 Grenade On weapon – 300 Grenade Unit reserve – 150 Grenade Second line - 150 Grenade Shell ke andar barood 94% R.D.X aur 06 % wax hota hai. Jisko ak sath a9-1 (HE) nam diya jata hai. Ismae wire guide band hota hai. Iska fuse itna nazuk hai ki agar tin meter se jayada upar se grenade hath se gir jay to grenade ko bina koi harkat kiye hue vahin barbad kar dena chahiye. Saman lagan aur asthan lena Asthan lena No. 1 ke pas launcher aur sight -Tadaiv - 20-27 launcher mount ke Sthan se 05 kadam minut pichhe aur baen is tarah se rakha jay e ki muzzle aage aur fid cover upar ki taraf ho. Launcher ke baen optical sight fid cover ki sidh me is prakar rakha ho ki optical ki khulane wala tasma launcher ki taraf ho launcher avam sight ke beech me itana jagah ho. Taki ek javan asani se let sake. . No. 2 ke pas saman mount aur ammunition ho jo ki launcher se 05 kadam dahine mount khula hua dono rear leg pichhe ki taraf mount ke dahine ek ammunition box shutter mount ki taraf ho. No. 3 ke pas saman do ammunition box. Launcher aur mount ke beech me panch kadam pichhe ammunition box ko is tarah rakho ki shutter aage ki taraf air carrying step upar ki taraf dono ke beech me itna jagah ho taki ak jawan aasani se let sake. (1,2 va 3 banto) Jab aadesh milata hai -Tadaiv - 27-30 Numbers asthan lo to numbers daudkar f aate hai no. 1 launcher aur optical sight minut ke beech me No 2 mount ki dono tango e ke beech me aur no. 3 dono ammunition box ke beech me let jate hai. Tamam numbers dahine hath ke -Tadaiv - -Tadaiv - 321 Niriksha n aur report Sankshe p upar bayan hath is prakar rakhate hai ki hatheli ka rookh niche ki taraf aur chhati kudrati taur par uthi hui, Nigahe samane yedi panje mile hue ho. No. 1 ki dono kohaniya feed cover optical sight ke agale kinare ki sidh me no. 02 ki kohaniya rear legs foot ke agale kinare ki sidh me No. 3 ki dono kohniya ammunition box ke agale kinare sidh me ho. Badali kar. - Jab aadesh milta hai badly kar to tamam numbers ko doharate hai aur no. 3, no. 2 ki jagah no. 2 aur no. 1 ki jagah no. 3 ki jagah leta. Aadesh do line “badalikar” Line tod no. 1 :- Is aadesh par tamam numbers aadesh ko doharate hai no. 1 udhkar toli ke pichhe jakar apani seat par baith jata hai. No. 2 no. 1 ki jagah aur no. 3 no. 2 ki jagah leta hai. Aur toli se agala wala jawan daudkar no. 3 ki jagah le leta hai. (aadesh do line tod numbers ) Tino number kneeling position me baith jate hai aur apane - 2 saman ka nirikshan karate hai. Nirikshan ho jane ke bad no. 03 up karate hai tamam number line position me aajate hai aur apna dahina hath ko 45 degree angle me khada karate. Sawal aur jawab se -Tadaiv - 30-38 minut e -Tadaiv - -Tadaiv - 38-40 minut e -Tadaiv - 3). CGRL 322 1. CGRL KI AAM JANKARI AUR FIRE KARANE KA TARIKA AVAN KUL TIT LAGAT ABHIYU VISHAY SAMA AR KTI Y SAMAY Shuru- Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan, class 1 1 Abhyas shuru ki ginati va bant. minut minut Paddati ka kam e e Uddeshy CGRL ki aam jankari aur fire karane ka 1 2 Abhyas a tarika minut minut Paddati e es Bayan Sabhi jawan ko 84 MM RL jinda round 2 4 Abhyas aur atirikt saman ki jankari ho taki minut minut Paddati samay par uchit upyog kiya ja sake. es es Sabak Sabak tartib war sikhaya jayega tartib 2 6 Abhyas me pahale Launcher ki visheshtayen minut minut Paddati avam parichay. es es Launch 1- Yah Sweden ka bana hua hathiyar 4 10 Abhyas er ki hai. minut minut Paddati vishesh 2- Tank ke khilaf platoon ka behatrin es es tayen hathiyar hai. avam 3- Yah anti–tank ,anti-personnel, sabhi paricha prakar ki armed gadiyon, loading SHIRS HAK 323 y Technic al data craft, concrete bunker ke alava din ke vakt dhuan va rat ke vakt roahsani dene ke kam me laya jata hai. Yah brig loaded hai pichhe ka dhakka nahi hai. Banavat me sada tatha istemal me kargar hai. 4- Isme firing mechanism dahine aur shist lene ke liye sabhi sighten barrel ke bayin taraf hai. 1- Calibre – 84 MM 2- Lambai – 1130 MM 3- Barrel ki lamabi – 856 MM 4- Sight radius – 296 MM 5- Grouse - 24 6- Venturi ki lambai – 274 MM 7- Ghumav – 602 MM ak chakkar me. 8- Tar L ka vajan 9- Mount ka vajan 10- Fire ki rafter / minute 11- Siddhant dhikata m Range Alag - Alag round par High explosi ve anti tank TPT (Target practic e 5 minut es 15 minut es Abhyas Paddati 3 minut e 18 minut e Abhyas Paddati 4 minut es 22 minut es Abhyas Paddati 4 minut es 26 minut es Abhyas Paddati - 14.2 Kgs - 0.800 grams – 6 round – Brig loaded precaution fire recoilless 12- Telescopic sight ka vajan – 1.100 gram Hit kade target par – 500 meter Harkati target Par – 400 Meter HE round – 1000 meter Smoke round – 1300 meter Eliminating round – 2100 meter Is abhiyan ko tanko, bunkero ya pil box arms fighting gadiyon, loading craft aur isi prakar ke targeto par kargar fire hai. Ismae piyo electronically fuse hai joki holo charge ke siddhant par kam karata hai. Isame khali case ka bana hota hai. Isame telephone ring hota hai. Isame. 6 fins hote hai. TPT ka matalab target practice tracer yah training ke dauran practice dene ke liye fire kiya jata hai. Isaki banavat HEAT ROUND ki tarah hoti hai. Sath hi 324 tracer) isaki trajectory bhi us tarah hota hai. Round ko target tak pahuchane ke liye case me barood bhara hota hai. Lekin isaki nose par fuse nahi hota hai na hi yah tank ko barbad karata hai. H.E. 1- Khule me ya morche me chhipa (High dusman explosi 2- Patali chadar ki lohe ki gadiyan ve) Isame ham impact burst aur air burst bhi karava sakate hai. Isme RDX aur TMT bhara hota hai. Smoke Yah round dusman ko andha karane me aur dhuyen ka parda banane me istemal kiya jata hai. Sight lagana avam shist lena HE round ki tarah hai ise har range scale se fire kiya jata hai. illus Rat ke vakt is round ka fire karake tej roshani me dusman ko assani se barbad kiya ja sakata hai. Yah pairadipti ke nam se bhi jana jata hai. Bag no. 1- Tool role 1 2- Main spring 3- Fore sight assembly 4- Drift no. 2 5- Combination tool 6- Screw driver 7- Spare parts box (anya kai hisse purje ) 8- Fore sight attachment Bag no. 1- Tin bhag me safai rod 2 2- Cleaning tool 3- Pardarshi box me oiling brush 4- Pad ke sath ceiling 5- Muzzle cover 6- Ventury cover 7- Weapon cover 8- Lakadi ka bag Saknsh Sawal avam javab se ep 3 minut es 29 minut es Abhyas Paddati 3 minut es 32 minut es Abhyas Paddati 3 minut es 35 minut es Abhyas Paddati 3 minut e 38 minut e Abhyas Paddati 2 minut es 40 minut es Abhyas Paddati **************************************************************** ******* 4). 81 MM MORTAR 325 1. 81 MM MORTAR KI SANKSHIPT JANKARI, HIFAZAT, SAFAI KARANA TATHA KHOLNA – JORNA Shirsha k Shuru shuru ka kam Vishay Prashiks Avant han it Upkaran samay Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan, 81 MM 1-4 class ki ginati aur groupo me bant mortar, Minut mortar es sight case, base plate, cleanin g rod , screw driver, cane lubricat ing oil, chindi, pointer, sand bag, ground sheet Abhiyuk ti Paddati byakhya n aur namuna 326 Doharai 81 Mortar ke technical data ke bare me class se puchha jay. tadaiv Uddesh ya Is addhyay ki samapti ke bad prashikshanarthiyo ko 81 MM mortar ki sakshipt jankari, hifajat, safai karna tatha kholne- jodne ke bare me jankari dena hai. 81 MM mortar battalion ka sabase jayada jordar fire karane wala hathiyar hai. Ladai me isaki kamyabi isake fire par nirbhar hai. Isliye harek jawan ko mortar ki jankari, uski hifajat, safsafai, jorana va kholane ke bare me jankari dena hai. 81 MMü mortar ke bare me tartibwar jankari di jayegi. Yah jankari tin bhago me sikhayi jayegi. tadaiv Mortar ki sankshipt Doharai tadaiv Pahunc h Tartib Bhag no. 1 Bhag no. 2 Mortar ak unchi trajectory wala hathiyar hai jisame recoil ka dhakka base plate ke jariye jameen ko jajb hota hai. Yah aam taur par muzzle loading aur chikane bor wala hathiyar hai. Isase pankhudiyon se sthirata pradan tatha avaz ki gati se kam gati wale ammunition fire kiya jata hai. Alag – alag charge va unchain lagakar fire ka ilaka mukarar karate hai.ek target Ilaka ko cover karata hai. Mortar ki hifajat va safai karana. Mortar ki jindagi ko badhane ke liye zaroori hai ki mortar saf rakha jay. Saf karane me madad dene wale Upkaran – 1. Cleaning rod assembly – Isaki madad se barrel ko saf kiya jata hai. Yah do aluminium ki khokhali naliyon ka bana hota hai is rod ki lambai ko kam ya jyad kiya ja sakata hai. Rod ke shire par ek Tshape ka handle laga hua hai. Dusare shire par taron ko brush laga hua hai. Jispar chindi lagai 3 Paddati Minut es byakhya n 3 Paddati Minut es byakhya n tadaiv 3 Paddati Minut es byakhya n tadaiv 2 Paddati Minut prashiks es hak byakhya n 5 Paddati Minut prashiks e s hak byakhya n 81 MM 5 mortar, Minut mortar es sight case, base plate, cleaning rod , screw driver, cane lubricatin g oil, chindi, Paddati prashiks hak byakhya n tatha namuna aur karyavah i 327 Bhag no. 3 jati hai. Barrel ko saf rod agar na mile to improvise tarike se ek lambi lakari ke shir par garnish lapeta jata hai aur safai ki jati hai. 2. Range ki hexagonal AF size 5/32 :- yah lohe ki L-shakla ki bani hoti hai. Isaki madad se screw assembly khola aur kasa jata hai. 3. Screw driver :- Yah firing pin kholane aur lagane ke istemal ata hai. 4. Gun grease hand pump type B:Yah gease nitpal me grease lagane ke istemal me laya jata hai. 5. Cane lubricating number 3 Mark -1 ;- Isake andar 3-70 ya oil OM 58 rakh jata hai. 6. Bipod aur base plate ki safai :Isake hisse purjo ko sukhe cotton kapade se safai ki jati hai. Bad me tel lagaya jata hai. Rozana ki safai ek tatha aam safai do bar ki jati hai. Mortar ko kholana va jodana Jab aadesh milta hai base plate madhy line action, Is addesh par no. 1 base plate ko pakadkar chhati ki line me uthakar daudata hua aage jata hai. Base plate batai hui jagah par rakhate hai. Base plate ka aage wala kinara base plate se takriban 03 inch pichhe ho. Base plate ki safed line base plate ke sidh me ho aur yakin karen ki rotating socket handle pichhe ki taraf ho aur pichhe aata hai, side case lekar jata hai aur base plate baen rakhata hau aur vishram position me khara ho jata hai. Moratar jodte samay No. 2 Ka kam :No. 2 baen hath se block brig assembly aur dahine hath se barrel ko upar se pakdata hai aur uthakar daudkar aage jata hai. Block brig assembly ko socket me rakhkar lock karata hai aur yakin karata hai ki safety nob F par aur pointer, sand bag, groundsh eet 81 mm 81 MM 5 Paddati mortar, Minut prashiks mortar es hak sight byakhya case, n tatha base namuna plate, aur cleanin karyavah g rod , i screw driver, cane lubricat ing oil, chindi, pointer, sand bag, ground sheet 81 mm 328 uparki taraf ho aur barrel ko niche se pakadakar sahara deta hai. No 3 Ka kam :No. 3 bipod shoes ke tango ko kholata hai. Nob locking ko dhila karta hai. Cross labeling device ko munasib rookh me ghumata hai. Badi gear elevating ko dono tango ke beech me lata ha, Nob locking case deta hai isake bad elevating screw ko 6 inch nikalata hai. Baen hath se clip caller assembly aur dahine hath se bipod ki dahine tange aur badi gear elevating ko uthakar khada ho jata hai. Base plate ke kinare 18 inch par rakhata hai. Ab no. 02 clip caller ka niche wala kinara barrel ki motai se 06 inch upar milate hue clip bolt laga deta hai. Mortar jud jane ke bad dekhane wali baten. Base plate ke safed line base plate leg ek sidh me ho. Brig block assembly lock ho. Safety nob upar ki taraf F par ho, rotating, socket handle thik safety nob ke niche ho. Clamp caller ka nichala hissa barrel ki motai se takriban 6 inch upar aur bolt thik se kasa hua ho. Elevating screw 6 inch nikala hua ho. Nob locking kasa hua ho. Traversing nut yok ke madhy me ho. Bipod durust fasale par rakha ho. Janjeer lagi hue ho. Shak Prashikshak aur prashiksharthiyon ke aur beech sambandhit Vishay par vistar sawal purvak sawal tatha jawab hona chahiye. Sankshe Mortar ak jordar fire karane wal p hathiyar hai. Larai me isaki mahtva purn upyogita hai aur agar iska sahi dhang se istemal kiya jay to dusman ko jayada se jayada nuksan 5 Paddati Minu tes byakhya n 5 Paddati Minu tes byakhya n 329 Abhyas pahunchaya ja sakata hai. Isaki saf safai uchch darje ki honi chahiye. Prashikshak aur prashiksharthi ko toli me baithakar class ko iska abhyas karvayenge. ************************************************* ************************ 5). MMG 1. MMG KI AAM JANKARI, KHOLANA, JORANA, BHARANA AUR KHALI KARANA SHIRSHAK Shurushuru ka kam Uddeshya Bayan VISHAY Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan, class ki ginati va bant. MMG ki aam jankari, kholana, jorana, aur khali karana. Gun ko safai ke liya toot foot ki badali KUL AVANTIT LAGATAR SAMAY SAMAY 1 Minute 1 Minute 2 1 Minutes Minute 4 2 330 nirikshan karate samay ya charge lete Minutes Minutes samya kholane jorane ki jaroorat hoti hai. Yah hathiyar lambi doori tak mar karane wala hathiyar hai. Isaka cyclic rate of fire jayada hai. Aam jankari MMG do prakar ke hai 8 12 Minutes Minutes 1. Gun Machine Mag 7.62 MM 2A 2. Gun Machine Mag 7.62 MM 2A-1 2A-1 MMG 2 A MMG Wajan 10.200 Kgs 10.500 Kgs Barrel ka Wajan 03.150Kgs 3.300 Kgs Lambai 104.8 CM Kutar 7.62 MM Range 1800 Meter Sight radius Padi 848 MM Sight radisu khadi 787 MM Tej fire 200 rounds Barrel Ki Lambai 68 Cm Grouse 04 Magazine box ka wajan 09 Kgs Belt ki lambai 340 CM Belt ka vazan 6.800 Kgs Belt me link 235 hota hai. Mount tripod ka Nam 7.62 MM L4A-1 mount tripod Mount tripod ka wajan 14.200 Kgs Free elevation – 33 degreemadhya se upar 22 degree niche 11 degree Control tabs – 11 Degreedhahine, 5.5 degree avam baen 5.5 degree Tripodo ke tango ki lambai – Pichhe ka 65 CM Aage ka 60 Cm Sight unit 102 A/B – 331 Gun ko kholana Jorana Sight unit 102 A ka wajan case sahit – 6.300 Kgs Sight unit 102 B ka wajan case sahit – 6.450 Kgs Sight ka wajan – 2.450 Kgs Sight Unit 102 A ke box ka wajan – 30.850 Kgs Sight Unit 102 B box ka wajan – 04 Kgs Height - 175 MM Chaurai - 125 MM Magnification (dekhane ki Shakti) – 3 Guna Dekhane ke liye aankh ki doori - 20 MM Telescope ya dhancha - 20 MM Field of queue - 12 degree 12 min Telescope ki lambai – 85 MM BARREL GROUP 6 18 Gun ko cock karo aur barrel catch ko Minutes Minutes dabao caring handle ko upar udhao ab barrel ko aage dhakelo aur bahar nikalo. Recoil buffer :Recoil buffer ko kholane se pahale yakin karo ki recoil mechanism aage hai ab baen hath se piston grip ko pakado aur dahine hath se recoil buffer ko gun ke najdeek se najdeek pakado aur dahine hath ki kalame vali angul se catch ko upar ki ore dabao. Recoil buffer ko tab tak upar uthao jab tak gun se alag na ho jaye. RECOIL WALE PURJE Dahine hath ke anguthe se telescopic rod ke niche wale shire ko thoda aage aur upar ko uthao aisa karane se rod ke upar laga hua stud body ke niche wale ki sleet se aajad ho jayega. Ab rod ko returning spring ko piche khichate hue bahar nikalo, piston aur brig block ko kholane ke liye baen hath ko body ke pichhe va niche lagao aur cocking handle ko picche khincho, brig block aur piston aasani se body ke bahar aa jayega. Cocking handle ko aage dhakelo piston aur brig block ko body se alag karo. Hissa8 26 332 Jorate samay dhyan rakhna chahiye ki Minutes Minutes piston, brig block aur gun ka number ek hai. Aur ise tartib se jorana chahiye. Piston aur brig block. Piston aur brig block ko jorane ke liye piston ko gun ki niche wali body ke hisse me dakhil karo. Ab brig block ko upar aur aage ki ore dabate hue pakado aur body ke upar wale hisse me dakhil karo. Trigger ko dabao aur piston ko pura aage jane do. Returning spring aur rod ko lagane ke liye returning rod ki aage wali hamwar satah piston ke surakh me dalo aur aage ki ore tab tak dabao jab tak ki rod picche wala stud body ke slot ki sidh me aa jati hai to telescopic rod ko thoda niche ki ore dabao taki stud sleet me fas jaye. Recoil buffer :Recoil buffer ko jarane ke liye recoil buffer ke aage wale shire ko guide ke andar cover karate hue tab tak niche dabao jab tak ki catch pura na lag jaye. Barrel group – Barrel group ko jorane se pahle gun ko cock karo, gas regulator ko niche aur carrying handle ko upar rakhate huye barrel ko barrel supporter rakhate hue barrel ko pichhe ki ore dabao aur cocking handle ko dahini ore baithao yadi gun ko utha kar le jana ho to carrying handle ko recej se alag karate hue usko upar uthao jab gun zod di jati hai jo chal wali purjo ko aage jaane do. Hamesha gun ko jarane ke bad cock karo – Yah yakeen karane ke liye ki gun thik joor gayi hai. Trigger ko dabao chal wale purjo ko control rakhate hue aage jane do ejection opening cover ko band karo. Belt ka bharana :Pahale link ko projection dusare link ke projection gap me rakho yad rahe projecting detent clip apani taraf ho. Bane surakh me round kin ok rake aur round ke pende ko itana dabao ki jab tak clip ki avaz na kare. Is tarah baki roundo ko bhi bharate jao. Agar drill kartoos ko nikalane ki jaroorat pade to kartoos ki nok ko sakht jagah par dabate hue link se alag karo. 333 Bhar aur khali kar Sankshep Bharna – 10 36 Bhar ke adesh par no. 2 aadesh ko Minutes Minutes doharate hai. Belt box ko kholata hai aur belt ko us samay fid tray me rakhata hai jab no. 1 ne top cover ko khada kar liya ho vah pahale round ko cartridge stopper ke khip rakhata hai. No. 2 belt ko dete samay dhyan rakhata hai ki. Belt sidha hai aur usame koi bal nahi hai. Toli ko cartiridge stopper dikhane ke liye gun ke pas line ban karao belt ko dekhen aur nikalate samay no. 1 is bat ka dhayan rakhega ki no. 2 ki koi anguli fid tray me nahi hai. (no. 2 ke kam ka abhayas lo.) No. 1 bhar ke addesh par top cover ko khada karata hai aur no. 2 ko belt hilane par usako baen hath se sahara deta hai. Top cover ko band karata hai. Is samay no. 2 baen pahloo me letata hai. Khali karna – Khali kar ke aadesh par no. 2 aadesh ko doharata hai belt ko us samay utarata hai jab no. 1 top cover khada kiya ho, belt ko box me band karata hai aur aam lying position leta hai. Khali kar ke aadesh par no. 1 gun ko cock karata hai. Tip cover ko khada karata hai. No. 2 ke belt nikalane ke bad fid tray par dekhata hai. Chembar me koi round to nahi hai Safety catch F par hai. Trigger ko dabata hai. Ejection opening cover ko band karata hai. Sawal avam Jawab se 4 40 Minutes Minutes 334 2. MMG SE FIRE KARANE KE TARIKE SHIRSHA K VISHAY Suru-suru ka kam Hathiyar aur saman ka nirikshan class ki ginati va bant. Uddeshya MMG se fire karane ke tarike Bayan Is path me fire karane ka tarika sikhaya jayega. Fire karana Fire ke aadesh par no. 2 aadesh ko doharata hai. No. 1 badan ko chhute hue aam lying position leta hai aur Mar ko dekhane ke liye apani nazar target par le jata hai. No. 1 trigger ko dabata hai. Bakhava 5 se 6 second ka bakhava deta hai. Bakhave ke dauran vah unhi chijo ko chek karata hai. Isase pahale fire ke dauran karta hai vah is prakar ek minute me 200 round fire karata hai. (rooko ka addesh milta hai.) Go on – Is aadesh par No. 2 No. 1 ke badan ko chhute hue aadesh ko doharayega aur no. 1 wahin fire jari karega. DHYAN ME RAKHANE WALI BAT – 1. Fire ka sahi fayada uthane ke liye bakhave ke dauran sist ko avasy chek kiya jaye. 2. Bina jaroorat ke lamba burst fire na kiya jaye. 3. Lamba burst chand ek maukon par fire karna ho. a. Jab koi surprise hashil karna ho. b. Jab koi samane aisa target nikal aye jis par lamba burst fire karane se fire ka achha natija hasil hone ki sambhavana ho. c. Attack se covering dete samay. d. Raising ke dauran jab target par mar nazar aana mushkil ho. KUL AVANT LAGAT IT AR SAMAY SAMAY 1 1 Minute Minut e 1 2 Minute Minut es 2 4 Minute Minut s es 20 24 Minute Minut s es 335 DAHINE BAEN KI DURUSTI Fire ke dauran dahine baen ki durusti is prakar di jati hai. – Ruk sab dahine ya baye degree ya click ‘go on” Rod No. 1 dahine ya baen degree ya click “go on”. Yadi aadesh click me milata hai to no. 1 utane hi click usi ore deflection drum par lagayega aur sist dekhega. Yadi aadesh degree me milata hai to hath se utane hi degree nap kar us asthan par koi nishan chunata hai. Gun ko lay karata hai aur fire ko jari karata hai. Yadi correction ke sath hi “go on” ka aadesh na mila ho to no. 1 “on” pukarata hai aur fire ke aadesh ki pratiksha karata hai. UPAR NICHE KI DURUSTI Fire ke dauran jab aadesh milata hai “rook” sab upar ya niche 100 ya 50 ‘go on ‘ to No. 1 mila hua correction rear sight par lagata hai aur elevation drum ki madad se najar ki line kayam karake fire shuru karata hai. Yadi ‘go on ‘ ka aadeh correction ke sath na mila ho to “on” puakarata hai aur fire ke aadesh ki pratiksha karega. Sankshep Sawal avam Jawab se 16 Minute s 40 Minut es **************************************************************** **************************************************************** ************************************************************* SPECIAL SUBJECTS FOR ADDITIONAL KNOWLEDGE 1). LESSON PLAN BANANA 336 Pahunch 1. Kisi bhi karya ko safalta purvak karne ke liye jaruri hai ki uske bare main purwanuman aur tafsil se yojna bana li jae taki us karya ki sahi tartib pata chal sake. Isi prakar kisi bhi instr ko apna lesson chalane se pahle sabak ka lesson plan banana jaruri hoga. Lesson plan ka matlab sabak ke bare mein aisi jankari aur yojna hoti hai, jiski madad se ek instr apne sabak ko samay ke mutabiq saralta aur tartib se chala pata hai. Uddesh 2. Lesson plan banane ka tariqa sikhana hai. Bhag 3. Is lecture ko teen bhagon main chalaya jayega. (a) Bhag I - Lesson plan banane se pahle ka soch vichar. (b) Bhag II - Lesson plan ka khaka aur usko banane ka tariqa. (c) Bhag III - PWT/IWT lesson plan se sambandhit hidayaten aur jaruri baten. Bhag I : Lesson Plan Banane Se Pahle Ka Soch-Vichar 4. Lesson plan banane se pahle agar hum gaur karen to hamen kuchh prashnon ke uttar ki jarurat paregi jaise, kya, kahan, kaise, kab, kaun aadi. Inhi se hamen lesson plan banane ka adhar milta hai. 5. Kya padhana hai vishay aur uddesh. 6. Dt, samay aur jagah. Jagah ka vikalp bhi hona chahiye. 7. Student ka star. Recruits, Young soldiers ya trained soldiers ke liye. Trained soldiers main bhi Sepoys, UOs ya SO’s ke liye. 8. Tariqe: Basic, PWT, CWT ya IWT ke tariqe se. 337 9. Trg aids: Kin-kin trg aids ki zarurat paregi. 10. Samay ki yojna: Samay ko yojna badh tariqe se pura upyog kiya jae. 11. Bandobasti karwai: Saman, Gaari, pani, khana aadu ki aawashyakta. 12. Kamzorian ya points jo pehle mahsush kie gae hon. 13. Is prakar ham dekhte hain ki in muddon par vichar karne se hamen lesson plan banane ka adhar mil jata hai. Bhag II - Lesson plan ka khaka aur uska banane ka tariqa 14. Lesson plan ke bare main anya kuchh bhi baatcheet karne se pahle ye nihayat hi jaruri hai ki apko uska khaka dikha diya jae aur apko bata diya jaye ki uske mukhya ansh kya hote hain. Yeh zaruri hai ki lesson plan ki outline/columns dikha dia jae sath hi ek lesson plan file cover mein namune ke taur par students ko dikha dia jae. Lesson plan ke ye mukhya ansh hote hain. (a) Sabase upar aur baen, course, subject aur periods allotted die jaen. (b) Upar aur dayen, syllabus ref, subject ref, pd No die jaen. (c) Lesson plan ke columns - Iske antargat (i) Ser No (ii) Bhag (iii) Pathaya samagri/vistaar (iv) Trg Aids (v) Samay/Time - Ismein actual aur running time darshaya jata hai. (vi) Remarks. Yeh column sabse mahatwapurna coln hota hai jiske antargat instr ke lie hidayaten di jati hain. 15. Abhi apne dekha ki lesson plan ka khaka kaisa hota hai, lekin banane ke lie karwai kis prakar ki jati hai, use ab hum dekhte hain, yani lesson plan banane ka tarika ab hum dekhenge. (a) Precis, GS pamphlet se material ikkatha karen. (b) Sabak ka uddesh aur samay ko maddenazar rakhte hue jaruri bhagon mein baant karen. (c) Har ek bhag ke ant mein kuchh sawal aur jawab shamil kar lie jaen. Isse instr ko class ka star pata chal jata hai. (d) Trg aids ka istemal. 338 (e) Har ek bhag ke sath samay ka bantwara kar dia jae. (Actual aur Running donon) (f) Kisi bhi pradarshan ko jarurat ke anusar shamil kia jae. Isse se behtar hoga ki pradarshan bhag ke ant main ya lesson ke ant main rakha jae. (g) Sankshep ant mein awashya kia jae. (h) In sabko milakar rough lesson plan ban jaega. (i) Rehearsal agar jarurat ho to kar lia jae. (j) Fair lesson plan bana lia jae. 16. Lesson plan banate waqt kuchh jaruri baten jinko dhyan main rakhna chahie woh is prakar hain. (a) Point form main ho. (b) Trg aids ko die coln main awashyakta ke anusar shamil kia jae. (c) Sawal aur jawab ke lie paryapt samay ho. (d) Sawal/Jawab pure likhe jaen. (e) Bhumika aur sankshep ko bhi pura likh sakte hain. (f) Instr ke lie hidayaten remarks coln main di jaen, Iske antargat woh sab hidayaton di ja sakti hain, jo ki instr ki madad karengi. (g) Fauji tartib aur tarika se lesson plan banaya jae tatha saaf suthra ho. Bhag III - PWT/IWT Lesson Plan se Sambandhit Hidayaten aur Jaruri Baten 14. PWT lesson plan se sambandhit jaruri baten is prakar hain;- (a) Shuru-Shuru ka kam. Basic lesson ke mutabiq ho Nirikshan aur Bandobast. (b) Uddesh. Abhyas dena hai. Udaharan den. (c) Dohrai. Sawal/Jawab classske star ke mutabiq hon. (d) Namuna. Sabse mahatwapurn bhag par dia jae. 339 (e) Abhyas. Class ki kamzorion ko maddenazar rakhte hue abhyas karwaen. Jin karwaion par abhyas dene ho uska ullekh karen. (f) Test. Dhyan rakhe ki abhyas di gai karwai main se hi kisi par test karaya jae. Sharten awashya di jaen. (g) Mukabala. Ismein bhi yah dhyan rakha jae ki yah vastvik aur vividhta purn ho. Yah bhi jaruri hai ki karwai aur tarika aisa chuna jae ki sabke lie barabar ho. Sharton ka ullekh remarks coln main karna chahie. (h) Sankshep. Shak aur sawalon ka jawab den aur uska parichay class ko unke actual star bataen. Unki kamzorion ko gaur karen aur jarurat ke anusar tatha class ki karwai ke anusar unka hausla badhaen. 18. IWT lesson plan se sambandhit jaruri baten is prakar hain ( Slide 7). (a) Shuru-Shuru ka kam. Basic aur PWT lesson ke mutabiq hi. (b) Uddesh. Hathiyar ki handling main aur bhi abhyas dena hai. (c) Hidayten. Is bhag main sabak se sambandhit sabhi hidaytenclass ko di jaen. Sath hi bhi class ko batai jaen. Jaise - drill amn ka istemal karne, asli tgt ka na hona zamin ki banawat ki bandishen. (d) Zor Dene Wali Baten. Aise mudde jin par aap zor dena chahte hai wah students ko bata dia jata hai. Jaise Morcho ka sahi chunav aur stemal, fasle ka sahi anuman lagana. Instr ki madad ke lie sabak se sambandhit kya-kya baten check karni chahie, remarks coln main di jaen. (e) Larai ki Halaat. Ismein zamini nishan aur larai ki tactical halaat ke bare main students ko bataya jata hai. Yad rahe ki larai ki halaat main adhik samay na lagaya jae aur use saral aur asani se samjhane yogya banaya jae. Instr ke lie sath-sath hidayaten remarks coln mein di jaen. Inhe pura likha jae. (f) Yad Dilao. Sabak se sambandhit sawal jawab pura likha jae. Ismein minor tactics ke sawal bhi shamil karna chahie. (g) Abhyas. Is bhag par sabse adhik samay dia jae aur pure sabak par karwai karai jae. Ismein sabse adhik zor tactical baton ke sath, hathiyar ki handling par ho. Sankshep 340 19. Sabak ko tartibwar chalane ke liye aur samay ka pura aur sahi istemal karne ke lie yeh jaruri hai ki vishay se sambandhit lesson plan bana lia jae. Aisa karne se faidon ke bare main ab adhik batane ki awyashakta nahin hai. Ise hum dekh chuke hain. Kisi bhi sabak ko sucharuroop se chalane ke lie, ek nape-tule star ko kayam rakhne ke liye aur instr avum VIPs ki sahuliat ke lie lesson plan ka bana lena ati awashyak hota hai. Iske mahatwa ko asani se nazarandaz nahin kia ja sakta hai. 2).FIRING RANGE KI TARTIB Uddesh Range ki tartib aur coachkarne ki tartib sikhana hai. Parichay Time ki bachat ke liye aur die hue time ke andher range ka zaida se zaida faida uthane ke liye yeh baten zarurai hai : (a) Range par kam karene ki durust tartib. (b) Achi butt marking drill. Range ki tartib Range par istemal karne wala saman Jawano ko range par le jane se niche likhi hai chizen check list ke anusar achi tarah check kar lena chahie : (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) (i) (j) Amn (hone wali pracs ke anusar). Tgt ki qismon aur tadad. Tgt repair ka saman. Milap ka sadhan (RS,Telephone, tar, whistle zarurat ke mutabik). Range standing order aur range course. Range clearance certificate. Firing point aur butt register. Paper, pencil aur clip boards. Red plags/bamboos zarurat ke anusar. Seantries ke liye red jackets/bigular first aid ka bandobast, arms aur niaut fire ke liye lamp hurricane zarurat ke anusar. 341 (k) Sand bags aur ground sheet zarurat ke anusar. (l) Ganti/belcha. (m)180 Lbs tent auter flywa zarurat ke anusar. (n) Pani ka bandobast. (o) Hathiyaron ka before firing inspection ki honi chahie. Range par jane se pahle barrack/camp mein karwaian : Range par jane se pahle niche likhi baton ka bandobast kar lena chahie : (a) Ammunition aur Amn party : Ammuniation ki qism aur tadad check kar li jaye aur is party ke jawan fire karne walon mein se nahi hone chahie. Is party ke jawano ko fire ki jane wali practice ki achi tarah se jankari dilani chahie. (b) Hathiyar : (1) Range par jane ke ek din pahle, fire hone wale hathiyar turning up aur zero hone chahie jin ka record coy/armourer ke pas hone chahie. (2) Isi parakar har hatiyar ke sath istemal hone wale magazino ko bhi achi tarah mulhaziaaur test kar lena chahie, taki firing ke dauran koi rukawat peshna aye. (c) Butt se milap : Butt se milap ke liye hoshiyar jawan detail karne chahie. Signal ya ishare pahle se muqrar kar lene chahie. Faltu bat chit ki ijajat nahi honi chahie. (d) Butt party : Butt party kafi pahle detail kar deni chahie. Agar is party ko bhi fire karna ho, to inki babli pahle se hi detail kar deni chahie. (e) Dusri dutian : Look out sentry aur aron ko tayar karne wali toli detail ki jaye aur unhe unki duty achi tarah samjaye. (f) Tamam jawano ko range ki tartib aur fire ki jane wali practice samhei jaye. Agar ho sake to range par jane se pahle, din mein range par hone wali tamam karwaion ki rehersal karai jaye. Range drill Order of fire batane se pahle, hathiyaron ka mulhazia aur sighton ko kala karao. Mulhazia ki karwai firing point officer ya JCO ke niche honi chahie. Ammuniation : Ammuniation ka mulhazia karo yeh karwai officer incharge ki nigrani mein hogi aur in baton ka yakin karo : (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) Tamam fire hone wale ammuniation ki sealen uski nigrani mein khuiti hai. Hrek dibbe/box ka ammuniation usi dibbe/box ke saan rakha jaye. Ammuniation ka lot number firing point register per note ho. Ammunition ki tadad aur qism firing point register par note karo. Yakin karo ki firing point par laga hua ammuniation defective/restricted to nahi hai. Yadi firing ke dauran ammuniation ke karan koi hadsa ho jaye, to us lot ke ammuniation ka fire band karke uski report, ammuniation ka lot number aur hathiyar sahit upar wale HQ aur QM ko di jaye. Order of firing aur targaton ki bant coach karne wale ko firing point par march karna. 342 Pahle do detail ko chor do, baki jawano ko piche munasib jagah par bhej de, jahan who ustad ke niche hathiyar safai ya weapon traning ka abhiyas Karen, ya fire hone wali partion ke bare mein jankari di jaye. Number 1 aur2 detail ko march karke, firing point ke piche 10 aur 20 gaz ke faisle wali jhadion ki line par lao aur suraj ki roshini ke khilaf muh karke baitha do. No. 1 details ko ammuniation issue karne aur usko saaf karne ka hukam do. Yeh yakin ho jane par ki tamam suraksha sambandhi/bandobasti karwaian thik hai : (a) Tamam zarurai jagah par jo muqami range order ke anusar ho.Sentry khade hai. (b) Unke pas siti, lal jhanda, lal jacket aur steel halmet hai. (c) Sentry se ghire hue ilaqe mein koi admi ya jandhar vastu to nahi hai. (d) Muqami hukamo/standing orders ke mutabik fire karne ke lie “clearance certificate” apne pas maujud hai. Details ko khare hone aur advance karne ka hukam do jis par no. 1 detail firing point par, number 2 detail number 1 detail ki jagah par ayagi aur teesri taiyari khari detail number 2 ki jagah legi. Coach firing point par firer ki record book len aur unki grouping ki qabliat malum Karen. Uske bad firing point officer yeh hukam dega : (a) “Detail number” iske upar target upar jane chahie. (b) “Detail position” ar fir, is par number 2 detail aur 3 detail suraj ke barkhilaf muh karte hue baith jaye. No. 2 detail ko ammuniation banta jaye jisko who saf kare. (c) “00 gaz limber up” coach shuru kar. Is par coach firer ki position check kare aur limber up khatam hone par khara ho jaye. (d) “Bhar”. (e) “Delibrate fire” is par coach practice ke anusar firer ke sath position leta hai. (f) Round khatam hone par coach yakin karte hai ki rifle khali hai aur butt niche hai. (g) “Khali kar” is par fire kar rahi detail khali kar ki karwai kar ke khari ho jati hai aur baqi do piche baithe dul detailen bhi firing point ki taraf muh kar ke khari ho jati hai. (h) “Nirikshan ke liye janch shastr” Is par sikhe hue tariqe ke anusar karwai ki jat hai. (i) “Report” par bari bari clear ki report baen se di jati hai. (j) “Chal wale purje age kar/bolt chala aur bazu sashtr, case uthao” ke hukam par sikhe hue tariqe ke anusar karwai karo. (k) “Target check” telephone operater butt ko is karwai ka signal de. (l) “Coach shuru kar” Is par coach firer ko uski galtain batata hai. (m)“Detail piche mur”. (n) “Detail badle” ke hukam par fire kar chuki detail tol shastr se jati hai aur number 5 firer ke adesh anusar who pahle ammuniation point par khali case ammuniation jama karti hai. Iske bad apne point sunne ke tie telephone par jati hai. Point sunne ke bad piche mur jiti hai aur apne 343 hathiyaro ko saf karti hai. Ane wali dono details sam tol shastr se age barti hai, jisme se number 2 detail firing point par aur number 3 detail no.2 ki jagah par a khari ho jati hai. Is tarah no.5 detail number 3 ki jagah leti hai. Is tarah se detailen bari fire karti hai. Fire samapti par kam : Fire samapti hone par karwai : (a) Fire samapti par hathiyaro ka mulhazia karna. (b) Ammuniation ki ginti karna, fired case, misfire aur bache hue zinda roundon ki tadad firing point register par bharna. (c) Sikka ikatha. (d) Jawano ko unke natije sunnana. (e) Akhir mein “fire samapti ka begule bajana. (f) Butt party aur sentry ki report lena. (g) Civil adhikarion se “no casulity/no damage” likhit report lena,( muqami/range standing order ke anusar). Sankshep (a) (b) (c) (d) Range par tamam harketen chatak honi chahie. Faltu koi bat chit nahi hoti chahie. Tamam karwai hukam se aur discipline ke ander honi chahie. Butt se milap ke liye ishare muqarrar kiya ja sakta hai : (1) One ring - Target up. (2) Two ring - Target check. (3) Three ring - Point batao/janda upar wagaira. 3). SIKHLAI KE TARIQE Pahunch 1. Ek acchha instr woh hota hai jo apne students ko jo gyan sikhlana hai use achchi tarah se sikha saken. Aap sabhi log yeh course karne ke bad jab unit mein jaenge to ho sakta hai aapko ek instr ka kam diya jaye, tab aapko class lene ki jarurat padegi. Ek class ko acchhe tarah se chalane ke liye yeh bahut hi jaruri hai ki aap sikhlai ke tariqe ko acchhi tarah se jante ho. In tariqon ko janana hi kafi nahin hai, balki ek aacha instr banane ke liye hamen inhe apni adaton mein shamil kar lena chahiye. Uddesh. 2. Aap ko sikhlai ka tariqon ke bare mein am jankari dena. Bhag 3. Yeh lec do bhagon mein chalaya jayega. 344 Bhag I - Niyam aur Usul Bhag II - Instr ki khubian Bhag I - Niyam aur Usul 4. Niyam. Ek achche sikhlai do khas baton par nirbhar karti hai:Instr ko us vishay par jis ko usne sikhana hai us par gaharai se gyan hona chahiye. (b) Class ko sikhne ki tamanna ya dilchaspi honi chahiye. 5. Sidhant(Usul). Upar diye gaye do niyamo ke alawa kisi bhi class ki safalta kuch usulon par nirbhar karti hai. (c) Uddesh. Kisi bhi lesson ke teen uddesh hote hain:Jaldi ka. Yeh saf aur chota hota hai eg is lec ka uddesh aapko sikhlai ke tarikon ke bare mein jankari dena hai. (i) Bad ka. Yeh uddesh kai jaldi ke uddesh ko mila kar banta hai eg is course mein jitne bhi lesson aapko padaye jate hai unkaa uddesh hai aapko ek accha sec cdr banana. (ii) Aim plus Woh uddesh hai jo students jane anjane mein sikh jate hai, eg aapko ek achha soldier banana. Sochvichar aur Taiyari. Kisi bhi lesson ko achhe tariqe se chalane ke liye yeh jaruri hai ki Instr lesson chalane se pahle hi sabhi baton ka sochvichar aur taiyari kare taki aakhri waqt mein koi badli karne ki jarurat na pare aur lesson chalane mein koi mushkil na aaye. Sochvichar aur taiyari in baton ki karni chahiye:(iii) Sikhlai ki baten. Sabse pahle ek instr jo kuchh class ko sikhlana hai uske bare mein sochvichar karta hai phir uski taiyari karta hai is prakar:(aa) Kya padana hai, kitna samay hai aur padane ka tariqa, PWT,CWT etc. (ab) Jo kuch use padana hai uska study material milega aur woh usko kis prakar taiyar karega. (ac) Uske bad subject pamphlet, precis, books ya course ke notes se dundhkar nikalega. (ad) Jo kuch use in kitabo mein milta hai uski jankari unko padkar hasil karega. (ae) Vishay ko chunna (aaa) Janana jaruri hai 345 (aab) Janana chahiye (aac) Janana se achha rahega. (af) Lesson plan Banana. Jab woh us subject (vishay) ke bare mein kafi gyan hasil kar leta hai tab use jo kuch padana hai use woh tartibwar lagata hai. Yeh karte samay use apne sabak ka uddesh, class ka standard aur use class ko chalane ke liye kitna samay diya hai dhyan mein rakhna chahiye. (Lesson plan kaise banaya jata hai yeh aapko alag lec mein sikhaya jaega). Lekin mote taur par ek Instr jo class chalane ja raha hai use tafsil mein samay, trg aid chart ya slides ka istemal karke kis tartib mein chalana hai use likhit rup mein banata hai, use lesson plan kahte hai. (Lesson plan banane ke chand ek faide class tartibwar chalai jati hai, class ko samajhne mein asani, Accident/durghatna se bachao, chizen, gun/ damage hone ki jankari, samajh ki stage wise janch. ) (iv) Trg Aids Lesson plan banate samay yeh sochvichar karna chahiye ki is class ko chalane ke liye use koun koun se trg aids chart/ slides ki jarurat padegi unka list banane ke baad woh unki demand trg store mein dega aur unko check karega ki thik hai.Yadi koi trg aids thik nahin hai to usko thik karwayega. Dhyan rahe ki koi bhi trg aid jo kam nahin karte hai class ke dauran istemal na kiye jaye. (v) Trg ki Jagah aur uska Istemal.Ek instr ko chahiye ki jis jagah par usne class leni hai wahan par jakar woh is prakar sochvichar aur taiyari kare:(aa) Jitne students ki class chalani hai kya unke baithne ke liye jagah hai, yadi nahin to uska intejam karwaye jaise ek Sqd Post ko repair karna, class ko is tarah se baithaya jaye ki suraj unke muh par na chamke. (ab) Class chalane ki jagah par jakar woh yeh dekhe ki koun se trg aid ko kis jagah lagaya jayega, yadi instr ne koi demo dena hai to use kis jagah se dega jaise ki puri class use asani se dekh sake, aur yadi students se abhyas karane hai to kis jagah se karayega aur khud kis jagah khara hoga jisse woh class ki galtion ko pakar saken. (vi) Adm. Ek achha instr ko chahiye ki woh yakin kare ki class ke liye pani ka bandobast hai, Class ke piche visiting officer ke liye baithne ka bandobast hai aur class 346 ka nominal roll, lesson plan, clip board, paper aur pencil table par rakha hai. Iske liye use taiyari karni chahiye. (vii) Vidhyarthion ka Star. Instr ko sikhlai pane wale vidhyarthion ke star ke bare mein gyan hona awashyak hai aur woh jo bhi soch vichar karta hai use class ka star dhyan mein rakhna chahiye. Vidhyarthion ke star mein antar ko dhyan mein rakhte hue hi class ki squadding bhi ki jati hai is prakar:(aa) Vidyarthion mein antar. Vidyarthion ke star mein antar nimnlikhit karan se ho sakta hai:(aaa) Gyan (intellegence). Cl ke sabhi vidyarthion ka gyan ek sa nahin ho sakta. (aab) Age badne ki jigyasa(intrest). Jo vidyarthi age badna chahte hai eg is course mein achhi grading hasil karna chahate hai woh ziada kam karenge aur baki students se acchhe honge. (aac) Utsukta (exitment). Jis kisi bhi student mein kisi bat ko janane ki utsukta ya jigyasa hoti hai uska us student se jisko koi utsukta nahin hai usse achha hona swabhawik hai. (aad) Pichla Anubhav. Jis vidyarthi ka pichla anubhav ziada hai woh baki students se achha hoga jaise ki is course mein jo student ziada pre course trg. (viii) Squadding .Aapne dekha hoga ki kisi bhi bare cl ki WT ke liye squadding ki jati hai. Squadding in karn se ki jati hai:(aa) Karan. Kion ki vidyarthion ke star mein antar hota hai isliye yadi ek achha aur ek kamjor vidyarthi ko ek hi sqd mein rakh diya jae to achha aur kamjor dono kism ke vidyarthion ko sikhlai mein mushkil aayegi. (ab) Basis. Takriban ek hi star ke vidyarthi ek sqd mein hon. (ac) Tariqa. Test lekar eg is course mein entrance test lekar aapke star ka pata lagaya gaya hai. (ad) Apnapan. Jab ek hi star ke jawan ek sqd mein hote hain to unhe class ke sabhi jawan apne saath 347 ke lagte hai aur woh class mein ziada interest leta hai. (ae) Achhi Spardha. Jab sqd ke sabhi vidyarthion ka star ek sa hota hai to har ek vidyarthi cl mein achha karne ke liye mehnat karta hai. (af) Jaldi Sikhne Mein Madad. Sqd mein sabhi vidyarthion ke liye koi bhi shak ya sawal mahatava puran hota hai jo usko cl mein jiada dhyan lagane mein madad karta hai aur woh jaldi sikhta hai. (d) Dilchaspi. Is usul ka sikhlai ke dauran niyam ke saath najdiki sambandh hai (cl ko sikhne ki tammanna hona) ek instr ko class ki dilchaspi kayam rakhne ko ahmiyat ka samajhna chahiye aur is dhang se class leni chahiye ki class ki ruchi bani rahe. Ruchi kayam rakhne ke chand ek tarike is prakar hai:(i) Class se Pahle. Jahirat (advertise) karke eg achhi tarah se banaya hua trg pgme ya posters banakar info room/ dining hall mein laga diya jaye to jin logo ko yeh class mein shamil hona hai unko is lesson ko attenkarne mein ziada ruchi rahegi. (ii) Class ke Dauran. Class chalate samay ruchi kayam is prakar rakh sakte hain:(aa) Lesson mein vastvikta (realism) honi chahiye eg rif fire mein blank rd fire karke, baccat strip istemal karke darshana. (ab) Competition. Har ek admi ki dili tamanna hoti hai ki woh dusre se achha kare.Is ka faida uthate hue ham class ki ruchi competition rakh kar bada sakte hain. (ac) Kism (variety). Lesson ko is tarah se chalaya jae ki class bore na ho eg questions puchkar ya PWT, CWT ke tarike se aur trg aid ka istemal karke. (ad) Safalta ka Ahsas. Har ek admi ki yeh ichha hoti hai ki woh jane ki woh kaisa kam kar raha hai isliye ek instr ko class ki ruchi banaye rakhne ke liye cl ko batate rahe ki koun student achha kam kar raha aur koun nahi aur kisko kitni mehnat ki jarurat hai. (ae) Hansi Majak. Yeh cl ko tarotaja karti hai parantu yeh bhadda ya bahut jiada nahi hona chahiye aur cl ke upar jabarjasti nahi thopa jana chahiye. (iii) Class ke Bad. Cl ke bad quiz, oral ya written test, exercise ya OTW aur utsaha jagakar, dilchaspi paida 348 karne mein madad karti hai eg, Is course mein aap log course mein achhi grading pane ke liye test mein achha karne ke liye cl mein kafi dilchaspi lete hai. (e) Indrion ka Istemal (use of senses). Admion ki panch indrion mein se jitni jiada indrion ka ek admi istemal karta hai woh us baat ko utni hi achhi tarah se samajh ta hai. Ham sikhlai ke dauran admi ki sabhi indrion ka istemal to nahi kar pate lekin unmen se kuch indrion ka istemal trg aid ki madad se karwa sakte hai. Trg aid ki madad se indrion ka istemal kis prakar karaya jata hai aapko dusre LD mein vistar mein bataya jayega. Lakin aapki thodi jankari ke liye kuch trg aid is prakar hai:(i) Sunane Wale. PA eqpt, tape recorder etc (ii) Dekhne Wale. Charts, model, slide etc (iii) Sparsh Karne Wale. Hathiyar ke upar handling (iv) Pradarshit Trg Aid. Demo, natak, sand/ cloth model etc (f) Harkat (jagrukta). Chahe instr kitna bhi achha ho woh safal nahi ho sakta hai yadi woh class ko jagruk nahi rakh sakta. Cl ko ham harkat dekar jagruk rakh sakte hai. Cl ki harkat do qism ki ho sakti hai:(i) Dimagi. Yeh cl se sabak ke dauran bich bich mein prashna puch kar karwai ja sakti hai. (ii) Sharirik. Yeh cl ko sharirik harkat karni hoti hai eg hathiyar ke upar abhyas. (g) Prashna uttar ka tariqa:(i) Cl se prashna puchne ke niyam. Instr jab bhi prashna puche to in baton ko dhyan rakhe:(aa) Prashna pura aur saaf ho. (ab) Puri cl ko sunai dena chahiye. (ac) Prashna pahle puri cl se puchna chahiye phir ek student ka naam lekar jawab dene ke liye kahe. (ad) Prashna ek ke baad dusre students se ek line mein na puche. (ae) Yadi do student jinke naam liye hai jawab na de saken to khud cl ko jawab batay. (ii) Cl Dwara puche hue Prashna. Yadi cl se kai student prashna puche to instr ko is prakar karwai karni chahiye:(aa) Prashna puchne wale vidhyarthi ko badawa do. (ab) Use aur aram se prashna puchne ke liye kaho. 349 (ac) Use prashna banane mein madad karo. (ad) Puche gaye prashna ko dohrao aur cl se uska uttar pucho. (ae) Yadi cl ko uska uttar pata nahin hai to uska uttar batao. (af) Yadi pucha gaya prashna subject ka na ho parantu samajhdari ka ho to sankshep mein batao. (ag) Beakufi (insincere ques) prashna puchne wale ko badawa mat do (DS udaharan dekar samjhaye). (iii) Cl ke uttar par Karhwai. Yadi cl ka koi student instr ke prashna ka uttar is prakar de ki uska matlab sahi nikalta ho to use sahi mana jaye kyon ki yeh jaruri nahi hai ki prashna ke uttar ka ek ek shabd rate hue tarikese mile jo ki kitab mein likha hai. (h) Insani Baten. Gyan ke alawa ek instr mein kuch ek khubion ka hona bhi jaruri hai jo ki usko cl ke saath vyavahar mein madad karti hai. Ek instr ki khubian aur use apne students ke saath kis prakar ka vyavahar karna chahiye, main is lec ke bhag do mein bataunga. (i) Sadharanta. Ek achhe instr ko kisi bhi mushkil se mushkil vishay ko class ke star ke mutabik itni sadharan tariqe se samjhana chahiye ki cl use asani se samajh saken. (b) Samajh ki Jaanch. Sikhlai ke dauran yeh jaruri hai ki Instr samay, samay par yeh jaanch kare ki cl ne sabak ko kitna samjha hai. Yeh jaanch karne ke kya karan hai aur yeh kyon jaruri hai, yeh is prakar hai:(i) Karan. Samajh ki jaanch karne ke yeh karan hai:(aa) Sikhne walon ke liye badhawa ka kam karti hai kyon ki jab woh sahi jawab deta hai to use yakin ho jata hai ki woh lesson ko samajh gaya hai. (ab) Samajh ki Jankari. Instr ko yeh pata chal jata hai ki uska padaya gaya lesson cl ko kitna samajh mein aa raha hai. (ac) Safalta ka Ahasas. Jab ek lesson cl ko samajh mein aa jata hai to instr aur vidyarthion donon ko hi safalta ka ahsas hota hai. (ad) Kitna Extra Coaching ki Jarurat hai. Vidyarthion ne sabak ko kitna samjha hai isko dekhte hue instr yeh anuman laga sakta hai ki cl ko kitne extra coaching ki jarurat hai. 350 (ii) Samajh ki jaanch ke Hisse. Samajh ki jaanch ka ek instr teen hisson mein baant kar sakta hai:(aa) Shuru Mein. Yeh yakin karne ke liye ki cl sikhlai pane ke liye taiyar hai ya nahi eg PWT lesson mein dohrai. (ab) Cl ke Dauran. Sabak ke kisi bhi bhag/ hisse ke khatam hone ke bad aur agle bhag/ lesson ke shuru karne se pahle. (ac) Akhri Mein. Yeh yakin karne ke liye ki cl pura lesson samajh gaya hai yeh prashna puchkar, quiz test lekar kar sakte hai. Bhag II : Instr ki Khubian 7. Kisi bhi cl ki safalta ek instr ke upar nirbhar karti hai. Ek instr mein koun koun se khubian honi chahiye aur use apne cl se kis tarah ka vyavahar rakhna chahiye, is prakar hai:(b) Instr ki Khubian. Ek instr mein nimnlikhit khubian awashyak hai:- hona (i) Dhancha (Bearing). Jaise hi ek instr cl ke samne aata hai vidhyarthi instr ke kuch bolne se pahile hi usko janchna (judge) karna suru kar deta hai.Isliye ek instr ka achha bearing hona jaruri hai. Ek achhe fauji bearing ko kayam rakhne ke liye instr ko hamesha achhi tarah (turned out) dress pahanna chahiye, chust hansmukh rahna chahiye aur uska cl ke saath achha vyavahar hona chahiye (ii) Josh/ Dilchaspi (Enthusiasm). Josh ek admi se dusre admi mein failta hai. Isliye agar instr mein josh/ dilchaspi hai to cl mein bhi iska hona swabhavik hai. Isliye ek instr ko chahe koi sabak pasand na ho to bhi cl ke samne nahi dikhna chahiye. (iii) Awaj. Bilkul saaf hona chahiye aur bahut dhime ya bahut tej nahi hona chahiye. Yadi PA eqpt ka istemal kiya ja raha hai to use thik se adjust karna chahiye. (iv) Bolne ka Dhang (Delevery). Bolne ka dhang ek kala hai. Isliye ek instr ko iska abhyas karke apni adaton mein shamil karna chahiye Dhyan mein rakhne wali baten is prakar se hai:(aa) Thik speed (ab) Vakyo ke bich mein thahrao 351 (ac) Mukhya baton par jor (ad) Sidhi sadi bhasa (ae) Bekar ki baten ( takya kalam) jaise ki achha phir, soche aur batayen, aadi shabdon ka istemal nahi karna chahiye. (v) Sahan shilta (patience) . Har cl mein alag alag star ke vidhyarthi hote hai. Isliye yadi kisi ko koi baat samajh mein na aye to instr ko kabhi gussa ya chahare par pareshani nahi dikhni chahiye balki us student ki madad karni chahiye. (vi) Hansi Majak. Is gun ka ek instr mein hona nihayat hi jaruri hai,Hansi majak aisa hona chahiye jo ki cl ki pasand ka ho lekin ek cl mein hansi majak bahut ziada nahi hona chahiye aur gande kism ka nahi hona chahiye. (vii) Bharosa. Ek instr ko apni kabliyat per bharosa hona chahiye aur kabhi bhi ghabrana nahi chahiye. (viii) Gyan. Instr jo kuch padane ja raha hai use uske bare mein gahrai se gyan hona chahiye aur gyan ke saath saath usme kisi bhi baat ko aasani se cl ko samajhne ki kabliyat honi chahiye. (ix) Hav Bhav( Gestures & mannerism). Yadi ek instr kabhi kabhi kisi jaruri baat ko samjhne ke liye koi harkat karta hai to thik hai lekin yadi woh koi bhi harkat yadi bar bar karta hai jaise ki sir ko khujana, (cl ke samne) muncho par haath lagana, pointer ke saath khelna, ankh band karna etc. Kyonki aisi harkat cl ka dhyan batanti hai. (c) WT Instr ki Khubian. Instr ki khubion ke alawa ek WT instr mein in khubion ka hona bhi jaruri hai:(i) Wpn Handling. Ek instr ki wpn handling bahut hi unche darje ki honi chahiye. (ii) Trg Aid ka Istemal. Ustad ko yeh malum hona chahie ki use koun se trg aid kis samay par, kaise aur kahan se cl ko dikhana chahiye. (iii) Galti Pakarne aur use dur Karne ki Kabliyat. Ek WT instr mein itni kabliyat honi chahiye ki woh koi bhi student yadi koi choti bhi galti kare to use pakar sake aur use dur karwa sake. (d) Instr ka Cl ke Saath Vyvahar. Instr ko cl ke saath vyavahar karte samay in baaton ka dhyan rakhna chahiye:(i) Instr ka Cl ke Saath Vyvahar Instr ko apni cl ke sabhi students ka naam malum hona chahiye aur unke naam lekar hi bulana chahiye. Instr ko cl ke har student ki sikhlai ki baaton mein kamjori aur unke aache kam ke 352 bare mein jankari honi chahiye aur samay samay par use students ko inke bare mein batate rahna chahiye. (ii) Sahakarmion se nishtha. Kabhi bhi dusre instr ki burai ya unke bare mein buri baat cl ke samne nahin karni chahiye. Sabhi instr ka aapas ka mel milap achha hona chahiye. (iii) Dostana Vyavahar. Ek instr ko kabhi bhi puri cl ki taraf ya kisi ek student ke upar gusse wala ya hamesha dantne wala rukh nahin apnana chahiye. Aur kabhi bhi apne aap ko bahut bada aadmi sochkar kisi ki be-izzati nahin karna chahiye. Cl ke sath aise vyavahar hona chahiye ki cl instr ko apna samjhe usse koi bhi subject ko puchne mein madad mangsake. Instr jab kisi student ki galti ko dur karwana hai to is prakar se karwana chahiye ki student ko lage ki woh uski madad kar raha hai aur use samjha raha hai. (iv) Uphas na Karna. Kisi bhi aadmi ko yeh pasand nahi hota hai ki koi uska majak udaye. Isliye kisi bhi student ka cl ke saamne majak nahi udana chahiye. (v) Tarafdari ya Pakshpat na Karna. (Avoid favouratism) Kabhi bhi vidhyarthion ke saath pakshpat nahin karna chahiye ki yeh mere gaon ka hai, unit ka hai, Regt ka hai etc. Aisa karne se vidhyarthion mein asantushtata fail jati hai. Shuru mein to jinko instr madad nahin karte hain wahi instr ko izzat nahin karega parantu baad mein jinko instr madad karte hain wo bhi unki izzat nahi karte hai. (vi) Satta na Marna (never bluff). Waise to ek instr ko jo kuch bhi ho woh pada raha hai uska bahut achha gyan hona chahiye lekin kabhi kabhi ho sakta hai use kisi bat ka pata na ho, aise samay mein use cl ko batana chahiye ki woh us baat ka pata lagakar batayega aur use yeh yakin karna chahiye ki woh baad mein us baat ko cl ko jarur bataye. Use jis baat ka pata nahi hai uske bare mein kabhi bhi satta nahi marna chahiye. (vii) Ziada na Hankana /Khud ka Badappan) Kai log apni hamesha badai karte hai ki maine aisa kiya vaisa kia aur bahut samay barbad kar dete hai, instr ko aise karna nahi chahiye ha yadi uska koi aisa tajurba hai jisse cl ko faida ho sakta hai to use woh cl ko bata sakta hai. Lekin cl chalane ke samay ka dhyan rakhte hue. (viii) Sakti Karna (Be firm ). Ek instr ko apni cl ke saath utni sakhti baratni chahiye ki unka discp kharab na 353 ho aur koi bhi galti karne par unki sakhtai se galti na karne ke liye kahna chahiye. Vidhiyarthion ki dil mein yeh baat kabhi nahi ane deni chahiye ki galti karne ke bad bhi use kuch nahi kaha jaega. Bad mein aisa instr hamesha students se izzat pata hai. (ix) Meljol kisi had tak (Avoid Familiarity). Vidhyarthi aur ek instr ka apas mein thoda meljol hona jaruri hai lekin itna nahi ki vidhyarthi instr ki izzat karna hi band kar de. 7. Sankshep Aapko jo kuch aaj is lec mein bataya gaya hai yadi aap in baton ko cl lete samay dhyan mein rakhenge to yakinan hi ek achhe instr banenge. Aur ane wale samay mein is course ke dauran aur course ke bad aapko hamesha safalta milegi. ********************************************************************************** ************************************************************************************* ********************************************************************************** 354